P00001
The first FT-17 tanks were aquired from France in 1921. They took part in the Rif war. Some of there tanks were still in service when the Civil war broke out. More vehicles of this type were acquired from France and Poland during the conflict. Though obsolete by the 1930's these vehicles continued to soldier on due to the lack of armored vehicles. The FT-17 Tankette was of WWI design. With its rear engine compartment and turret-mounted armament, it pioneered the layout for all future tank designs. The French Army had some 1600 available in May 1940; however, around 500 were in service in metropolitan France. Most were deployed in independent tank companies (CACC).

ARMAMENT
1 x 7mm machinegun
or
1 x 37mm gun?
MAX ARMOR
16mm
WEIGHT
6.7 tonnes


P00002
The Trubia was an indigenous tank design heavily influenced by the FT-17. Though this vehicle was approved for full production, budget constraints limited numbers to six. Three of these vehicles took part in the Spanish Civil War in the Regiment of Infantry Miln. The tank was designed by army officer Captain Ruiz de Toledo, and built by Trubia in 1926 (hence the name). 

ARMAMENT
1 x 40mm gun
2 x 7mm machineguns
or
3 x 7mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
15mm
WEIGHT
6 tonnes


P00003
The T-26 was the most powerful armored vehicle on the Spanish battlefield (with the exception of the rare BT-5). Around 300 of these tanks were shipped to Spain by the Soviet Union beginning in October 1936. The first T-26 were operated by Soviet-Spanish crews and later all Spanish crews. Republican T-26 Bs were shipped to Spain with radios and had radio capability when crewed by Russians. As Republican Spanish crews took over, they ripped out the radios, desiring more room and being more comfortable with signal flags. Thus, later mixed Russo-Spanish or Spanish crews will be radioless. Though this tank was far superior to any of the vehicles operated by the Nationalists and played a vital role in the successful defence of Madrid. Poor tactics limited the effectiveness of the the Repuclican tank forces however, and the poor performace of tanks in the Spanish civil war reinforced the opinion held by many armies (France in particular) that tanks were best used for infantry support. T-26 light tanks were based on a British Vickers-Armstrong design imported into the Soviet Union in 1930. Typically employed by tank units as close support for infantry, 1200 T-26s were produced from 1931 to 1941, more than the total tank production of France and Germany combined. Most of these were the T-26 Model 1933s, and T-26 Model 1937s, which are represented together in the game.

ARMAMENT
1 x 45mm gun
1-3 x 7.62mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
25mm
WEIGHT
10 tonnes


P00004
This vehicle represents the light infantry tank M36 and its development the Basque Euzkadi light tanks. With a crew of four, such a small vehicles must have been very crowded. The engine was air cooled with armoured vents at the rear of the vehicle and was prone to mechanical breakdown. The vehicle was also severly underpowered.
The debut of this tank in a military parade was not auspicious. As soon as they saw it, the people called it the toy tank (tanque de juguete) and just as these tanks rolled past the Basque President, a number of them stalled and quit and had to be pushed in review with the help of soldiers and civilians lest they block the parades progress. 

ARMAMENT
2 x 7mm machineguns
or
2 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
10mm
WEIGHT
4.5 tonnes


P00005
A total of 50 BT series tanks arrived in Spain in August of 1937. They formed the equipment of the elite International heavy tank regiment. They were considered by the Soviet advisers to be the most modern and best tanks in Spain, and were held in reserve through the late summer and early autumn, waiting for a major opportunity to exploit their capabilities. For many of the Soviet advisors in Spain, the International Tank Regiment was the last, best hope to display the power of tanks on the modern battlefield. These hopes would be crushed in the autumn of 1937 during the Saragossa campaign.  BT-5 light tanks featured a suspension based on that of the American Christie convertible tank. The suspension of these vehicles were designed to be operated without tracks on roads, which reduced track wear and the possibility of track failure. The tracks could then be fitted for use across terrain. The resulting speed of such a flexible design found the BT series normally assigned to independent tank brigades or to cavalry formations rather than to the slower infantry. Some 7,000 BT series tanks were produced during the period 1932-41 in many variants, the most numerous being the 45mm gunned versions represented in the game.

ARMAMENT
1 x 45mm gun
1-3 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
22mm
WEIGHT
14 tonnes


P00006
The Catalonian Sadurni de Noya was one of the few attempts at domestic AFV production during the Spanish Civil War. Lacking in Russian AFVs due to Madrids suspicious jealously of Catalan autonomy, Catalonians resorted to using some of their industrial potential in the production of an armoured car that was produced in two versions: one as an unarmed personnel carrier; and the other as an assault vehicle mounting a light machine gun. Well crafted with a number of design innovations, the Sadurni de Noya was mechanically reliable but was too insignificantly armed to make any impact on the battlefield. The Spanish designation for this vehicle was Carro Sadurni de Noya. This unit also represents any of a number of locally produced tankettes.

ARMAMENT
1 x 7mm machinegun
or
1 x 7.62 machinegun


P00007
This Soviet light scout car saw initial use in the Mlaga campaign where a number of destroyed FA-1's were observed by the Italians and Nationalists. Speedy yet lightly armed, this vehicle was intended for recon use and could offer little infantry support. The FA-1 had a crew of 2. Spanish designation for this car was Autoametralladora Ligera FA-1. The FA-1 armored car was designed as a reconnaissance vehicle, and was little more than an automobile mounting a rifle caliber machinegun in a thinly armored turret. 

ARMAMENT
1 x 7.62mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
10mm
WEIGHT
2.5 tonnes


P00008
The first use of this Soviet armoured car was in the Northern Campaigns where Navarese Requets fighting their way into Bilbao, encountered defending Basques using this vehicle and other Soviet equipment which had been sent to try and save the city. This vehicle had a crew of 4. Spanish designation was Autoblindado BA-6. BA-6 heavy armored cars, although a 1930s design based on a 6x4 truck chassis , remained the standard Soviet heavy armored car throughout the second world war. They mounted a 45mm gun in an enclosed turret.

ARMAMENT
1 x 45mm gun
1 x 7.62mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
15mm
WEIGHT
5.1 tonnes


P00009
This unit represents the various locally produced armored trucks used by the Republican forces. These vehicles were based on commercial vehicles. Armor plates were bolted or welded onto the superstructure of the vehicle and machineguns were either mounted in turrets or firing slits were provided. The quality of these vehicles varied considerably. Some were practically useless, while others were truly battleworthy. This unit is a compromise intended to represent vehicles of this type and not any design in particular.


P00010
A carry over from tactics used successfully in the Russian Civil War, the armored train was used to less practical effect in the Spanish War as a mobile firing platform by Republican forces. Actual trains varied so the version given here is meant as a representation only.


P00011
The Catalonian Sadurni de Noya was one of the few attempts at domestic AFV production during the Spanish Civil War. Lacking in Russian AFVs due to Madrids suspicious jealously of Catalan autonomy, Catalonians resorted to using some of their industrial potential in the production of an armoured car that was produced in two versions: one as an unarmed personnel carrier; and the other as an assault vehicle mounting a light machine gun. Well crafted with a number of design innovations, the Sadurni de Noya was mechanically reliable but was too insignificantly armed to make any impact on the battlefield. The Spanish designation for this vehicle was Carro Sadurni de Noya. This unit also represents any of a number of locally produced tankettes.


P00012
This unit represents a group of about 6 trucks used by Republican forces. These trucks would have been from various sources, both military and commercial.


P00013
This unit represents a group of about 6 trucks used by Republican forces. These trucks would have been from various sources, both military and commercial.


P00014
This unit represents a group of horse-drawn wagons used by Republican forces. These wagons would have been from various sources, both military and commercial.


P00015
This unit represents a group of horses used by Republican forces. The Spanish Republic was never strong in cavalry. This was mostly due to the urban origin of much of the Republic's core support. Cavalry units were formed amongst the Popular Army, and joined cavalry troops drawn from the Asaltos and Loyalist Spanish Army.


P00016
This unit represents small boats used for crossing small bodies of water such as rivers or lakes.


P00017
This unit represents rafts for carrying infantry across small bodies of water.



P00019
At the outbreak of the Civil War, the shipyards of Valencia immediately began military production. The Russian engineer Nikolai N. Alymov was entrusted with the design of a new armored car. This vehicle was based on the FA/BA series, but in many ways the vehicle was superior with better mobility and a better hull design. The vehicle was produced from January 1937 until the end of the conflict.

ARMAMENT
2 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
8-9mm
WEIGHT
2-3 tons


P00101
This was a light mortar of pre-war domestic design used by both sides in the Spanish Civil war.


P00102
Possessed by both sides, 81mm mortars became more popular than the 51mm as the war progressed. The mle 27/31 81mm Mortar was designed by the Edgar Brandt company. The 81mm mortar could fire light and heavy bombs, and smoke.

MAX RANGE
2850m
SHELL WEIGHT
3.25kg & 6.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
59.7kg


P00103
As France was reluctant to supply the Republic, the Soviet Union stepped in. Mortars such as this saw action as early as the battle of Teruel. The BM obr. 37 82mm was the standard medium mortar in Soviet rifle battalions. Reasonably light and effective.

MAX. RANGE
3100m
SHELL WEIGHT
3.4kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
56kg


P00104
Purchased from France by Republican Spain. The mle 16 TR 37mm Infantry Gun was designed in 1916 as an infantry support weapon. Still in service in 1940, it was sometimes pressed into the anti-tank role.

MAX RANGE
2400m
SHELL WEIGHT
.55kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
108kg


P00105
This weapon was supplied by the Soviet Union in relatively large numbers it was very similar to the French mle 16 TR.


P00106
Supplied to the Nationalists, this gun was featured in the fighting for Madrid. Also, a common element of the Italian forces at Guadalahara, many of these guns were captured by the Republic. The Cannone da 65/17 dated back to 1913, when it was first used as a mountain gun by the Alpini troops. By mid-1940 this 65mm piece was the standard infantry support weapon of the Italian Army. Infantry regiments in regular and Autotrasportabile (truckable) infantry divisions were each allocated one battery of four 65/17 guns, as was each Blackshirt Legion. About 700 were in service in 1940.

MAX. RANGE
6500m
SHELL WEIGHT
4.2kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
556kg


P00107
This gun was used both by the Italians and the Spanish Nationalists. Captured models were acquired by the Republicans after Guadalahara. The Cannone-cc da 37/45 anti-tank gun was the German 37mm PaK 35/36 built under license by the Italians. Apparently not widely used, it was encountered by the British in the early desert campaigns. It was usually transported en portee (carried in a truck).

ARMOR PENETRATION
48mm at 500m
SHELL WEIGHT
0.97kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
435kg


P00108
A common anti-tank gun provided to the Spanish Republicans and Basques. This weapon was generally similar to the German PaK 35/36.


P00109
I have seen photographic evidence of Bofors 37mm guns in Republican use. Also this unit could represent other varied guns of around 4cm imported for the Spanish Republic.


P00110
This Anti-tank gun was supplied to the Spanish Republic by the Soviet Union. PTP obr. 32 45mm anti-tank guns were essentially scaled up versions of the German 37mm Rheinmetall gun and, despite their small caliber they served the Soviets throughout the war. The carriages of the Model 1937s were designed to be pulled by either horse or motorized transport. In 1937 the weapon was updated slightly without any major changes in performance.

ARMOR PENETRATION
35mm at 1000m
SHELL WEIGHT
1.43kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
510kg


P00111
The Famous "French 75" saw considerable use by both sides in the Spanish Civil War. The mle 1897 75mm Field Gun was the famous Model 1897 field piece, the first gun with a modern recoil system and fast-acting breech block. It revolutionized field artillery, and became the most widely used field gun ever produced. At the start of WWII the French had some 4500 of these guns in their inventory. It was the standard light artillery piece in most French divisions, and was also used in the Maginot Line fortresses.

MAX RANGE
11,100m
SHELL WEIGHT
6.2kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1140kg


P00112
An archaic piece that was exported to the Republic and to the Basques. This gun was designed by L.A.Bishljakov, K.M.Sokolovski and K.I.Lipinski in the Putilov factory, Imperial Russia. It was based on 76 K 00 and it was influenced by the French 75 K 97. By the start of WWI the 76 K 02 was the primary field artillery piece in the Russian army. It was originally designed to fire direct-fire, but proved to be also good in indirect-fire. It's main drawback was that it didn't elevate enough and this led to many variations later on.

MAX Range
9,000m
SHELL WEIGHT
6.35kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1106kg


P00113
This is weapon was probably also suppolied to the the Spanish Republic. P obr. 02/30 76mm field guns were modernized pieces dating from the days of Tsar Nicholas II. A confusing array of more efficient propellants and projectiles were specified for the updated guns, which combined with the fact that some cases longer barrels were fitted as well led to the necessity of issuing four different range tables for one type of gun. Many 02/30s were still in service at the beginning of the war, a good number of them seeing service with the Germans as well.

MAX. RANGE
13,290m (L40)
SHELL WEIGHT
6.4kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1350kg (L/40)


P00114
This gun was utilized by both sides in the Spanish Civil War. The mle 13 S 105mm Field Gun was based on a Russian 107mm design. First produced in 1914, some 897 of these pieces were available in May 1940, used mainly as corps artillery.

MAX RANGE
12,000m
SHELL WEIGHT
15.7kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2300kg


P00115
This weapon is included to represent Italian weapons captured by the Republicans and subsequently used. The Cannone da 105/28 field howitzer was a license-built version of the French 105mm mle 1913 (also known as the L 13 S). It was used by the Italians primarily as corps artillery, and occasionally was employed at divisional level in place of the 100/17. In mid 1940 the Italians had 956 in service.

MAX. RANGE
12000m
SHELL WEIGHT
15.74kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2300kg


P00116
This gun was later provided to the Republic as heavy artillery support. P obr. 10/30 107mm field guns were a pre World War I design modernized in the early 1930s by fitting longer barrels on the existing horse drawn carriages. Many of these guns were still in service at the time of the German invasion, and saw service with their captives as well. These elderly pieces could fire 5-6 rounds/minute.

MAX. RANGE
16,350m
SHELL WEIGHT
17.18kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2380kg


P00117
This gun was probably supplied to the Republic in the later stages of the war. The G obr. 37 152mm Gun Howitzer was one of the most widely used Soviet artillery pieces of the war, and was perhaps the most important counter-battery weapon in their inventory. Two different carriages were specified: one with dual wheels for motorized transport, and one with spoked wheels for transport by horse. The crew of nine could bring the gun into battery in about 5 minutes, and fire three or four rounds/minute thereafter. Suitably modified, the Model 1937 was mated to the KV heavy tank chassis as the SU-152 assault gun, and the IS heavy tank chassis as the ISU-152. As an anti-tank gun, the 152-37 depended upon its shot weight rather than its velocity, but was highly effective. The Germans made good use of any 152-37s they could acquire.

MAX. RANGE
17,265m
SHELL WEIGHT
43.56kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
7128kg


P00118
This gun was inherited by both sides from vestiges of the Regular army and saw much use in early battles. Until supplemented by Russian equipment, this gun provided much of the Republics heavy fire support. The mle 17 S 155mm Howitzer C 17 S was originally designed as a 152mm howitzer for Czarist Russia. Adopted for use by France during WWI, over 1800 pieces were still in service in May 1940. French infantry divisions were authorized a regiment consisting of two twelve-gun groupes. Most C 17 S were horse-drawn.

MAX RANGE
11,300m
SHELL WEIGHT
43.6kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
3300kg


P00119
This piece saw frequent use by both sides as field artillery, especially in the early conflicts for the Guadarrama mountains. The mle 28 75mm Mountain Gun was designed as a replacement for the mle 06 65mm mountain gun.


MAX RANGE
9000m
SHELL WEIGHT
7.25kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
660kg


P00120
This gun represents a probable acquisition for the Republic before the arrival of Soviet supplies. The supplies provided to the Republic by the Soviet Union included a number of AA guns intended to the defence of Madrid. These guns continued to be shipped until a choke hold was placed of Russian shipments.

MAX EFFECTIVE CEILING
5600m
SHELL WEIGHT
0.9kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2654kg


P00121
The supplies provided to the Republic by the Soviet Union included a number of AA guns. These guns continued to be shipped until a choke hold was placed on Russian shipments. The ZP obr. 38 76.2mm anti-aircraft gun was an updated version of a Vickers based Soviet design of 1931. Many of the earlier gun's virtues were retained, such as sturdiness and reliability, but improvements in the commander's controls and the addition of a second axle to the carriage increased the Model 1938's effectiveness. Many of these guns captured by the Germans were rebored to take 88mm rounds.

MAX. EFFECTIVE CEILING
9300m
SHELL WEIGHT
6.61kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
3047kg


P00122
These naval guns represent the secondary armament of the Republican battleship Jaime I, the secondary armament of cruisers of the Cervera class, and the primary armament of destroyers of the Alsedo class of the Republican Navy. These vessels were sometimes used for shore bombardment. 


P00123
These naval guns represent the primary armament of the Republican Churruca class destroyers. These vessels were sometimes used for shore bombardment.


P00124
These naval guns represent the primary armament of the Republican Cervera and Mendez Nunez class cruisers. These vessels were sometimes used for shore bombardment.


P00125
These naval guns represent the primary armament of the Republican battleship Jaime I. Jaime I was sometimes used for shore bombardment.


P00201
The militias were composed of  union members, local communist and anarchists and other anti-facist or pro-republican civilians. These men were very brave and highly motivated, but were often not well armed and only rarely had any military training or experience. The primary fighting force for the Republic in the early war, the militias were largely ineffective and unable to stop the advance of the Army of Africa (exception: Battle of Madrid), though, at a high cost to themselves, they did attrition the Army of Africa's best units and bought some time for a popular army to be trained. Later in the war, militia units not assimilated into the Popular Army could be found acting as guerillas behind Nationalist lines.


P00202
The Carabineros were another pre-civil war paramilitary force. They were primarily a border police force. Like most of the other paramilitary forces proved to be very good soldiers. 


P00203
The Guardia Asaltos (Assault Guards) were a paramilitary urban police force, similar to the Guardia Civil, whose loyalties mostly lay with the Republic and were relied on to be a force loyal to the government should there be an insurrection. Not as numerous as the Guardia Civil, the Asaltos formed the best Republican troops of the early war and played a key factor in suppressing army units attempting to rise in certain cities, thus keeping these areas loyal to the Republic. Though a majority of Guardia Civil did declare for the Republic, the fact that so many didn't kept the Republic suspicious of them and they were often dispersed to militia units, which prevented their being utilized to their best capabilities. Asaltos personnel were drawn from ex-Army of Africa and Foreign Legion and were considered better trained and equipped for street fighting than army conscripts.


P00204
The Guardia Asaltos (Assault Guards) were a paramilitary urban police force, similar to the Guardia Civil, whose loyalties mostly lay with the Republic and were relied on to be a force loyal to the government should there be an insurrection. Not as numerous as the Guardia Civil, the Asaltos formed the best Republican troops of the early war and played a key factor in suppressing army units attempting to rise in certain cities, thus keeping these areas loyal to the Republic. Though a majority of Guardia Civil did declare for the Republic, the fact that so many didn't kept the Republic suspicious of them and they were often dispersed to militia units, which prevented their being utilized to their best capabilities. Asaltos personnel were drawn from ex-Army of Africa and Foreign Legion and were considered better trained and equipped for street fighting than army conscripts.


P00205
Loyalist regular army units could be found in the early stages of the war still in formation, though they were bled from desertion either to the Nationalists, or to Militia bands representing their local community and eventually were disbanded. Later these units represent Republican units with more than average military experience.


P00206
One of the major participants in the wartime Republican coalition was the Spanish Communist Party and when the regular army revolted, Stalin decided that a communist defence in Spain would bolster the communist image worldwide. Not willing to risk the provocation of using Soviet troops, he ordered the Comintern to recruit and send volunteers from all over the world to fight in Spain. These volunteers were highly motivated, though they were often young and training was often very uneven. Most were communists, some later became communists, others were adventurers or anti-facists. They were initially organized along roughly national lines and arrived just in time to take part in the crucial battles for Madrid. Since they were communist organized, they tended to have better material support than other units (Russia had become the principal supplier of aid to Republican Spain.). The International Brigades took heavy casualties in the battle to save Madrid, but their timely arrival helped save the Republic. Later, many of the brigades had their men transferred to other Spanish units to impart training and battle sense to the undisciplined Spaniards. And as Spanish replacements filtered in, the International Brigades became international in name only. Brigade volunteers came from all over Europe, the Americas and even Asia. Some rare units actually contained a high number of W.W.I. veterans. The German anti-facist Edgar Andre battalion was among the best. Other units of note are the Italian Garibaldi's, who ended up fighting Mussolini's Italians at Guadalajara, Franco-Belgian Andre Marty Battalion which fought to the last before being wiped out, the British Saklatvala, which lost one third of its men defending Suicide Hill, the American Abraham Lincoln Battalion, the Canadian Mackenzie-Papineau, and Polish-Hungarian Dabrowsky.


P00207
As a proper training process began to be implemented and take effect, the Republic was at last able to field a regular army. However, except for certain elite communist units, material shortages were always endemic. As Russian training methods became more pronounced over time, the regular use of commissars became an almost standard feature, as with the International Brigades. The later Republican army showed a remarkable ability to take a heavy pounding and still maintain unit integrity, though these units were often severely reduced as to combat worthiness.


P00208
As a proper training process began to be implemented and take effect, the Republic was at last able to field a regular army. However, except for certain elite communist units, material shortages were always endemic. As Russian training methods became more pronounced over time, the regular use of commissars became an almost standard feature, as with the International Brigades. The later Republican army showed a remarkable ability to take a heavy pounding and still maintain unit integrity, though these units were often severely reduced as to combat worthiness. Cavalry units were formed in the new Popular Army. The Republic was never strong in Cavalry, however, and such units would have been rather rare.


P00209
This unit represents a platoon of the Basque Army. These men bravely attempted to defend the Basque region and perhaps establish a separate Basque state. Because the Basques were largely nationalists, they were held in suspicion by the Communist dominated Madrid. This combined with the fact that the Basque region was quickly separated from the rest of the Spanish republic meant that these brave but ill-equipped and ill-trained men were committed to a doomed cause.

 
P00210
The dinaminteros were Asturian miners who were experts with the use of dynamite from their jobs. They were men and boys who entered battle armed with dynamite and often little else. Because Asturia was largely Republican in sympathy, great numbers of these miners flocked to the Loyalist cause. Accounts relate them being able to approach a machine gun nest in a building from the building's blind side, drill mounting holes for the dynamite and figure the charge to just the right amount to blow up the entire building and leave those alongside untouched. Also, they were able to trim fuses so expertly that they could toss dynamite like a grenade so that it would explode on impact, without the receiving troops having even a chance of throwing it back.


P00211
This unit represents an Engineer platoon.


P00212
This unit represents a machinegun platoon equipped with pre-war Spanish Maxim machineguns.


P00213
This unit represents a machinegun platoon equipped with Soviet Supplied Maxim machineguns.


 
P00214
This unit represents a groups of pro-Republican partisans. Many such groups operated behind Nationalist lines throughout the Civil War Period. Units could be cut-off Republican army units, or militia units. Partisans were still active until the 1960's in Spain.


P00215
This unit represents anti-tank rifles supplied to Republican troops by the Soviet Union. 


P00301
This unit represents a Division HQ. Many Spanish Republican forces were rather ad hoc, and this included the headquarters units. Communication would have been generally poor, especially amongst the Republicans who had few officers trained for proper HQ functions.


P00302
This unit represents a Brigade HQ. Many Spanish Republican forces were rather ad hoc, and this included the headquarters units. Communication would have been generally poor, especially amongst the Republicans who had few officers trained for proper HQ functions.


P00303
This unit represents a regiment HQ. Many Spanish Republican forces were rather ad hoc, and this included the headquarters units. Communication would have been generally poor, especially amongst the Republicans who had few officers trained for proper HQ functions.


P00304
This unit represents a battalion HQ. Many Spanish Republican forces were rather ad hoc, and this included the headquarters units. Communication would have been generally poor, especially amongst the Republicans who had few officers trained for proper HQ functions.


P00305
This unit represents a battalion HQ. Many Spanish Republican forces were rather ad hoc, and this included the headquarters units. Communication would have been generally poor, especially amongst the Republicans who had few officers trained for proper HQ functions.


P00306
This unit represents a Corps HQ. Many Spanish Republican forces were rather ad hoc, and this included the headquarters units. Communication would have been generally poor, especially amongst the Republicans who had few officers trained for proper HQ functions.


P00307
This unit represents a Army HQ. Many Spanish Republican forces were rather ad hoc, and this included the headquarters units. Communication would have been generally poor, especially amongst the Republicans who had few officers trained for proper HQ functions.


P00401
In many ways the Spanish Republic suffered fram a lack of effective military leadership. Most of the professional officers went over to the Nationalist. Considering the highly political nature of many of the Republican military formations, officers were often chosen for political skill or reliability and not for military skill or experience. Spain did not take part in WWI and Spanish officers still believed in leading from the front and setting an example for their men. The Spanish officers were undoubtable brave, but this led to a rather high mortality rate, which did not help the experience problem. Considering the amazing durability of the Republican armies during the conflict however, effective leadership must have been available. This is a real tribute to the officers of the Spanish Republic.


P00402
In many ways the Spanish Republic suffered fram a lack of effective military leadership. Most of the professional officers went over to the Nationalist. Considering the highly political nature of many of the Republican military formations, officers were often chosen for political skill or reliability and not for military skill or experience. Spain did not take part in WWI and Spanish officers still believed in leading from the front and setting an example for their men. The Spanish officers were undoubtable brave, but this led to a rather high mortality rate, which did not help the experience problem. Considering the amazing durability of the Republican armies during the conflict however, effective leadership must have been available. This is a real tribute to the officers of the Spanish Republic.


P00403
In many ways the Spanish Republic suffered fram a lack of effective military leadership. Most of the professional officers went over to the Nationalist. Considering the highly political nature of many of the Republican military formations, officers were often chosen for political skill or reliability and not for military skill or experience. Spain did not take part in WWI and Spanish officers still believed in leading from the front and setting an example for their men. The Spanish officers were undoubtable brave, but this led to a rather high mortality rate, which did not help the experience problem. Considering the amazing durability of the Republican armies during the conflict however, effective leadership must have been available. This is a real tribute to the officers of the Spanish Republic.


P00404
In many ways the Spanish Republic suffered fram a lack of effective military leadership. Most of the professional officers went over to the Nationalist. Considering the highly political nature of many of the Republican military formations, officers were often chosen for political skill or reliability and not for military skill or experience. History has always shown this to be disasterous. Spain did not take part in WWI and Spanish officers still believed in leading from the front and setting an example for their men. The Spanish officers were undoubtable brave, but this led to a rather high mortality rate, which did not help the experience problem. Considering the amazing durability of the Republican armies during the conflict however, effective leadership must have been available. This is a real tribute to the officers of the Spanish Republic.


P00405
In many ways the Spanish Republic suffered fram a lack of effective military leadership. Most of the professional officers went over to the Nationalist. Considering the highly political nature of many of the Republican military formations, officers were often chosen for political skill or reliability and not for military skill or experience. History has always shown this to be disasterous. Spain did not take part in WWI and Spanish officers still believed in leading from the front and setting an example for their men. The Spanish officers were undoubtable brave, but this led to a rather high mortality rate, which did not help the experience problem. Considering the amazing durability of the Republican armies during the conflict however, effective leadership must have been available. This is a real tribute to the officers of the Spanish Republic.


P00406
In many ways the Spanish Republic suffered fram a lack of effective military leadership. Most of the professional officers went over to the Nationalist. Considering the highly political nature of many of the Republican military formations, officers were often chosen for political skill or reliability and not for military skill or experience. History has always shown this to be disasterous. Spain did not take part in WWI and Spanish officers still believed in leading from the front and setting an example for their men. The Spanish officers were undoubtable brave, but this led to a rather high mortality rate, which did not help the experience problem. Considering the amazing durability of the Republican armies during the conflict however, effective leadership must have been available. This is a real tribute to the officers of the Spanish Republic.


P00407
In many ways the Spanish Republic suffered fram a lack of effective military leadership. Most of the professional officers went over to the Nationalist. Considering the highly political nature of many of the Republican military formations, officers were often chosen for political skill or reliability and not for military skill or experience. History has always shown this to be disasterous. Spain did not take part in WWI and Spanish officers still believed in leading from the front and setting an example for their men. The Spanish officers were undoubtable brave, but this led to a rather high mortality rate, which did not help the experience problem. Considering the amazing durability of the Republican armies during the conflict however, effective leadership must have been available. This is a real tribute to the officers of the Spanish Republic.


P00408
In many ways the Spanish Republic suffered fram a lack of effective military leadership. Most of the professional officers went over to the Nationalist. Considering the highly political nature of many of the Republican military formations, officers were often chosen for political skill or reliability and not for military skill or experience. History has always shown this to be disasterous. Spain did not take part in WWI and Spanish officers still believed in leading from the front and setting an example for their men. The Spanish officers were undoubtable brave, but this led to a rather high mortality rate, which did not help the experience problem. Considering the amazing durability of the Republican armies during the conflict however, effective leadership must have been available. This is a real tribute to the officers of the Spanish Republic.


P00409
In many ways the Spanish Republic suffered fram a lack of effective military leadership. Most of the professional officers went over to the Nationalist. Considering the highly political nature of many of the Republican military formations, officers were often chosen for political skill or reliability and not for military skill or experience. History has always shown this to be disasterous. Spain did not take part in WWI and Spanish officers still believed in leading from the front and setting an example for their men. The Spanish officers were undoubtable brave, but this led to a rather high mortality rate, which did not help the experience problem. Considering the amazing durability of the Republican armies during the conflict however, effective leadership must have been available. This is a real tribute to the officers of the Spanish Republic.


P00410
In many ways the Spanish Republic suffered fram a lack of effective military leadership. Most of the professional officers went over to the Nationalist. Considering the highly political nature of many of the Republican military formations, officers were often chosen for political skill or reliability and not for military skill or experience. History has always shown this to be disasterous. Spain did not take part in WWI and Spanish officers still believed in leading from the front and setting an example for their men. The Spanish officers were undoubtable brave, but this led to a rather high mortality rate, which did not help the experience problem. Considering the amazing durability of the Republican armies during the conflict however, effective leadership must have been available. This is a real tribute to the officers of the Spanish Republic.


P00411
Once Russian advisors and aid began to take a paramount role in the Republican effort, and the Communist Party came to dominate the Republican war effort Commissars were actively used. The commissar was a political indoctrination and training officer who co-commanded with the actual unit commander. One was concerned with the military function of the unit, the other, the political reliability of the troops and commander. The Commissar has moral modifiers but no combat modifiers.


P00412
Once Russian advisors and aid began to take a paramount role in the Republican effort, and the Communist Party came to dominate the Republican war effort Commissars were actively used. The commissar was a political indoctrination and training officer who co-commanded with the actual unit commander. One was concerned with the military function of the unit, the other, the political reliability of the troops and commander. The Commissar has moral modifiers but no combat modifiers.


P00413
Represent priests serving with the Basque troops on the Republican side. The Basque troops were not as political a force as the rest of the Republican forces and fought for nationalist reasons. The strong sense of religion in the Basque regions led to the use of Priests as front-line moral modifiers.


P00501 
The Polikarpov I-16 was one of the major types supplied by the Soviet Union. It was a very capable aircraft for its time and was a match for the early model ME-109s.  278 flew for the Republic. 


P00502
A small number of Potez 25 aircraft were used as light bombers and recon assests by the Northern and Basque forces. This unit can also be used to represent the many relatively low performance aircraft used by the Republican airforce.  50 flew for the Republic. 

P00503
The Polikarpov I-15 formed the backbone of Republican fighter forces. This was for its time a very effective aircraft, superior to the Heinkel 51 and equal to the Fiat CR-32. When ME-109s began to appear, however, the I-15 was outclassed.
155 were imported and 287 built under licence.


P00504  
The I-152 , Super Chato, biplane fighter, a development of the I-15 with a straight upper wing and a more powerful engine. Armed with 4 7.62mm Machineguns and could carry a 100KG bomb. 2408 were built. Despite a significant increase in power, performance in the I-152 was disappointing, this in part due to the increased drag imparted by the cabane-strut wing arrangement. The I-152 saw limited combat in Spain (as the 'Super Chato'), and an entire Regiment piloted by Soviet aviators flew in Chinese service during the winter of 1937-38 while resisting the Japanese invasion. Though production of the I-152 came to halt during 1938, the type soldiered on in the light attack role well into the first year of the Patriotic War. 30 flew late in the war.


P00505 
Breguet Br. XIX A2 the mainstay of the pre-war Spanish light bomber and reconaissance force. At the outbreak of hostilities most of the 60 Breguet XIX recon bombers went to the Republicans.


P00506
The SB-2 (Skorostnoi Bombardirovschik, high speed bomber) , was a revolutionary aircraft with clean aerodynamic lines which, together with its powerful engines, gave it a top speed of 430 km./h. The first conflict that the SB-2 participated in was the Spanish Civil War. They were first deployed in Spain on October of 1936. Early in the conflict they were of considerable concern to Nationalist forces. They were affectionately known as the Katusha (a character in a musical at the time) to Republican forces. It continued to perform well until 1938, when it was faced with more advanced fighter opposition in the form of the Bf 109. 


P00507 
The R-Z was a ground attack version of the R-5 ,  with a new and deeper fuselage and a semi-enclosed cockpit. 1031 were built from 1935 to 1937.  62 R-Z saw combat in Spain after January 1937.   

P00508 
License-built in Spain, the Nieuport-Delage NiD 52 was the mainstay of the pre-war Spanish fighter force. The serving aircraft at the outbreak of hostilities divided between the two sides 60 going to the Republic.  A total of 133 flew with the Republic. 


P00509 
This medium bomber. first flew in 1934 and the Republic had a squadron of them in the early war.  Slow moving but with a high service ceiling it could carry a  3,000lb. bombload. One squdron flew for the Republic early in the Civil War.


P00511 
In 1936 the Spanish Republic bought aircraft, including 49 Potez Po.54 medium bombers. The writer Andr Malraux raised money and bought a squadron of Potez Po.54 bombers to form the Escuadrilla Espana. Slow moving, often with inexpeiced pilots and often used in low level attacks these bombers suffered heavy losses.  They were replaced by Russian bombers in late 1937 and used in secondary roles.  50 flew for the Republic. 


P01001
The PzKpfw IB was the first and the smallest of Germany's mass-produced tanks. Production started in 1934, and by 1937 it had already seen combat in the Spanish Civil War. Though intended as a training vehicle, having only a two-man crew and a negligible anti-tank capability, it was pressed into service when Poland was invaded in 1939 due to a general shortage of tanks, and was still in widespread use during the invasion of France in 1940. By the time Germany attacked the USSR, however, only 74 were still being used in the panzer regiments. A small number were converted in 1940 to self-propelled infantry and anti-tank guns. A total of 1493 (Models A and B) were built. "PzKpfw" stands for "Panzer-Kampfwagen" (Armored Battle Vehicle).

ARMAMENT
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
13mm
WEIGHT
5.8 tonnes

P01077
The PzKpfw II was another of Germany's pre-war light tanks pressed into battle due to the lack of more modern vehicles. It fought as a main battle tank during the invasion of Poland, but due to its small gun and thin armor it was afterwards relegated to a reconnaissance role in tank companies and battalions. The A model was the initial production version, appearing in mid 1937. It was followed by the B and C models, which differed from the A in minor details only. 1113 of these three types were built. They were used as main battle tanks in Poland, after which most were uparmored (these are represented by the Pz IIF in the game) and shifted to a reconnaissance role in tank companies and battalions.

ARMAMENT
1 x 20mm cannon
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
16mm
WEIGHT
8.9 tonnes

P01002
The PzKpfw II was another of Germany's pre-war light tanks pressed into battle due to the lack of more modern vehicles. It fought as a main battle tank during the invasion of Poland, but due to its small gun and thin armor it was afterwards relegated to a reconnaissance role in tank companies and battalions. The IIF model was the 1941-42 production version, with thicker front armor than its predecessors. 1780 Pz II tanks were built, of which 524 were the IIF. Beginning in 1942 the Pz II was gradually phased out of service and, like most other pre-war tanks, was rebuilt to carry field guns and anti-tank weapons.

ARMAMENT
1 x 20mm cannon
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
35mm
WEIGHT
9.5 tonnes

P01004
The PzKpfw IIL "Lynx" was a light tank whose primary role was as a fast recon vehicle. It featured an extensively reworked Pz II chassis with all new running gear to give it excellent cross-country performance. Out of an original order for 800, only about 100 were built, with production starting in 1943. All Pz IIL were issued to the armored recon battalions of certain panzer divisions.

ARMAMENT
1 x 20mm cannon
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
30mm
WEIGHT
13 tonnes

P01005
The PzKpfw 35(t) was the German designation for the Czech LT vz 35 light tank produced in the mid '30s. When Germany invaded Czechoslovakia in 1939, 219 LT vz 35s were incorporated into German service. They served in the Polish and French campaigns, and were still in action with the 6th Panzer Division during the invasion of Russia in 1941, where during the subsequent winter it was found that the vehicle's pneumatic transmission was prone to freezing up. By the end of 1941 most had been lost.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm cannon
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
25mm
WEIGHT
10.5 tonnes

P01080
The PzKpfw 38(t)A was a Czech light tank (the LT vz 38) just going into production when Czechoslovakia was occupied in 1939. The Germans found it to be a rugged and reliable vehicle, and kept it in production for their own use. 150 of the initial model A were produced, followed by 325 of the Models B, C and D (which the A also represents in the game). Originally the tank had been designed to have a three-man crew, but the Germans added a fourth crewman to ease the work load of the vehicle commander. The Pz 38(t)A served as a main battle tank on all fronts except North Africa; and its rugged chassis would be utilized for many different kinds of armored vehicles throughout the war. This unit represents a three-tank platoon as used in 1939-40.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm cannon
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
25mm
WEIGHT
9.4 tonnes

P01006
The PzKpfw 38(t)A was a Czech light tank (the LT vz 38) just going into production when Czechoslovakia was occupied in 1939. The Germans found it to be a rugged and reliable vehicle, and kept it in production for their own use. 150 of the initial model were produced, followed by 325 of the Models B, C and D. Originally the tank had been designed to have a three-man crew, but the Germans added a fourth crewman to ease the work load of the vehicle commander. The PzKpfw 38(t) served as a main battle tank in the invasions of Poland, France and Russia; and its rugged chassis would be utilized for many different kinds of armored vehicles throughout the war. This unit represents a five-tank platoon as used after 1940.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm cannon
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
25mm
WEIGHT
9.4 tonnes

P01076
The PzKpfw 38(t)E was an uparmored version of its original predecessor the PzKpfw 38(t)A. The additional armor resulted in a heavier vehicle but did not impair its speed. In the game, this unit also represents the later (and equivalent) Models F and G. A total of 846 of these three types were built between late 1940 and mid 1942, when use of the 38(t) chassis was switched to the production of self-propelled anti-tank guns. At the start of the invasion of Russia, six of the seventeen panzer divisions participating in the attack were equipped with the PzKpfw 38(t).

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm cannon
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
50mm
WEIGHT
9.9 tonnes

P01007
The Aufklrer 38(t) was a light reconnaissance tank based on the rugged and dependable chassis of the Pz 38(t). In this case the superstructure was redesigned, and the original turret was replaced by that of the PSW 234/1 armored car. The intent was to continue providing armored reconnaissance units with a fully tracked recon vehicle after production of the PzKpfw IIL had ceased. 50 were built, all in early 1944.

ARMAMENT
1 x 20mm cannon
1 x 7.92 machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
50mm
WEIGHT
9.75 tonnes

P01078
The PzKpfw III was Germany's primary main battle tank through 1942. Limited production began in 1937, but at a slow pace as the vehicle underwent development. By early 1938 ten Model A, fifteen Model B and fifteen Model C had been built. Thirty Model D were then constructed. In the game the D represents all the early models as used in Poland. A few Pz IIIDs also participated in the Norwegian campaign. All were withdrawn from active duty during 1940.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm cannon
3 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
15mm
WEIGHT
16 tonnes

P01081
The PzKpfw III was Germany's primary main battle tank through 1942. Production began in 1937, but at a slow pace as the vehicle underwent development. With 435 built between September 1939 and July 1940, the F model was the first mass-production version (following 96 examples of the very similar Pz IIIE, which the IIIF also represents in the game). Even in 1940, however, its gun was seen as being too weak; and in 1941 it was hopelessly outclassed by the Russian T-34 and KV tanks. "PzKpfw" stands for "Panzer Kampfwagen" (Armored Battle Vehicle). This unit represents a three-tank platoon as used in 1939-40.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm cannon
3 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
30mm
WEIGHT
19.8 tonnes

P01008
The PzKpfw III was Germany's primary main battle tank through 1942. Production began in 1937, but at a slow pace as the vehicle underwent development. With 435 built between September 1939 and July 1940, the F model was the first mass-production version (following 96 examples of the very similar Pz IIIE, which the IIIF also represents in the game). Even in 1940, however, its gun was seen as being too weak; and in 1941 it was hopelessly outclassed by the Russian T-34 and KV tanks. "PzKpfw" stands for "Panzer Kampfwagen" (Armored Battle Vehicle). This unit represents a five-tank platoon as used after 1940.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm cannon
3 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
30mm
WEIGHT
19.8 tonnes

P01009
The PzKpfw IIIG was an uparmored and upgunned version of the Pz IIIF, with other minor improvements. The G model introduced the 50mm L/42 cannon, which was basically a lower-velocity version of the army's new PaK 38 50mm anti-tank gun. Unfortunately for the Germans, in 1941 both weapons were found to be inadequate vs. Russian T-34s and KVs. 600 Pz IIIG were built, with production ending in February 1941.

ARMAMENT
1 x 50mm L/42 cannon
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
37mm
WEIGHT
20.3 tonnes

P01010
The PzKpfw IIIH was based on the Pz IIIG, with extra armor plates bolted on to the front and rear of the hull. The drive train and running gear were also improved to increase reliability. The bolted-on armor was an expedient, inefficient method of increasing the tank's protection, and only 308 of the IIIH were built before the improved Model J appeared.

ARMAMENT
1 x 50mm L/42 cannon
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
30+30mm
WEIGHT
21.8 tonnes

P01011
The PzKpfw IIIJ was a significant improvement in the Pz III series. The armor thickness was decreased to 50mm but, being made of a single plate instead of two 30mm plates bolted together, its effectiveness was just as great with an overall reduction in the vehicle's weight as a bonus. Initially the IIIJ carried the same medium velocity 50mm L/42 gun as the IIIH, and 1549 of this type were built. (In the game these are represented by the IIIH.) The more powerful L/60 gun was then introduced, and 1067 of this version were produced. The new gun, a modified version of the towed 50mm anti-tank gun, gave the IIIJ considerably more hitting power but still not enough to deal satisfactorily with the Russian T-34s and KVs.

ARMAMENT
1 x 50mm L/60 cannon
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
50mm
WEIGHT
21.5 tonnes

P01067
The PzKpfw IIIL tank featured yet another increase in armor. This took the form of "spaced" armor added to the front of the vehicle in anticipation of the Allies' use of the new hollow-charge (HEAT) projectile which the Germans were already using. 653 of the Pz IIIL were produced, after which 250 of the PzKpfw IIIM were built, which differed from the IIIL only in having special modifications for deep wading.

ARMAMENT
1 x 50mm L/60 cannon
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
50+20mm
WEIGHT
22.7 tonnes

P01012
By mid 1942 the short-barreled 75mm L/24 gun of the Pz IV was being replaced by a longer and much more powerful weapon. The surplus L/24 guns were installed on the Pz IIIL, thus creating the PzKpfw IIIN. This gave the vehicle a better anti-personnel capability, and the 75mm gun's hollow-charge rounds increased its anti-tank effectiveness. The downside was that the gun's low muzzle velocity gave it a shorter effective range vs. enemy armor. 700 of the PzKpfw IIIN were produced.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm L/24 cannon
2 x 7.92 machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
70mm
WEIGHT
23 tonnes

P01013
The PzKpfw III(Fl) flamethrower tank was a medium tank outfitted with a flamethrower instead of a main gun. 100 of these tanks, based on the Pz IIIM chassis, were produced in early 1943. These vehicles shot a sticky black oil that had a range of 55-60 meters. They were very effective in removing stubborn pockets of resistance, but their drawback was the very limited range of the flamethrower.

ARMAMENT
1 x Flamethrower
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
50+30mm
WEIGHT
23 tonnes

P01014
The PzKpfw IV medium tank was designed in the mid '30s as a close-support vehicle for tank units. Its 75mm L/24 cannon was effective against soft targets, but its low velocity gave it a mediocre anti-tank capability. The Pz IVD and IVE were the two most common models at the start of the Russian campaign in 1941, at which time two four-tank platoons were included in the medium company of the panzer battalion. 229 of the Pz IVD were built, with production beginning in October 1939.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm L/24 cannon
2 z 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
35mm
WEIGHT
20 tonnes

P01015
The PzKpfw IVE was an uparmored version of the Pz IVD. The two types were in production simultaneously from September 1940 till April 1941, by which time 223 of the Pz IVE had been built. In the game, this unit also represents the Pz IVF, which featured single-plate 50mm armor instead of bolted-together 30mm plates. 462 of the Model F were produced.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm L/24 cannon
2 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
30+30mm
WEIGHT
21 tonnes

P01016
In response to the well armored T-34s and KVs of the Red Army, The Germans began designing a much more powerful gun for the Pz IV in late 1941. When it was ready, it was introduced during production of the Pz IVF, thus creating the PzKpfw IVF2. This changed the basic role of the Pz IV from support tank to main battle tank, with a gun more powerful than any then being carried in Allied tanks. Though still under-armored, the Pz IVF2 provided a great increase in the striking power of panzer formations. 200 of these tanks were produced. In the game, this unit also represents about half the production of its successor, the PzKpfw IVG.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm L/43 cannon
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
50mm
WEIGHT
23 tonnes

P01017
The PzKpfw IVH was the next evolutionary step in the development of the Pz IV series. It featured a substantial increase in the front armor and a longer, more powerful L/48main gun. The Model H was by far the most numerous of the series, with 3774 produced. In addition, this unit represents part of the production run of the Pz IVG with the new gun and increased armor, plus the 1758 PzKpfw IVJ that were built subsequent to the Pz IVH. Having been built from October 1937 through March 1945, the Pz IV was the only German tank to remain in production throughout the war, proving the soundness of its design.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm L/48 cannon
2-3 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
80mm
WEIGHT
25 tonnes

P01018
The appearance of the Russian T-34 tank had made all German tanks obsolete overnight, and a crash program was begun to give the panzer troops something better. The result two years later was the PzKpfw V "Panther", with a truly outstanding main gun and frontal armor that could defeat all but the most powerful Allied tank and anti-tank guns. It was big, complicated and expensive, and initially suffered serious reliability problems due to being rushed into combat, but on the battlefield it proved to be one of the best tanks of the war. During 1944-45 a panzer regiment was authorized one battalion of Panthers and one of Pz IVs.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm L/70 cannon
2-3 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
110mm
WEIGHT
43-45.5 tonnes

P01087
The Panther F was to have been the next version of the PzKpfw V to enter production. Thanks to its smaller turret, it was slightly lower and lighter than its predecessor the Panther G, and featured thicker turret armor, higher top speed and improved gun optics. None were ever produced, however, and the vehicle is included here only for use in "what if" scenarios.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm L/70 cannon
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
120mm
WEIGHT
45 tonnes

P01088
The Panther II was a concept vehicle intended to be designed and produced in conjunction with the PzKpfw VIB King Tiger, so that the two could share as many components as possible. The Panther II was to have thicker hull armor than the normal Panther and would carry the new, smaller and more heavily armored turret of the Panther F. No complete Panther IIs were ever built, and the Germans decided to concentrate on another design, the E-50, instead. The Panther II is included here only for use in "what if" scenarios.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm L/70 cannon
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
100mm
WEIGHT
55 tonnes

P01019
When first committed to large-scale combat at the end of 1942, the PzKpfw VIE "Tiger" was the heaviest and most powerfully armed production tank in the world. Contemporary Allied weapons were ineffective at all but point blank range against its stout armor, while its dreaded 88mm gun could destroy almost any enemy tank at maximum range. It quickly gained a fearsome reputation, and dominated the scene wherever it appeared until the advent of the Russian 122mm and 152mm guns. Tigers were usually allotted to independent heavy panzer battalions, though certain favored panzer divisions eventually had their own Tiger companies. 1354 PzKpfw VIE were built. Tiger crews were considered the creme de la creme of the panzer troops.

ARMAMENT
1 x 88mm L/56 cannon
2-3 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
110mm
WEIGHT
57 tonnes

P01020
The PzKpfw VIB King Tiger, also known as the Tiger II or Royal Tiger, was one of the ultimate tank designs of WWII. At 68 metric tons, it was the heaviest tank put into production by any nation during the war. Its great weight, slow speed and mechanical unreliability were serious disadvantages, and it was most effective as a defensive weapon. However, it carried an extremely powerful 88mm gun, and its massive frontal armor - the thickest of any WWII production tank - was all but impervious to Allied guns. 489 King Tigers were built between January 1944 and March 1945, and were issued to independent heavy tank battalions.

ARMAMENT
1 x 88mm L/71 cannon
2-3 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
180mm
WEIGHT
68 tonnes

P01089
The PzKpfw Maus ("Mouse") was designed by order of Hitler himself in 1942. The massive vehicle, which weighed 188 metric tons, carried 180-240mm of armor and mounted a 128mm cannon with a coaxial 75mm gun. It was propelled by electric motors that were powered by a generator driven by the tank's diesel engine. Two Maus prototypes were built in 1943-44. By 1945 they were still undergoing testing, but in the final days of the war they were thrown into combat against the advancing Soviets. One is preserved in a tank museum outside Moscow. This unit is included here only for use in "what if" scenarios.

ARMAMENT
1 x 128mm L/55 cannon
1 x 75mm L/36 cannon
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
240mm
WEIGHT
188 tonnes

P01021
The StuG IIIB assault gun was designed primarily as an infantry support vehicle. It was based on the PzKpfw III chassis, and like most other assault guns it had no turret. This made it more difficult to engage a fast-moving target or one on its flank, but turretless vehicles were faster and cheaper to build while their low silhouette made them harder to hit and easier to conceal. 320 of the B version were built. In the game this unit also represents the earlier A and the later C-E models. These StuGs were used in assault gun batteries and battalions. "StuG" stands for "Sturmgeschtz" (Assault Gun).

ARMAMENT
1 x 75 L/24 cannon
MAX. ARMOR
50mm
WEIGHT
20.2 tonnes

P01075
The StuG IIIG assault gun was based on previous versions of the PzKpfw III chassis. The original StuG III had been designed as an infantry support tank, but by 1943, StuGs were being used increasingly in an anti-tank role. This was made possible by the introduction of a longer barreled 75mm cannon and additional armor. The G model was the most common StuG built. Production started in late 1942 and continued through the end of the war, with some 7800 examples produced. In the game this unit also represents the earlier F and F/8 models, of which 359 and 354 were built respectively..

ARMAMENT
1 x 75 L/48 cannon
1 or 2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
80mm
WEIGHT
23.9 tonnes

P01022
The StuG IIIG assault gun was based on previous versions of the PzKpfw III chassis. The original StuG III had been designed as an infantry support tank, but by 1943, StuGs were being used increasingly in an anti-tank role. This was made possible by the introduction of a longer barreled 75mm cannon and additional armor. The G model was the most common StuG built. Production started in late 1942 and continued through the end of the war, with over 7000 examples produced. This unit represents the StuG IIIG in its anti-tank role.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75 L/48 cannon
1 or 2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
80mm
WEIGHT
23.9 tonnes

P01023
The StuH 42 assault gun was based on the StuG IIIG. The StuH was created in answer to requests from the front for a vehicle with more anti-personnel firepower than currently available with the 75mm cannon. The extra firepower was gained by installing a 105mm howitzer. Other than the bigger gun, the StuH was more or less identical to the StuG IIIG. Around 1200 units were constructed by the end of the war.

ARMAMENT
1 x 105mm gun
1 or 2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
80mm
WEIGHT
24 tonnes

P01025
The StuPz IV "Brummbr" (Grizzly Bear) assault gun was another effort at mounting a 150mm close-support weapon in a fully-tracked armored vehicle. By using the larger Pz IV chassis the StuPz could carry heavier armor and more ammunition. Production lasted almost two years from April 1943, with about 300 vehicles built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 150mm howitzer
1 x 7.92 machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
100mm
WEIGHT
28.2 tonnes

P01026
The PzJg I was the first German modification of a standard tank chassis to create a non-turreted tank destroyer. It paired an ex-Czech 47mm anti-tank gun with the chassis of a Pz I with its turret removed, in order to increase the mobility of the towed gun. The drawbacks to the arrangement were the vehicle's poor armor protection and its high silhouette which made it easier to spot. 202 were built from early 1940 through early 1941. "PzJg" stands for "Panzer-Jger" (Tank Hunter).

ARMAMENT
1 x 47mm cannon
MAX. ARMOR
14.5mm
WEIGHT
6.4 tonnes

P01027
The Marder II Tank Destroyer was based on the PzKpfw II chassis. The PzKpfw II as a tank was obsolete by this time and a new use for the vehicle was found by eliminating the turret and mounting a 75mm anti-tank gun in its place. This gave the vehicle quite a punch, but it suffered from a lack of heavy armor. In addition, the PaK 40 75mm anti-tank gun was a fairly large piece and the only way to mount it was to place it on top of the superstructure. This resulted in a relatively tall vehicle which was not easy to hide. In the game this unit also represents the early Marder III, 66 of which were shipped to the German forces in North Africa.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm L/46 cannon
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
30mm
WEIGHT
10.8 tonnes

P01028
The Marder III Tank Destroyer was based on the PzKpfw 38(t) chassis. At the time of its creation there was a serious need for a weapon capable of knocking out Russian tanks. Better armed German tanks were in the pipeline but still several months away. In the interim it was decided to marry the Pz-38(t) chassis with the PaK 40 75mm anti-tank gun. Ready for service by mid-1943, it was effective at killing tanks though seriously under-armored.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm L/46 cannon
MAX. ARMOR
20mm
WEIGHT
10.6 tonnes

P01029
The PzJg Tiger "Ferdinand" (later also called the "Elefant") was a heavy tank destroyer. Competition between Henschel and Porsche for the new heavy tank "Tiger" contract had resulted in an early order for 90 of the new Porsche tanks. After more testing it was decided that the Henschel was the better vehicle, so the Porsche contract was canceled. Then in early 1943 Hitler ordered that 90 Porsche Tiger hulls were to be built to carry an 88mm cannon. These were completed in time for use during the battle of Kursk. The Ferdinand has the distinction of being one of the most heavily armored vehicles ever to enter production, and was one of the few with tracks driven by electric motors.

ARMAMENT
1 x 88mm L/71 cannon
MAX. ARMOR
200mm
WEIGHT
65 tonnes

P01030
The PzJg III/IV Tank Destroyer "Nashorn" (Rhino) or "Hornisse" (Hornet) was based on extensively modified Pz III or Pz IV chassises. It was created in order to mount the excellent 88mm PaK43/1 anti-tank gun to an armored chassis. The 88mm cannon was well suited to the Russian steppes and was often able to kill targets up to 5km away. On the other hand the open crew compartment and poorly armored superstructure was a serious weak point in close fighting.

ARMAMENT
1 x 88mm L/71 cannon
1 z 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
30mm
WEIGHT
24 tonnes

P01031
The JgdPz 38(t) "Hetzer" (Troublemaker) was a light tank destroyer based on the Pz 38(t) tank. Though the tank itself was obsolete by 1942, its simplicity and proven reliability kept the basic chassis in production for a variety of self-propelled guns. For the Hetzer, a modified version of the Pz IV 75mm gun was mounted in the front superstructure, and the armor on all four sides of the vehicle was sloped as much as possible. Unlike the open-topped Marder II and III, the Hetzer was completely enclosed, and its well-sloped armor and low profile greatly enhanced its survivability. It was not especially popular with its crews, however, due to its extremely cramped interior. "JgdPz" stands for "Jagd-Panzer" (Hunting Panzer).

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm L/48 cannon
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
60mm
WEIGHT
15.7 tonnes

P01032
The JgdPz IV was a tank destroyer based on the PzKpfw IV chassis. It was intended as the replacement for the StuG assault gun in its anti-tank role. Its low height and sloped armor enhanced its survivability. With production occurring throughout 1944, 769 were produced. By late 1944 the JgdPz IV had been largely superseded by the JgdPz IV/70 with the more powerful gun of the Panther tank.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm L/48 cannon
1-2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
60mm
WEIGHT
25 tonnes

P01033
The JgdPz IV/70 was an upgunned version of the JgdPz IV tank destroyer which was based on the PzKpfw IV chassis. It was fitted with the same main gun used in the Panther tank, the 75mm L/70. When compared to the 75mm L/48, the L/70 was able to fire a 75mm shell at higher velocity which in turn, allowed the penetration of thicker armor over greater distances. The downside to this weapon was its very long barrel and its increased weight on an already overloaded Pz IV chassis. By late 1944 the panzerjger battalion of (SS-) panzer divisions was theoretically equipped entirely with these vehicles, but in reality only one or two of its companies actually had them.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm L/70 cannon
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
80mm
WEIGHT
26 tonnes

P01034
The JgdPz V "JagdPanther" (Hunting Panther) was a heavy tank destroyer based on the PzKpfw V "Panther" chassis. One of the best tank destroyers of the war, it combined the proven 88mm PaK 43 anti-tank gun with thick and well-sloped front armor. Like most other tank destroyers it had no turret, the main gun being mounted in the front superstructure. Its only major shortcomings were in its large size and the gun's limited traverse (the vehicle itself had to be aimed in the general direction of the target). By the time production stopped in March 1945, 392 had been produced.

ARMAMENT
1 x 88mm L/71 cannon
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
80mm
WEIGHT
46 tonnes

P01083
The Jagdtiger was based on the King Tiger chassis. In place of the latter's turret, however, it had a fixed superstructure mounting a 128mm high-velocity gun. With armor up to 250mm, and weighing some 70 metric tons, it was the heaviest and most heavily armed and armored production AFV of WWII. 77 were built, and were issued to schwere Panzerjgerabteilung 653 and schwere Panzerabteilung 512.

ARMAMENT
1 x 128mm cannon
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
250mm
WEIGHT
70 tonnes

P01035
The SPW 250/9 "Caesar" was a halftrack reconnaissance vehicle. It was an SPW 250 halftrack mounting a turret with a 20mm cannon, and was intended as the replacement for the SdKfz 222 armored car. The 250/9 was just what the German Army needed to combat the lack of roads on the Russian front. Though lightly armed and armored, it served as a recon vehicle on all fronts until the end of the war.

ARMAMENT
1 x 20mm cannon
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
14.5mm
WEIGHT
6 tonnes

P01036
The SPW 251/1 was the standard armored personnel carrier of the German Army. Designed primarily for transporting troops accompanying tanks in an advance, the 251/1 used a combination of wheels and tracks to give the vehicle fairly good cross-country performance. Each 251/1 could carry up to 13 men, and had mounts for its panzergrenadier squad's two light machineguns. This unit also represents the similar but smaller SPW 250/1, which was used in halftrack-equipped (SS-) panzer recon companies.

ARMAMENT
0-2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
14.5mm
WEIGHT
8 tonnes

P01037
The SPW 251/2 was an SPW 251 halftrack carrying with a GrW 34 81mm mortar that could be fired from the vehicle. A section of two was part of the heavy platoon in a halftrack-equipped (SS-) panzergrenadier company. This unit also represents the similar but smaller SPW 250/7, which was used in halftrack-equipped (SS-) panzer recon companies.

ARMAMENT
1 x 81mm mortar
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
14.5mm
WEIGHT
8 tonnes

P01038
The SPW 251/9 "Stummel" (Stump) was an SPW 251 halftrack fitted with a low-velocity 75mm cannon. It was used primarily for infantry support in the heavy companies of halftrack-equipped panzergrenadier formations. This unit also represents the similar but smaller SPW 250/8, which was used in halftrack-equipped (SS-) panzer recon companies.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm L/24 cannon
1 or 2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
14.5mm
WEIGHT
8.5 tonnes

P01039
The SPW 251/16 flamethrower halftrack was based on the SPW 251 armored personnel carrier. Instead of transporting infantry, the 251/16 carried two flamethrowers (flammenwerfer), one mounted on each side of the vehicle. The "flammenwerfer" was good for around 80 shots using 1 to 2 second bursts. With a maximum range of 35 meters, it was truly a "close support vehicle".

ARMAMENT
2 x flamethrowers
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
14.5mm
WEIGHT
8.6 tonnes

P01040
The SPW 251/22 anti-tank halftrack was based on the SPW 251 chassis. By late 1944 the role of the German Army had switched to the defensive. To combat the ever increasing numbers of tanks, any and all means were used to mount anti-tank guns. A complete(minus the wheels) PaK 40 anti-tank gun was mounted on the SPW 251 chassis, thus creating yet another version of this versatile halftrack.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm L/46 cannon
MAX. ARMOR
14.5mm
WEIGHT
9.5 tonnes

P01085
In late 1941, nine SdKfz 6 halftracks were converted to carry a captured Russian FK36 76m gun for use in a mobile anti-tank role. A box-shaped superstructure of 10mm armor plate replaced the passenger compartment of each halftrack, and the gun was mounted to fire over the vehicle's hood. All nine vehicles were shipped to the Afrikakorps in early 1942, where they were issued to Panzerjgerabteilung 605.

ARMAMENT
1 x 76mm L/51.5 cannon
MAX. ARMOR
10mm
WEIGHT
10.5 tonnes

P01082
The Kfz 13 was a 4x4 passenger car chassis with an open-topped armored body. Its armament consisted of a machinegun mounted on a pedestal behind the driver. 147 were built between 1932 and 1934. They were used in the reconnaissance units of non-motorized (primarily infantry) divisions. Most were withdrawn after the Polish campaign, but a few served on into 1940.

ARMAMENT
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
8mm
WEIGHT
2.1 tonnes

P01041
The PSW 221 was a light armored car designed in the mid 1930s. It was basically an armored body and turret mounted on a standard, four-wheel heavy passenger car chassis. Its role in the German Army was as a reconnaissance vehicle operating in conjunction with PSW 222 armored cars. Most were eventually replaced by more capable vehicles, though some managed to serve out the war. With production lasting for five years ending in 1940, approximately 340 were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
8mm
WEIGHT
4 tonnes

P01042
The PSW 222 armored car was based on the PSW 221. Designed as an reconnaissance vehicle, its main difference from the 221 was an increase in armament. In addition a more powerful motor was added along with many minor upgrades. In production from 1936-43, almost 1000 examples were constructed. They were issued to the armored car companies of reconnaissance battalions.

ARMAMENT
1 x 20mm cannon
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
8mm
WEIGHT
4.8 tonnes

P01079
The PSW 231 (6 rad) armored car was an armored reconnaissance vehicle built on a 6x4 truck chassis. It had two sets of driving controls - one in the front operated by the driver, and the other at the rear used by the radio operator. This allowed the car to be driven out of a dangerous situation quickly without having to turn around. Production started in 1932 and lasted until 1937, with 123 (including the PSW 232 variant with a long-range radio) built. They were issued to the reconnaissance units of motorized forces, but after service in Poland in France were withdrawn due to their limited off-road mobility.

ARMAMENT
1 x 20mm cannon
1 x 7.92 machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
8mm
WEIGHT
5.35-6 tonnes

P01043
The PSW 231 (8 rad) was an armored car designed for reconnaissance. Its 8-wheeled chassis, which featured all-wheel drive and steering, gave it excellent off-road performance. It had two sets of driving controls - one in the front operated by the driver, and the other at the rear used by the radio operator. This allowed the car to be driven out of a dangerous situation quickly without having to turn around. Production started in 1936 and lasted until 1943, with over 600 built. They were issued to the heavy platoon of armored car companies in motorized reconnaissance battalions.

ARMAMENT
1 x 20mm cannon
1 x 7.92 machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
18mm
WEIGHT
8.3 tonnes

P01044
The PSW 233 was based on the PSW 231 (8 rad) chassis. It featured a 75mm cannon mounted in an open topped, fixed position. It was created to give reconnaissance vehicles an ability to engage area targets and tanks. The low muzzle velocity of the cannon made tank killing a chancy operation. Produced from December 1942 through October 1943, a little over 100 were produced.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm L/24 cannon
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
30mm
WEIGHT
8.7 tonnes

P01045
The PSW 234/1 was an 8-wheeled armored car. A relatively late war vehicle, it was based on the Puma chassis. A new turret was installed that carried a 20mm cannon - capable of anti-aircraft fire - instead of the 50mm cannon found on the Puma. Like the other vehicles in the 234 series, it used a 12-cylinder diesel engine that gave it a respectable top speed and range. Between June 1944 and January 1945, around 200 were produced.

ARMAMENT
1 x 20mm cannon
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
30mm
WEIGHT
11.5 tonnes

P01046
The PSW 234/2 "Puma" was an 8-wheeled armored car carrying a 50mm L/60 cannon mounted in a fully enclosed turret. Like the other vehicles in the 234 series, it used a 12-cylinder diesel engine which provided a respectable top speed and range. Approximately 100 were built out of an initial order for 1500.

ARMAMENT
1 x 50mm L/60 cannon
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
30mm
WEIGHT
11.7 tonnes

P01047
The PSW 234/3 was an 8-wheeled armored car. Using the same chassis as the Puma, the turret was replaced with a 75mm cannon mounted in an open topped fixed position. Created to give other reconnaissance vehicles close support, it also had a limited tank killing ability. With under a hundred produced, relatively few of these vehicle saw service. Like the other vehicles in the 234 series, the 234/3 used a 12-cylinder diesel engine, which provided a respectable top speed and range.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm L/24 cannon
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
30mm
WEIGHT
11.5 tons

P01048
The PSW 234/4 was an 8-wheeled armored car. Using the same chassis as the Puma, the turret was replaced with the 75mm PaK 40 anti-tank gun mounted in an open-topped fixed position. With the PaK 40 cannon, the 234/4 was able to provide a fairly potent anti-tank presence for the other reconnaissance vehicles it was intended to support. Like the other vehicles in the 234 series, it used the robust Tatra diesel engine, which provided a respectable top speed and range.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm PaK 40 L/56 cannon
MAX. ARMOR
30mm
WEIGHT
11.5 tonnes

P01049
The sIG IB was a self-propelled howitzer on the PzKpfw I chassis. The sIG 33 150mm infantry gun (sans wheels) was simply attached to the turretless superstructure. To provide some protection for the crew (which had to stand on the engine deck), they and the gun were shielded on the front and sides by armor plate. With a tall profile and thin armor, the sIG IB was top-heavy and vulnerable to even anti-tank rifles. 38 were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 150mm infantry gun
MAX. ARMOR
13mm
WEIGHT
8.5 tonnes

P01084
The sIG II was a self-propelled howitzer on a widened and lengthened PzKpfw II chassis. The turret was removed and a low open-top superstructure mounted in its place to carry the sIG 33 150mm infantry gun. Twelve of these vehicles were built, and all were sent to the Afrikakorps in early 1942 where they equipped Heavy Infantry Gun Companies (SP) 707 and 708.

ARMAMENT
1 x 150mm infantry gun
MAX. ARMOR
30mm
WEIGHT
11.2 tonnes

P01050
The sIG 38(t) "Bison" was a self-propelled howitzer that used the PzKpfw 38(t) chassis to carry a 150mm infantry gun mounted in a thinly armored superstructure which replaced the original turret of the 38(t). Mounted on a chassis that was more appropriate for the weight of the infantry gun, the Bison proved to be a reliable weapons platform. It was limited by the relatively few rounds of ammo that it could carry and was still found to be lacking in armor. Production started in early 1943 and continued through late 1944, with close to 400 built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 150mm L/12 cannon
MAX. ARMOR
20mm
WEIGHT
12 tonnes

P01086
The PzA LrS was an early attempt at producing a self-propelled artillery piece on a captured vehicle. The French Tracteur Blind 37L (known to the Germans as the "Lorraine Schlepper") was the vehicle utilized, modified by the addition of an open-top compartment housing an sFH 13 150mm howitzer. 94 were converted in mid-1942, and were first issued to the 21st Panzer Division in North Africa. Others equipped panzer artillery units stationed in Western Europe.

ARMAMENT
1 x 150mm L/17 cannon
MAX. ARMOR
12mm
WEIGHT
8.5 tonnes

P01051
The PzA II "Wespe" (Wasp) was a self-propelled howitzer that mounted a 105mm field piece on the PzKpfw II chassis. One of the more successful self-propelled howitzers, the Wespe earned a good reputation from the crews that worked with it. Somewhat better armed then previous self-propelled vehicles, the Wespe still suffered from the open top that was common with this type of vehicle. With production starting in early 1943, over 600 were produced by late 1944.

ARMAMENT
1 x 105mm L/28 cannon
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
30mm
WEIGHT
11 tonnes

P01052
The PzA III/IV "Hummel" (Bumblebee) was a self-propelled howitzer mounting a 150mm field piece on an extensively modified PzKpfw IV chassis. Originally intended as a temporary solution for providing an armored, fully tracked chassis for artillery, it none the less proved to be a good design. The Hummel was introduced to combat at Kursk in 1943, and remained in service for the duration of the war. The artillery regiment of a panzer division generally contained one Hummel battery. A total of 319 were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 150mm L/30 cannon
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
30mm
WEIGHT
24 tonnes

P01068
The Panzerwerfer 42 "Maultier" (Mule) was a halftracked armored truck that had been modified to mount the 150mm Nebelwerfer, which fired a rocket propelled artillery shell. When fired the rockets emitted a great deal of smoke, which made them an easy target for counter-battery fire. Being mounted on a halftrack allowed the vehicle to move and scoot, thus permitting a good deal of protection. With production starting in April 1943, around 300 were produced by early 1944.

ARMAMENT
1 x 150mm Nebelwerfer 42
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
8mm
WEIGHT
7.1 tonnes

P01053
The FlaKPz 38(t) was an anti-aircraft tank developed in late 1943 as an interim solution to the lack of full-tracked AA vehicles. It carried a 20mm FlaK 38 on a modified Marder III Ausf M chassis. The single 20mm gun was lacking in firepower, but the vehicle was needed until more heavily armed AA tanks could be produced. Constructed from late 1943 until early 1944, around 140 were built. They were assigned to the AA platoons in panzer regiments.

ARMAMENT
1 x 20mm cannon
MAX. ARMOR
20mm
WEIGHT
9.8 tonnes

P01054
The FlaKPz IV "Mbelwagen" (Furniture Van) was an anti-aircraft tank based on the PzKpfw IV chassis. With Panzer units in dire need of protection from Allied air attacks, the Mbelwagen was developed to accompany them. With the gun crew perched on top of an open deck, absolutely no protection was given. Intended as a temporary solution, it ended up serving till the end of the war. Production started in early 1944 and lasted for one year with around 240 produced.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm L/60 cannon
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
80mm
WEIGHT
24 tonnes

P01055
The FlaKPz IV "Wirbelwind" (Whirlwind) was an anti-aircraft tank based on the PzKpfw IV chassis. It was designed to accompany Panzers on the battlefield so as to give some protection against Allied ground attack aircraft. Mounting four 20mm cannons in an octagonal, open-top turret, it provided an impressive amount of firepower; however, by late in the war 20mm shells weren't powerful enough to bring down Allied aircraft. On the other hand, it was a devastating weapon vs. ground troops. With production starting in mid 1944, less than 100 were produced by November 1944.

ARMAMENT
4 x 20mm cannon
1 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
80mm
WEIGHT
22 tonnes

P01056
The FlaKPz IV "Ostwind" (East Wind) was an anti-aircraft tank based on the PzKpfw IV chassis. It was similar to the Wirbelwind, which it was intended to replace, but carried the more powerful 37mm AA gun in a different turret. 43 were constructed.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm cannon
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
80mm
WEIGHT
25 tonnes

P01057
The SdKfz 10/4 was an anti-aircraft halftrack. It carried a single 20mm cannon which was mounted on the back of a Demag D7 halftrack. One of the first self-propelled anti-aircraft vehicles produced it was very poorly armored, and as the war progressed the 20mm cannon became obsolete. Between 1938 and 1944, a little over 600 were constructed.

ARMAMENT
1 x 20mm L/112.5 cannon
MAX. ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
5.5 tonnes

P01058
The SdKfz 6/2 was an anti-aircraft halftrack. It carried a single 37mm cannon which was mounted on the back of a Bssing-NAG BN9 halftrack. Intended to provided more firepower then what the SdKfz 10/4 was capable of , it suffered due to a complete lack of armor. With production starting in 1939, over 300 were produced by 1943 when production stopped.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm L/98
MAX. ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
10.4 tonnes

P01059
The SdKfz 7/1 was an anti-aircraft halftrack. Using the Zgkw 8t chassis, a flat platform was installed on the back of the vehicle, which permitted the mounting of the 20mm Flak 38. A much larger vehicle then the SdKfz 10/4, the 7/1 (like most anti-aircraft halftracks) still lacked any protection for the gun or crew. By late 1944, production ended with a little over 300 constructed.

ARMAMENT
4 x 20mm L/112.6 cannons
MAX. ARMOR
none
WEIGHT 11.5
tonnes

P01060
The FlaK LKW 20mm was an anti-aircraft truck. With the ever increasing need for air-defense vehicles, the German Army started mounting Flak weapons on the back of specially modified 4-wheeled trucks. These vehicles used a variety of chassis and had no armor for either the gun or crew. In addition, their cross-country performance was lacking.
ARMAMENT
1 x 20mm cannon
MAX. ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
4 tonnes

P01061
The FlaK LKW 37mm was an anti-aircraft truck. With the ever increasing need for air-defense vehicles, the German Army started mounting Flak weapons on the back of specially modified heavy 4 wheel drive trucks. Several chassis were used but for the most part the Bssing-NAG carried the heavier 37mm cannon. Like other AA trucks, the LKW had no armor for gun or crew.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm cannon
MAX. ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
7.5 tonnes

P01069
The Kbelwagen was a small passenger vehicle generally used for a variety of light duties. Most all military units had them and were mainly used by the commanding officers. Powered by a 998cc air-cooled engine, speed was not the Kbelwagen's strong point. In addition most early vehicles lacked 4-wheel drive though overall, they did earn a good reputation for reliability. Over 50,000 of these were produced during the course of the war and remained in production long after the war ended. In the game, the vehicle appears in its reconnaissance role.

ARMAMENT
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
1 tonne

P01062
Trucks were used for transporting troops and equipment. They consisted of many different brands and just as many different styles. Just before the war started they were over 100 different types of trucks being produced or used in Germany. In 1938 the Schell plan was implemented to reduce this to a more practical number. Though this helped a great deal, Germany always needed more trucks and consequently pressed into service everyone it could find. Generally most trucks had no armor or armament, which made them easy victims.


P01063
The RSO prime mover was intended as an artillery tractor. Experience on the East Front had shown that the SdKfz prime movers required too much maintenance. Hitler ordered that an inexpensive replacement be designed, and thus the Raupenschlepper-Ost (RSO) was born. Well suited for cross-country work, its top speed of around 10 mph was very slow. Despite its shortcomings, some 27,000 were built by the end of the war.

ARMAMENT
none
MAX. ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
3.5 tonnes

P01064
The SdKfz 7 prime mover was a light halftrack designed to move, mount or carry a wide variety of military equipment. Many varieties of prime movers were built and the SdKfz 7 represents the 3-ton model. Utilizing a halftrack chassis it initially had good off-road performance, but Russian mud and ice was able to bring out the shortcomings in this design. Somewhat complicated it required a good deal of maintenance to keep it in a reliable running condition.

ARMAMENT
none
MAX. ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
10 tonnes

P01065
The SdKfz 11 prime mover was a medium halftrack designed to move, mount or carry a wide variety of military equipment. Many varieties of prime movers were built and the SdKfz 11 represents the 8-tonne model. Utilizing a halftrack chassis it initially had good off-road performance, but Russian mud and ice was able to bring out the shortcomings in this design. Somewhat complicated it required a good deal of maintenance to keep it in a reliable running condition.

ARMAMENT
none
MAX. ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
6 tonnes

P01066
This unit represents a variable number of horses, wagons and/or artillery limbers used for transport. Throughout the war the vast majority of German divisions (i.e., the infantry-type divisions) relied almost entirely on horse-drawn transport. For example, a volksgrenadier division was authorized some 3000 horses but only 150 vehicles. The artillery in infantry and volksgrenadier divisions was entirely horse-drawn.


P01070
This unit represents a number of horses sufficient to carry a platoon of cavalrymen. A 1939 platoon had 45-50 horses.


P01071
Bicycles are one of the least demanding forms of transportation available to any army. Requiring neither fuel nor fodder, bicycles can move troops on improved roads about as fast as can be tactically prudent, and are easily discarded at no great loss in the event of prolonged engagement. They do, however, require reasonably well surfaced roads - something not as common in Russia as in western Europe during the 1940s.


P01072
This unit represents a variable number of motorcycles used for the transport of infantry. Comprising many different brands and types, they were used for a variety of purposes but could be found most often affiliated with some type of recon unit.


P01073
This unit represents a variable number of unarmed and unarmored powered boats used to transport infantry and equipment across water.


P01074
This unit represents a variable number of rafts used to transport infantry and equipment across water.


P01601
The Germans built or pressed into service many different kinds of barges to use as landing craft in their intended invasion of England. This unit represents a typical such barge, assumed to be carrying a 20mm gun for AA defense and having a ramp so that it can carry vehicles as well as infantry.


P01101
The GrW 34 81mm mortar was a smoothbore, muzzle loading, and portable weapon that allowed shells to be fired at a high angle of attack. Generally it was broken down into pieces and carried by the men that made up a mortar crew. In motorized outfits the mortars were carried in trucks, but in foot-infantry units they could be transported in wagons. The GrW 34 lacked the range of the U.S. 81mm mortar but fired a heavier shell.

MAX. RANGE
2200m
SHELL WEIGHT
3.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
56.7kg

P01102
The GrW 34 81mm mortar section represents two 81mm mortars. By 1944 a section was normally found in the heavy platoon of all infantry-type companies. The mortar was a smoothbore, muzzle loading, and portable weapon that allowed shells to be fired at a high angle of attack. Generally they were broken down into pieces and carried by their crew. In motorized units the mortars were carried in trucks, but in foot-infantry units they could be transported in wagons. The GrW 34 lacked the range of the U.S. 81mm mortar but fired a heavier shell.

MAX. RANGE
2200m
SHELL WEIGHT
3.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
56.7kg

P01103
The GrW 42 120mm mortar was basically a direct copy of the excellent Russian 120mm mortar. Due to its weight it could not be carried by its crew, so like its Soviet counterpart it came with a small two-wheeled trailer that allowed it to be towed by a vehicle. Generally four mortars could be found in the mortar platoon of the infantry battalion. 3510 were in service on October 1, 1944.

MAX. RANGE
6050m
SHELL WEIGHT
16kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
281kg

P01104
The leIG 18 75mm infantry gun was a light, low-velocity artillery piece designed to provide advancing troops with artillery support. Six were normally found in the infantry-gun company of the infantry regiment. Overall the weapon was light and very easy to conceal due to its small size. The 1eIG 18 was introduced into the army in the late 1920s and served throughout the war.

MAX. RANGE
3475m
SHELL WEIGHT
6kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
400kg

P01105
The sIG 33 150mm infantry gun was a low-velocity artillery piece designed to provide direct or indirect fire support for infantry. Two were normally found in the infantry-gun company of the infantry regiment. Almost three times heavier than its companion piece the 1eIG 18 75mm infantry gun, it was also more durable and effective. First introduced to the army in 1933, it served throughout the war. The sIG series of vehicles mounted this gun for use in armored formations.

MAX. RANGE
4700m
SHELL WEIGHT
38kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1680-1800kg

P01106
The sPzB 41 was a 28mm anti-tank weapon. Generally classified as a heavy anti-tank rifle it required a crew of two and needed to be broken down into several smaller pieces in order for it to be transported. A unique feature of this weapon was the tapered bore that the barrel used. It was pretty much obsolete by the time it entered service in 1941, as most all tanks were immune to the 20mm APCR shell it fired. Less then 200 of these weapons were produced.

ARMOR PENETRATION
66mm at 500m
SHELL WEIGHT
630 grams
WEIGHT IN ACTION
118kg

P01107
The PaK 35/36 37mm was the standard German anti-tank weapon at the beginning of the war. Proving adequate for the job when Poland was overrun, it was almost obsolete one year later when France was invaded. By the time the invasion of Russia started it had earned the nickname of "door knocker" as the shells simply bounced off of medium and heavy Russian tanks. It was a relatively light weapon that could be pushed around for short distances by its crew and due to its small size, it was easy to conceal.

ARMOR PENETRATION
50mm at 500m (APCR ammo)
SHELL WEIGHT
0.97kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
435kg

P01108
The lePaK 41 was a 42mm anti-tank weapon. It featured a "squeeze-bore" barrel that accepted a 42mm shell in the breech but tapered to a 29mm bore at the muzzle. The outer casing of the shell collapsed inward as it traveled down the barrel. This raised its muzzle velocity (and armor penetration) substantially, but at the expense of greatly increased barrel wear. Production was halted when the tungsten needed for its projectiles became in short supply.

ARMOR PENETRATION
87mm at 500m (APCR ammo)
SHELL WEIGHT
1.52kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
642kg

P01109
This unit represents an infantry Panzerjger ("Tank Hunter") platoon of three towed PaK 38 50mm anti-tank guns. The PaK 38 was developed in the late 1930s, and entered service in 1941. At the start of Operation Barbarossa a little over a thousand were available. Despite being some 200kg heavier than the 37mm anti-tank gun, the PaK 38 could still be manhandled by its crew. On the Eastern front it proved inadequate against the well-armored T-34 and KV tanks, and was replaced by 75mm guns as quickly as possible.

ARMOR PENETRATION
120mm at 500m (APCR ammo)
SHELL WEIGHT
2.73kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
986kg

P01110
The PaK 97/38 was a 75mm anti-tank gun based on the famous Model 1897 French field piece. In 1941, when the standard German anti-tank guns were found to be ineffective against the Russian T-34 and KV tanks, some 700 of these French gun barrels were adapted to the PaK 38 carriage, thus creating the PaK 97/38. They were rushed to the Eastern Front, where they served until replaced by the more powerful PaK 40 75mm anti-tank gun. Many were then put to use as artillery pieces.

ARMOR PENETRATION
75mm at 500m
SHELL WEIGHT
5.98kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1190kg

P01111
The PaK 40 was a 75mm anti-tank gun introduced at the start of 1942. Basically it was an enlarged version of the PaK 38 50mm gun. It proved to be a very successful design, and remained the standard divisional anti-tank gun for the remainder of the war. One drawback was its weight, which was too great to allow its crew to manhandle it. This made it difficult to change positions quickly to meet new enemy threats. The gun's usual towing vehicle was the SdKfz 11 halftrack or RSO prime mover.

ARMOR PENETRATION
154mm at 500m (APCR ammo)
SHELL WEIGHT
9.55kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1425kg

P01112
This unit represents an Anti-Tank Platoon of four PaK 43 88mm anti-tank guns. This weapon was essentially the same gun as mounted in the King Tiger tank, but on a four-wheeled platform towed by an SdKfz 7 unarmored halftrack. In action the wheels were removed, and the gun could be fired through a 360-degree arc. It was probably the finest anti-tank gun ever produced. The demand for it was so great that other versions (the PaK 43/41) were built using a normal artillery-type carriage. These guns were used in independent towed heavy panzerjger battalions, with four guns per platoon and three platoons per battalion.

ARMOR PENETRATION
274mm at 500m (APCR ammo)
SHELL WEIGHT
23kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
3700kg

P01113
The PaK 43/41 had the same barrel as the PaK 43, but mounted on a modified howitzer carriage. Demands from the front for more 88mm anti-tank guns necessitated this expediency, which negated most of the PaK 43's qualities (the new version was so big it was nicknamed the "barndoor") - though not its deadly ability to kill targets over 3000 meters away. These guns were used in independent towed heavy panzerjger battalions, with four guns per platoon and three platoons per battalion.

ARMOR PENETRATION
274mm at 500m (APCR ammo)
SHELL WEIGHT
23kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
4380kg

P01114
The K81/1 was a 128mm anti-tank weapon that saw very limited use during World War II. Originally intended for production as the PaK 44, the K81/1 was hastily created in the last months of the war by mounting the PaK 44 barrel on the carriage of the French GPF 155mm gun. Some barrels were mounted instead on captured Russian 152mm carriages.

ARMOR PENETRATION
230mm at 1000m
SHELL WEIGHT
28.3kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
12150kg

P01115
The leFK 16na was a 75mm field gun that was basically a modified version of the World War One era 77mm FK 16. In 1919 there were over 3000 77mm guns still in service in the German Army where they served as the basic divisional gun during the post war years. During the early 1930s it was decided to standardize the caliber of artillery pieces. The leFK 16na was created when the barrel of the 77mm gun was replaced with a new design utilizing a caliber of 75mm. Overall the gun was obsolete by 1940 standards, but it continued to be used by any and all formations that needed a light gun.

MAX. RANGE
12875m
SHELL WEIGHT
5.83kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1524kg

P01139
The PaK 97/38 field gun was the PaK 97/38 anti-tank gun used as a field artillery piece. It was often found in the artillery regiment of Luftwaffe field divisions.

MAX. RANGE
11000m
SHELL WEIGHT
5.98kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1190kg

P01116
The FK 40 75mm field gun was the PaK 40 anti-tank gun used in the field artillery role; a situation brought about by the chronic shortage of true field guns late in the war.

MAX. RANGE
7680m
SHELL WEIGHT
5.74kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1425kg

P01117
The leFH 18 105mm Howitzer was an artillery piece capable of direct or indirect fire. Originally entering service in 1935, it was to replace the older leFH 16. This was the most commonly used light field howitzer used by the German army. It was well praised for its ease of set-up, rate of fire, and reliability.

MAX. RANGE
10670m
SHELL WEIGHT
14.8kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1985kg

P01118
The leFH 18M 105mm Howitzer was an artillery piece capable of direct or indirect fire. Originally entering service in 1941, it was virtually identical to the leFH 18. The main difference being the addition of a muzzle brake, which increased performance about 18% when compared to the older leFH. It was well praised for its ease of setup, rate of fire, and reliability.

MAX. RANGE
12315m
SHELL WEIGHT
14.25kg (long-range shell)
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1985kg

P01119
The sK 18 105mm was the standard medium artillery gun. It used the same mount as the sFH 18, but supported a much longer barrel. Originally developed in the late 1920s it entered service in 1933. It was a large weapon for its caliber size, and difficult to operate off-road unless some type of mechanized assistance was available.

MAX. RANGE
19000m
SHELL WEIGHT
15.14kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
5642kg

P01120
The sFH 18 150mm Howitzer was an artillery piece capable of direct or indirect fire. It was introduced to the troops in the mid 1930s. Similar in design to the leFH 18, the sFH was quite a bit bigger and much heavier. Though an effective weapon, it was not well liked by its crew as it was very difficult to move in the mud and ice on the Russian front.

MAX. RANGE
13250m
SHELL WEIGHT
43.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
5512kg

P01121
The sFH 36 150mm Howitzer was an artillery piece capable of direct or indirect fire. The sFH 36 was a much improved version of the sFH 18, as it only weighed half as much which allowed it to be transported in one load. This reduction was accomplished by shortening the barrel by four feet and through the extensive use of alloys. Shortly after production began, it soon ended in 1942 due to a shortage of alloy materials In addition a muzzle brake was fitted which enhanced the performance of the gun, but not enough to make up for the shortened barrel.

MAX. RANGE
12300m
SHELL WEIGHT
43.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
3280kg

P01122
The K 18 150mm gun was a heavy artillery piece capable of direct or indirect fire. Design work started on this piece in 1933 and was accepted into service by 1938. Originally intended as a replacement for the World War One era, 150mm K 16, performance was only marginally better. In addition, transportation and set-up was a tedious and drawn-out operation.

MAX. RANGE
24500m
SHELL WEIGHT
43kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
12760kg

P01123
The K 18 170mm gun was a heavy artillery piece capable of direct or indirect fire. Entering service in 1941 it soon became the backbone of the German heavy artillery. Designed by Krupp, the weapon was noted for its stability and ease of operation, and for the most part, replaced the K 18 150mm heavy artillery gun.

MAX. RANGE
29600m
SHELL WEIGHT
68kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
17520kg

P01124
The LG 40 75mm recoilless gun was an artillery piece that had been specially engineered for light weight so that it could be parachuted with airborne forces. The low weight was achieved by eliminating the recoil mechanism and through the use of light alloys. The first of this type to enter production, it was unique in that the recoil mechanism was no longer needed because the propellant gases were emitted to the rear of the unit. The gases were directed through a venturi attached to the rear of the barrel, which made it dangerous to stand behind, when it was fired.

MAX. RANGE
6800m
SHELL WEIGHT
5.83kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
145kg

P01125
The LG 42 105 recoilless gun was an artillery piece that had been specially engineered for light weight so that it could be parachuted with airborne forces or carried by pack. The low weight was achieved by eliminating the recoil mechanism. The recoil mechanism was no longer needed because the propellant gases were emitted to the rear of the unit. The gases were directed through a venturi attached to the end of the barrel, which made it dangerous to stand behind, when it was fired. This weapon also saw service with mountains units. More then 3 times heavier then the LG 40 75mm, the LG 42 was almost 1400kg lighter then the leFH 18 105mm Field Howitzer.

MAX. RANGE
3400m
SHELL WEIGHT
14.8kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
540kg

P01126
The GebG 36 75mm mountain gun was the standard light mountain howitzer. First entering service in 1938, it had been designed so that it could be easily broken down into 11 loads (none of which weighed more then 114kg) so that mules could carry the weapon on narrow mountain passes. Overall the GebG 36 was well liked by its crew and the weapon served until the end of the war. Another 75mm gun used by German mountain troops was a specially modified version of the leIG 18 75mm infantry gun.

MAX. RANGE
9200m
SHELL WEIGHT
5.75kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
750kg

P01138
The GebH 16 100mm mountain howitzer was an old Czech gun used by the Germans to fill the gap caused by the absence of any domestically produced model in the 1930s. It was large and heavy, but quite serviceable despite its age.

MAX. RANGE
9280m
SHELL WEIGHT
13.4kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1235kg

P01127
The GebH 40 105mm mountain howitzer was introduced later in the war. Designed so that it could be easily broken down into 9 loads (none of which weighed more then 250kg) so that mules could carry the weapon on narrow mountain passes. The barrel, which was equipped with a muzzle brake, was attached to a split-trail carriage that was supported by two light alloy wheels. Considered by many to be the best mountain gun ever built, it remained in service with many countries long after the war was over.

MAX. RANGE
16740m
SHELL WEIGHT
14.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1663kg

P01129
NbW 41 150mm Nebelwerfer (Smoke Projector) rocket launcher was an artillery piece that fired rockets instead of the traditional artillery shells. With no recoil to absorb, the Nebelwerfer could be produced for one-third the cost and in one-half the time that it took for a comparable artillery piece. The NbW 41 was a six-barreled launcher that was mounted to a light two-wheeled trailer. Generally all six rockets could be fired virtually simultaneously, thus creating quite an impact at the receiving end. The rocket shells were initially used for laying smoke, but could also fire HE shells.

MAX. RANGE
6900m
ROCKET WEIGHT
34.15kg

P01136
NbW 42 210mm Nebelwerfer (Smoke Projector) rocket launcher was an artillery piece that fired rockets instead of the traditional artillery shells. With no recoil to absorb, the Nebelwerfer could be produced for one-third the cost and in half the time it took for a comparable artillery piece. The NbW 42 was a five-barreled launcher based on the NbW 41. It fired a shell that was three times heavier than, and carried four times the explosive charge of, the NbW 41. Mounted to a small two-wheeled trailer, it was easily manhandled by the weapon's crew.

MAX. RANGE
7850m
ROCKET WEIGHT
112.6kg

P01130
The sWG 40 280mm rocket launcher was an artillery piece that fired rockets instead of the traditional artillery shells. This weapon was a very simple design as it used a wooden crate to provide the launching platform for the rocket shell. A variety of simplistic methods were used to aim the weapon. Wooden stakes were driven into the ground to provide a base for the launching platform to lean against or pits could be dug into the ground which allowed the launching platform to lean against the earthen walls. All methods were very time consuming and slow to reload. Carrying 110 pounds of TNT, the sWG 40 was a potent weapon.

MAX. RANGE
2000m
ROCKET WEIGHT
79-82kg

P01137
The RW 56 300mm rocket launcher consisted of a six-rocket launcher rack on the carriage of a PaK 38 50mm anti-tank gun. To give an idea of the immense firepower of such a weapon, in just ten seconds it could fire over 1670 lbs. (762kg) in projectile weight.

MAX. RANGE
4550m
ROCKET WEIGHT
127kg

P01131
The FlaK 38 20mm was a single-barreled anti-aircraft weapon. It entered service in 1939 and was intended as the replacement for the Flak 20mm. Generally carried on a small two-wheeled trailer the FlaK 38 could be found in every theater of the war and mounted on a huge variety of equipment. Its high rate of fire made it useful against low flying aircraft and "soft" ground targets. During the last years of the war the FlaK 38 lost most of its effectiveness against the increasingly well armored Allied aircraft.

MAX. EFFECTIVE CEILING
2000m
SHELL WEIGHT
0.3kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
405kg

P01132
The FlaKvierling 38 was a quadruple-barreled 20mm anti-aircraft weapon. First entering service with the German navy in 1940, it quickly earned a good reputation for being able to fire an impressive amount of shells. Quickly adopted for use by all branches of the German military it was generally towed into place or could found mounted on a variety of vehicles. What the FlaKvierling lacked in punch, it more then made up with its volume of fire. Well liked by its crews, it served throughout the war on all fronts.

MAX. EFFECTIVE CEILING
2000m
SHELL WEIGHT
0.3kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1520kg

P01133
The FlaK 36 37mm was a single barreled anti-aircraft weapon. It had an automatic action that operated off of gas pressure and barrel recoil. It took a multi-round ammo clip that allowed the gun to have a practical rate of fire of 80 rounds per minute. Mounted on a triangular platform it was generally carried by a two-wheeled trailer, but could also be found mounted in a wide variety of vehicles.

MAX. EFFECTIVE CEILING
2000m
SHELL WEIGHT
0.635kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1544kg

P01134
The FlaK 43 37mm was a single barreled anti-aircraft weapon. Very similar in appearance to the FlaK 36, the FlaK 43 had a completely different mechanism for feeding and loading the shells. This fully automatic action allowed it to have almost twice the practical firing rate of the FlaK 36. Somewhat small in size it had a pedestal mount and generally came equipped with a shield that gave the crew some protection.

MAX. EFFECTIVE CEILING
4200m
SHELL WEIGHT
0.635kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1392kg

P01135
The FlaK 18 was a single barreled 88mm anti-aircraft weapon. One of the more famous weapons developed by Germany, it first entered service in the mid 1930s. Originally intended strictly for anti-aircraft purposes only, it was soon discovered that its rapid rate of fire and pinpoint accuracy allowed it to accomplish many jobs. It was often used for destroying bunkers and for turning back armored assaults. Overall a very effective weapon it was much appreciated by the crews that served it.

MAX. EFFECTIVE CEILING
10,600m
SHELL WEIGHT
9-9.6kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
5150kg

P01201
This unit represents a standard 1939-43 rifle platoon. It generally consisted of around 50 men armed with rifles, a few submachineguns, one light machinegun per squad, and a 50mm light mortar. For game purposes the platoon is also assumed to have an anti-tank rifle attached from its parent company. Unlike other armies, the Germans considered the machinegun - not the rifle - to be the prime infantry weapon, and based all their infantry tactics around it.


P01202
This unit represents the basic rifle platoon in a 1944 German infantry division. It consisted of three squads and a small HQ, with a total of about 33 men. The platoon was armed with rifles, submachineguns and four MG 42 light machineguns. For game purposes the platoon is also assumed to have several Panzerfaust or Panzerschreck hand-held anti-tank weapons, which enabled an ordinary soldier to eliminate a 40-ton tank with a single shot - though only at close range.


P01203
This unit represents a 1941-42 rifle platoon of the Waffen (armed) SS. Like its regular army counterpart, it generally consisted of around 50 men armed with rifles, a few submachineguns, light machineguns and a 50mm mortar. For game purposes it is also assumed to have an anti-tank rifle attached from its parent company. Most SS infantry was motorized; this unit represents the minority that was not.


P01204
This unit represents an early-war motorized rifle platoon. It generally consisted of around 50 men armed with rifles, a few submachineguns, two light machineguns per squad, and a 50mm light mortar. For game purposes the platoon is also assumed to have an anti-tank rifle attached from its parent company. Transportation was provided by trucks or halftracks. With a total of eight light machineguns in its four squads, the motorized infantry platoon possessed an impressive amount of anti-personnel firepower for its size.


P01205
This unit represents an early-war motorized rifle platoon of the Waffen (armed) SS. Like its regular army counterpart, it generally consisted of around 50 men armed with rifles, a few submachineguns, two light machineguns per squad, a 50mm light mortar, and an anti-tank rifle attached from its parent company. Transportation was provided by trucks or halftracks. Fierce and ruthless in combat on the Eastern Front, SS troops often took no prisoners - and in return were shown no mercy or quarter by the Russians.


P01206
This unit represents a Fallschirmjger (parachute infantry) platoon in the early-to-mid period of the war. Parachute troops were actually part of the Luftwaffe, and as in other nations were an elite, so were generally better equipped and motivated than regular infantry.


P01225
This unit represents a 1944-45 Fallschirmjger (parachute infantry) platoon. It was generally equipped with three squads and a small HQ; about 40 men in all. The platoon was armed with rifles and assault rifles, six MG 42 light machineguns and one Panzerschreck. The older parachute formations, with their core of hardened veterans, retained their elite edge throughout the war and were regarded as some of the best German troops in the field.


P01207
This unit represents a late-war second-line Fallschirmjger (Parachute Infantry) platoon. It was generally equipped with three squads and a small HQ; about 40 men in all. The platoon was armed with rifles and assault rifles, six MG 42 light machineguns and one Panzerschreck. By late 1944 most of the men in the parachute divisions were replacements with no jump training; and moreover, those in the recently raised formations lacked the experience, leadership and esprit de corps of the older outfits.


P01208
This unit represents a Luftwaffe field infantry platoon, found in the field infantry divisions fielded by the German Air Force and manned by excess ground personnel. Hermann Gring refused to make the men available as replacements to the army, and created these divisions instead. Poorly trained and led by inexperienced officers, the Luftwaffe field formations had limited combat effectiveness.


P01209
This unit represents a Panzergrenadier platoon. This was the new name given to the motorized infantry in mid-1942. No organizational change occurred. The new name was both an honorific and a reflection of their special training to work with the panzer forces.


P01210
This unit represents a an SS Panzergrenadier platoon. This was the new name given to the SS motorized infantry in mid-1942. No organizational change occurred. The new name was both an honorific and a reflection of their special training to work with the panzer forces.


P01211
This unit represents a Volksgrenadier platoon. It generally contained three squads and a small HQ; about 33 men in all. They were armed with rifles (one squad), submachineguns (two squads), three MG 42 light machineguns and several Panzerschreck. The volksgrenadier regiment had no anti-tank gun platoon; instead, it had an extra volksgrenadier company armed with Panzerschreck. In the game these troops are assumed to be split up and attached to the platoons. Volksgrenadier troops were formed in the latter half of 1944. Some were regular army units simply renamed, while others were second-class replacements with little training.


P01212
This unit represents a Volkssturm platoon. By 1944 Germany's manpower losses were becoming very difficult to replace. An order went out in October 1944 that all civilian males between the ages of 16 and 60 were to join the Volkssturm (home guard). Each district was expected to form at least one battalion for the defense of the surrounding area. The recruits were either old veterans of WWI or children, usually led by young officers of the Hitler Youth group. Generally 45 men made up a platoon, and were armed with whatever small arms happened to be available - but usually with a large number of deadly Panzerschreck or Panzerfaust hand-held anti-tank weapons.


P01213
This unit represents a generic machinegun platoon, with about 30 men and three or four heavy machineguns. The weapon was the revolutionary MG 34 (or later the even better MG 42) fitted to a tripod that provided a stable platform for long-range fire. The MG 42 was the most advanced design in the world, with up to twice the rate of fire (as much as 20 rounds per second) of Allied weapons.


P01214
This unit represents a generic machinegun platoon of the Waffen SS, with about 30 men and three or four heavy machineguns. The weapon was the revolutionary MG 34 (or later the even better MG 42) fitted to a tripod that provided a stable platform for long-range fire. The MG 42 was the most advanced design in the world, with up to twice the rate of fire (as much as 20 rounds per second) of Allied weapons..


P01215
This unit represents a generic assault engineer platoon. It generally consisted of 40-50 men with rifles, submachineguns, light machineguns, satchel charges, flamethrowers, and later one or more Panzerfaust or Panzerschreck hand-held anti-tank weapons. The main function of this platoon was to lead the assault on fortified positions. The German term for assault engineers was Pionere ("Pioneers").


P01216
This unit represents a generic assault engineer platoon of the Waffen SS. Like its counterpart in the regular army, it generally consisted of 40-50 men with rifles, submachineguns, light machineguns, satchel charges, flamethrowers, and later one or more Panzerfaust or Panzerschreck hand-held anti-tank weapons. Its main role was to lead the assault on fortified positions. The German term for assault engineers was Pionere ("Pioneers").


P01217
This unit represents a cavalry platoon of about forty men in three squads. The Germans used only one cavalry division during the invasion of Russia, and the division was disbanded in late 1941. Additional cavalry was found in the recon battalion of the older infantry divisions, but in 1943 these mounted squadrons were consolidated into brigades controlled by each army group. These were used mainly to combat the ever-present threat of partisans.


P01218
This unit represents a Waffen SS cavalry platoon of about forty men in three squads. One SS cavalry division was formed in 1942 to fight partisans. Several more created late in the war were destroyed almost immediately by the Russians.


P01219
This unit represents a motorcycle platoon. Generally, it was an infantry platoon that had been assigned motorcycles to increase their mobility so that they could keep pace with armor. The goal was to provide an inexpensive form of transportation, as the construction of halftracks was never able to keep up with demand. They were issued a variety of brands, which included the traditional two-wheeled model and sidecars. Often they were part of a reconnaissance company, and worked with other forms of motorized infantry to scout for the main force. Typically, 35-40 men made up a platoon and they were issued around 9-12 motorcycles. They were armed with all types of small arms, which included rifles, grenades and light machineguns.


P01220
This unit represents an SS motorcycle platoon. The SS troops were generally all volunteers, and when compared to other army units, they typically received better training and the latest weapons. Considered an elite unit, they received more food and ammo, but also got the hardest jobs. Generally, the motorcycle platoon was an infantry unit that had been assigned motorcycles to increase their mobility so that they could keep pace with armor. The goal was to provide an inexpensive form of transportation, as construction of halftracks was never able to keep up with demand. They were issued a variety of brands, which included the traditional two-wheeled model and sidecars. Often they were part of a reconnaissance company, and worked with other forms of motorized infantry to scout for the main force. Typically, 35-40 men made up a platoon and they were issued around 9-12 motorcycles. They were armed with all types of small arms, which included rifles, grenades and light machineguns.


P01223
This unit represents a motorcycle machinegun platoon, with heavy MG 34 or MG 42 machineguns carried in sidecars. Motorcycle machinegun platoons were sometimes found in bicycle as well as motorcycle units.


P01224
This unit represents an SS motorcycle machinegun platoon, with heavy MG 34 or MG 42 machineguns carried in sidecars. Motorcycle machinegun platoons were sometimes found in bicycle as well as motorcycle units.


P01221
This unit represents a Bicycle platoon. It generally consisted of a platoon leader who was in charge of three squads, of 12 men each. Rifles, pistols, hand grenades and a few light machineguns were typically assigned to this unit. For transportation the Wehrmacht Bicycle 38 was issued. This bike, which had racks to enable the carrying of most of the light weapons, was useful only on a prepared surface. Bicycles were generally used to increase the road mobility of infantry who had no other means of transport. For obvious reasons their mobility was severely hampered by inclement weather.


P01222
This unit represents an SS Bicycle platoon. The SS troops were generally all volunteers, and were considered an elite unit. When compared to other army units, the SS typically received better training and the latest weapons. This allowed them to maintain a higher moral level. It generally consisted of a platoon leader who was in charge of three squads, of 12 men each. Rifles, pistols, hand grenades and a few light machineguns were typically assigned to this unit. For transportation they were issued the Wehrmacht Bicycle 38. This bike, which had racks to enable the carrying of most of the light weapons, was useful only on a prepared surface.


P01226
This unit represents the later-war panzergrenadier platoon, with three squads and a small HQ; about 40 men in all. They were armed with rifles and submachineguns, six MG 42 light machineguns and a panzerschreck (the German equivalent of the bazooka, though much more powerful than the American weapon). They are also assumed to possess a number of panzerfausts - hand-held anti-tank rockets that could easily destroy any existing vehicle. In theory all panzergrenadiers were "armored" infantry, but normally in a late-war panzer division only one of its four panzergrenadier battalions was equipped with armored halftracks. The other three were still transported in trucks.


P01227
This unit represents an SS-panzergrenadier platoon, with three squads and a small HQ; about 40 men in all. They were armed with rifles, submachineguns and/or assault rifles, six MG 42 light machineguns and one panzerschreck (the German equivalent of the bazooka, though much more powerful than the American weapon). They are also assumed to possess a number of panzerfausts - hand-held anti-tank rockets that could easily destroy any existing vehicle. In theory all panzergrenadiers were "armored" infantry, but even in the SS - which received preferential treatment in supplies and equipment - only one battalion per panzergrenadier regiment was equipped with armored halftracks in a late-war panzer division. The other panzergrenadier battalions were still transported in trucks.


P01301
This unit represents a motorized headquarters. During the war, German headquarters staffs were usually able to adapt to changing circumstances rapidly, and conducted some amazing feats of improvisation. Their experience with the concept of the Kampfgruppe (battle group), a mixed force of different unit types, proved invaluable whenever it became necessary to form a cohesive force quickly from whatever troops happened to be at hand.


P01302
This unit represents a motorized headquarters. During the war, German headquarters staffs were usually able to adapt to changing circumstances rapidly, and conducted some amazing feats of improvisation. Their experience with the concept of the Kampfgruppe (battle group), a mixed force of different unit types, proved invaluable whenever it became necessary to form a cohesive force quickly from whatever troops happened to be at hand.


P01303
This unit represents a motorized headquarters. During the war, German headquarters staffs were usually able to adapt to changing circumstances rapidly, and conducted some amazing feats of improvisation. Their experience with the concept of the Kampfgruppe (battle group), a mixed force of different unit types, proved invaluable whenever it became necessary to form a cohesive force quickly from whatever troops happened to be at hand.


P01304
This unit represents a non-motorized (i.e., infantry type) battalion headquarters. During the war, headquarters staffs were able to adapt to changing circumstances rapidly, and conducted some amazing feats of improvisation. Their experience with the concept of the Kampfgruppe (battle group), a mixed force of different unit types, proved invaluable whenever it became necessary to form a cohesive force quickly from whatever troops happened to be at hand.


P01305
This unit represents a motorized headquarters. During the war, German headquarters staffs were usually able to adapt to changing circumstances rapidly, and conducted some amazing feats of improvisation. Their experience with the concept of the Kampfgruppe (battle group), a mixed force of different unit types, proved invaluable whenever it became necessary to form a cohesive force quickly from whatever troops happened to be at hand.


P01306
This unit represents a motorized headquarters. During the war, German headquarters staffs were usually able to adapt to changing circumstances rapidly, and conducted some amazing feats of improvisation. Their experience with the concept of the Kampfgruppe (battle group), a mixed force of different unit types, proved invaluable whenever it became necessary to form a cohesive force quickly from whatever troops happened to be at hand.


P01307
This unit represents a motorized headquarters. During the war, German headquarters staffs were usually able to adapt to changing circumstances rapidly, and conducted some amazing feats of improvisation. Their experience with the concept of the Kampfgruppe (battle group), a mixed force of different unit types, proved invaluable whenever it became necessary to form a cohesive force quickly from whatever troops happened to be at hand.


P01401
To generalize, German army officers were well trained, especially in staff matters. Junior-grade leaders were taught to think fast and make quick decisions, the reasoning behind this being that any decision tended to be better than none at all, and any action taken quickly could catch the enemy by surprise and throw him off balance. They were also expected to make decisions above their normal command level when necessary, and to seize opportunities that presented themselves without having to await orders. This was a tremendous difference from the training received in other armies - at least early in the war - and quick thinking by German officers often led to results out of all proportion to what might have been expected. Heavy losses diluted this advantage as the war went on, but in all save the most inexperienced units the Germans retained an edge in tactics until the very end.


P01402
To generalize, German army officers were well trained, especially in staff matters. Junior-grade leaders were taught to think fast and make quick decisions, the reasoning behind this being that any decision tended to be better than none at all, and any action taken quickly could catch the enemy by surprise and throw him off balance. They were also expected to make decisions above their normal command level when necessary, and to seize opportunities that presented themselves without having to await orders. This was a tremendous difference from the training received in other armies - at least early in the war - and quick thinking by German officers often led to results out of all proportion to what might have been expected. Heavy losses diluted this advantage as the war went on, but in all save the most inexperienced units the Germans retained an edge in tactics until the very end.


P01403
To generalize, German army officers were well trained, especially in staff matters. Junior-grade leaders were taught to think fast and make quick decisions, the reasoning behind this being that any decision tended to be better than none at all, and any action taken quickly could catch the enemy by surprise and throw him off balance. They were also expected to make decisions above their normal command level when necessary, and to seize opportunities that presented themselves without having to await orders. This was a tremendous difference from the training received in other armies - at least early in the war - and quick thinking by German officers often led to results out of all proportion to what might have been expected. Heavy losses diluted this advantage as the war went on, but in all save the most inexperienced units the Germans retained an edge in tactics until the very end.


P01404
To generalize, German army officers were well trained, especially in staff matters. Junior-grade leaders were taught to think fast and make quick decisions, the reasoning behind this being that any decision tended to be better than none at all, and any action taken quickly might catch the enemy by surprise and throw him off balance. They were also expected to make decisions above their normal command level when necessary, and to seize opportunities that presented themselves without having to await orders. This was a tremendous difference from the training received in other armies - at least early in the war - and quick thinking by German officers often led to results out of all proportion to what might have been expected. Heavy losses diluted this advantage as the war went on, but in all save the most inexperienced units the Germans retained an edge in tactics until the very end.


P01405
To generalize, German army officers were well trained, especially in staff matters. Junior-grade leaders were taught to think fast and make quick decisions, the reasoning behind this being that any decision tended to be better than none at all, and any action taken quickly might catch the enemy by surprise and throw him off balance. They were also expected to make decisions above their normal command level when necessary, and to seize opportunities that presented themselves without having to await orders. This was a tremendous difference from the training received in other armies - at least early in the war - and quick thinking by German officers often led to results out of all proportion to what might have been expected. Heavy losses diluted this advantage as the war went on, but in all save the most inexperienced units the Germans retained an edge in tactics until the very end.


P01406
To generalize, German army officers were well trained, especially in staff matters. Junior-grade leaders were taught to think fast and make quick decisions, the reasoning behind this being that any decision tended to be better than none at all, and any action taken quickly might catch the enemy by surprise and throw him off balance. They were also expected to make decisions above their normal command level when necessary, and to seize opportunities that presented themselves without having to await orders. This was a tremendous difference from the training received in other armies - at least early in the war - and quick thinking by German officers often led to results out of all proportion to what might have been expected. Heavy losses diluted this advantage as the war went on, but in all save the most inexperienced units the Germans retained an edge in tactics until the very end.


P01407
To generalize, German army officers were well trained, especially in staff matters. Junior-grade leaders were taught to think fast and make quick decisions, the reasoning behind this being that any decision tended to be better than none at all, and any action taken quickly might catch the enemy by surprise and throw him off balance. They were also expected to make decisions above their normal command level when necessary, and to seize opportunities that presented themselves without having to await orders. This was a tremendous difference from the training received in other armies - at least early in the war - and quick thinking by German officers often led to results out of all proportion to what might have been expected. Heavy losses diluted this advantage as the war went on, but in all save the most inexperienced units the Germans retained an edge in tactics until the very end.


P01408
To generalize, German army officers were well trained, especially in staff matters. Junior-grade leaders were taught to think fast and make quick decisions, the reasoning behind this being that any decision tended to be better than none at all, and any action taken quickly might catch the enemy by surprise and throw him off balance. They were also expected to make decisions above their normal command level when necessary, and to seize opportunities that presented themselves without having to await orders. This was a tremendous difference from the training received in other armies - at least early in the war - and quick thinking by German officers often led to results out of all proportion to what might have been expected. Heavy losses diluted this advantage as the war went on, but in all save the most inexperienced units the Germans retained an edge in tactics until the very end.


P01409
To generalize, German army officers were well trained, especially in staff matters. Junior-grade leaders were taught to think fast and make quick decisions, the reasoning behind this being that any decision tended to be better than none at all, and any action taken quickly might catch the enemy by surprise and throw him off balance. They were also expected to make decisions above their normal command level when necessary, and to seize opportunities that presented themselves without having to await orders. This was a tremendous difference from the training received in other armies - at least early in the war - and quick thinking by German officers often led to results out of all proportion to what might have been expected. Heavy losses diluted this advantage as the war went on, but in all save the most inexperienced units the Germans retained an edge in tactics until the very end.


P01410
To generalize, German army officers were well trained, especially in staff matters. Junior-grade leaders were taught to think fast and make quick decisions, the reasoning behind this being that any decision tended to be better than none at all, and any action taken quickly might catch the enemy by surprise and throw him off balance. They were also expected to make decisions above their normal command level when necessary, and to seize opportunities that presented themselves without having to await orders. This was a tremendous difference from the training received in other armies - at least early in the war - and quick thinking by German officers often led to results out of all proportion to what might have been expected. Heavy losses diluted this advantage as the war went on, but in all save the most inexperienced units the Germans retained an edge in tactics until the very end.


P02001
The L3/35 Tankette was developed along the lines of the British Carden-Loyd Mk VI and first appeared as the L3/33 in 1933, but was retrofitted in 1935 and became the L3/35. In June 1940, when Italy entered the war, this tankette was found in all three armored divisions (except for two tank battalions), the tank battalions in the motorized divisions, the light tank squadron group in each Celere (Fast or Rapid) division, and numerous independent tank battalions. In addition to seeing action in the Ethiopian War and Spanish Civil War, the L3 was used everywhere Italians fought in WWII. Some 2000-2500 were built in different models and variants.

ARMAMENT
2 x 8mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
15mm
WEIGHT
3.5 tonnes

P02002
The L3 cc ("controcarro"; anti-tank) was a basic L3 tankette with a Solothurn 20mm anti-tank rifle mounted in place of its normal machinegun armament. Only a few were so modified, and they saw action only in North Africa.

ARMAMENT
1 x 20mm anti-tank rifle
MAX. ARMOR
15mm
WEIGHT
3.5 tonnes

P02003
The L3 Lf ("Lanciafiamme"; flamethrower) was another variant of the L3. Development began in 1935. The flamethrower nozzle replaced one of the mavchineguns, and the flame fuel was carried in an armored trailer towed by the tankette. Later versions had the fuel carried in a box-shaped tank mounted above the L3's engine compartment. The L3 Lf saw action in Spain, France, the Balkans, North Africa and Italian East Africa.

ARMAMENT
1x flamethrower
1 x 8mm machine gun
MAX. ARMOR
15mm
WEIGHT
5 tonnes

P02004
The L5 was Italy's first series production tank. Based loosely on the French FT-17, the FIAT 3000, as it was originally designated, was armed with two coaxially mounted machineguns. A later version carried a 37mm gun instead, and was used as a platoon- and company-commander's vehicle. Eventually their designations were changed to L5/21 and L5/30 respectively. The L5 was considered a first- line tank until mid 1939, seeing action in Libya in 1926 and in Ethiopia in 1936. It also fought along the French-Italian border in 1940 and in Sicily in 1943. Some 100 were built.

ARMAMENT
2 x 8mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
16mm
WEIGHT
5.5 tonnes

P02005
The L6/40 Light Tank was developed to replace the L3/35 in the role of cavalry or reconnaissance. It was developed from the chassis of the L3 and provided an increase in firepower, protection and mobility. By 1942, however, it was hopelessly obsolete and production was canceled in favor of the Semovente L40 47/32. 283 L6/40 were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 20mm L65 Gun
1 x 8mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
40mm
WEIGHT
6.8 tonnes

P02006
The M11/39 was intended as the standard medium tank for the Italian armored divisions. Carrying two turret-mounted 8mm machineguns and a superstructure-mounted 37mm gun, it was fairly well armed. However, the limited traverse of the 37mm gun proved unsatisfactory and soon the search for a design with a turret-mounted gun began. The result was that only 100 of these vehicles were built. The M11/39 saw action in Italian East Africa and Libya.

ARMAMENT
1x 37mm L40 gun
2 x 8mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
30mm
WEIGHT
11 tonnes

P02007
The M13/40 was designed as a replacement for the M11/39. Ordered in January 1940, it was in action by the second half of the year. Though basically the same as the M11/39 mechanically, the M13/40 carried a bigger gun in a fully rotating turret. Its weaknesses were slow speed and a cramped two-man turret. The M13/40 saw action in North Africa and the Balkans. 785 were built. Four M13/40 made up a platoon until August 1941.

ARMAMENT
1 x 47mm L32 gun
3 x 8mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
42mm
WEIGHT
14.3 tonnes

P02008
The M13/40 was designed as a replacement for the M11/39. Ordered in January 1940, it was in action by the second half of the year. Though basically the same the M11/39 mechanically, the M13/40 carried a bigger gun in a fully rotating turret. Its weaknesses were slow speed and a cramped two-man turret. The M13/40 saw action in North Africa and the Balkans. 785 were built. After August 1941, five M13/40 were authorized per medium tank platoon.

ARMAMENT
1 x 47mm L32 gun
3 x 8mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
37mm
WEIGHT
14.3 tonnes

P02009
The M14/41 was essentially an up-engined M13/40, fitted with the 15 TM41 V-8 diesel in an attempt to remedy the slow speed of the M13/40. Some 895 of these AFVs were built, seeing action in North Africa. By late 1942 they had supplanted the M13/40 as the standard medium tank in Italian armored divisions.

ARMAMENT
1 x 47mm L32 gun
3 x 8mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
37mm
WEIGHT
14.3 tonnes

P02011
The MR/35 was a captured French R35, 124 of which Italy received from Germany in 1941. The Italians installed radios and designated them MR/35. Their only action in Italian service was in Sicily in July 1943.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm L21 gun
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
45mm
WEIGHT
10 tonnes

P02012
Taking note of the success of the Sturmgeschtz III, the Italians designed a similar vehicle in early 1941, which they called the Semovente M40 da 75/18. Based on the M13/40 hull and chassis, it mounted a 75mm howitzer in a box-shaped superstructure. Although sometimes used as a tank destroyer, the SMV 75/18 was intended primarily to provide support and flank protection for Italian medium tank units. It saw action in North Africa and Italy. About 60 were produced.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm L18 howitzer
MAX. ARMOR
50mm
WEIGHT
14.8 tonnes

P02013
The Semovente M41 da 75/18 differed from the M40 da 75/18 in that it was based on the faster M14/41 tank. 162 of these vehicles were produced. Semoventi were normally used in batteries of four vehicles.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm L18 howitzer
MAX. ARMOR
50mm
WEIGHT
14.8 tonnes

P02017
The Semovente L40 da 47/32 Tank Destroyer was derived from the L6/40 Light Tank to increase the mobility of the 47mm gun. It was employed mostly in "Gruppi Semoventi 47/32" anti-tank battalions, but was often relegated to the role of infantry support since its anti-tank capabilities were limited. About 300 were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 47mm L32 gun
MAX. ARMOR
30mm
WEIGHT
6.5 tonnes

P02018
The Semovente M41M da 90/53 was developed in 1942 by placing a 90mm AA gun on a modified M14/41 hull. The hull and chassis were lengthened, and the engine was moved from the rear of the vehicle to the center. The design proved unsatisfactory due to the stresses caused by the large and powerful gun, and by a very limited ammunition stowage capacity. Originally intended for use in Russia, the Semovente M14M da 90/53 saw action only in Sicily. Thirty were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 90mm L53 gun
MAX. ARMOR
30mm
WEIGHT
15.7 tonnes

P02019
The AS 42 "Sahariana" Scout Car was developed for long-range desert reconnaissance. It was unarmored, but had excellent cross country range. It saw action in North Africa, Sicily and Italy. Some 200 were built.

ARMAMENT
varied (MG, 20mm, etc.)
MAX. ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
4.5 tonnes

P02021
The Lancia 1ZM Armored Car began development in 1912. It saw action in World War I, and in 1928 was fitted with more modern machineguns. An interesting feature of the IZM was a set of rails that allowed the vehicle to drive through and cut barbed wire. The vehicle saw action during the Spanish Civil War, in Ethiopia and in Italian East Africa. 

ARMAMENT
2 x 8mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
6mm
WEIGHT
4 tonnes

P02022
The AB 611 Armored Car was based on a FIAT 6x4 truck. It carried four machineguns: two in the front of the turret, and one each at the rear of the turret and hull. Some, however - apparently platoon- and company-command vehicles - mounted a 37mm L40 gun in place of the two turret-front machineguns. The AB 611 saw action in Ethiopia and Italian East Africa. 46 were built.

ARMAMENT
4 x 8mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
15mm
WEIGHT
7 tonnes

P02024
The AB 40's advanced automotive design filled the needs of the Italian Army for a modern armored car. It featured 4x4 drive, fully independent suspension, four-wheel steering, free-spinning spare wheels in the middle on both sides to prevent 'bellying' on obstacles, and a rear driving position (so the vehicle could get out of a sticky situation without having to turn around). Twenty-four were built before the design was changed to the more heavily armed AB 41.

ARMAMENT
3 x 8mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
18mm
WEIGHT
7 tonnes

P02025
The AB 41's advanced design fulfilled the needs of the Italian Army for a modern armored car. It featured 4x4 drive with four-wheel steering, a fully independent suspension, a free-spinning rotating spare wheel on both sides in the middle to prevent bellying when crossing obstacles, a rear driving position, and increased horsepower over its sister, the AB 40 armored car. The primary purpose of the AB 41 was reconnaissance and it was therefore allocated to reconnaissance units of armored, motorized and cavalry divisions as well as independent recon companies. About 560 were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 20mm L65 gun
2 x 8mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
18mm
WEIGHT
7.5 tonnes

P02026
The Autocannone da 65/17 was based on the British Morris CS 8 15-cwt truck, 24 captured examples of which were modified by the Italians to carry the 65mm infantry gun as a self-propelled artillery piece. They saw action in North Africa.

ARMAMENT
1 x 65mm L17 gun
MAX. ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
3 tonnes

P02027
The Autocannone da 20/65 was a flatbed truck - often a captured British vehicle - carrying the Italian 20mm AA gun. These SP guns saw action primarily in North Africa.

ARMAMENT
1 x 20mm L65 AA gun
MAX. ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
3 tonnes

P02028
The Autocannone da 75/27 CK dated back to the First World War when the Italians modified trucks to carry the Krupp 75mm AA gun. In 1927 the Italians mounted this same gun on the Ceirano truck. Some of these vehicles saw action during the early fighting in North Africa. 

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm L27 AA gun
MAX. ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
7 tonnes

P02029
The Autocannone da 90/53 resulted from modifying 4x4 (and later 6x6) heavy trucks to carry the 90mm AA gun. The vehicle was designed to serve in both the anti-aircraft and anti-tank roles. About 57 were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 90mm L53 AA gun
MAX. ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
12 tonnes

P02030
From 1926 the Italians developed various wheeled prime movers (which they called tractors) to tow artillery. Three common models were the Trattore Leggero 37 (light), Trattore Medio 40 (medium) and the Trattrice Pesante 32 (heavy). Each had 4x4 drive with oversized wheels and four-wheel steering. Most also had fully independent suspension.


P02031
The Italians originally moved their light guns "en portee" (carried on the back of trucks) in motorized units. When this fell out of favor they developed special light trucks to tow them. This unit is a generic representation of these vehicles.


P02032
The Italians used many different types of trucks, which they categorized as Leggero (light), Medio (medium) or Pesante (heavy). Beginning in 1937 the Army set standards for manufacturers to follow along the lines of payload capacity and minimum top speed. The Army never had enough motor transport during the war, but made an effort to fully motorize the armies in North Africa and Russia. They used captured British trucks to help alleviate shortages within their North African forces, and were also supplied with Opel Blitz and French Citroen trucks by the Germans. Despite all efforts, they were never able to fully meet the motorization needs of their troops.


P02033
This unit represents a variable number of wagons sufficient to move a battery of guns or a platoon of infantry. A 1940 non-North-African-type infantry division was authorized 154 wagons (and 121 motor vehicles), with all of its divisional artillery and regimental infantry guns horse-drawn.


P02034
This unit represents a number of horses sufficient to carry a plotone (platoon) of cavalrymen. A 1940 cavalry regiment contained 818 horses.


P02035
Bicycles are one of the least demanding forms of transport available to any army. Requiring neither fuel nor fodder, bicycles can move troops on improved roads as fast as is tactically prudent, and they are easily discarded at no great loss in the event of prolonged engagement. Their main drawback is that they do require improved roads.


P02036
This unit represents a variable number of motorcycles used for the transport of infantry - generally Bersaglieri.


P02037
This unit represents a variable number of unarmed and unarmored powered boats used to transport infantry and equipment across water.


P02038
This unit represents a variable number of rafts used to transport infantry and equipment across water.


P02039 
The T-26 was the most powerful armored vehicle on the Spanish battlefield (with the exception of the rare BT-5). The arrival of Russian tanks in the Republican arsenal gave the Loyalists considerable armoured superiority as the cannon bearing T-26 Bs greatly outclassed the Italian and German light tanks being supplied to the Nationalists. However, poor tactics led the Republic to squander most of these tanks in costly armoured assaults, unsupported by infantry, or to diffuse their offensive capability by allotting them to static defense or infantry support roles. Though most T-26 Bs were found in Republican service, the Nationalist troops resorted to a number of measures to capture these tanks, going so far as to offer a bounty for each tank captured intact, as the only means of achieving armoured parity with the Republicans. 
A few T-26 Bs were captured by the Italian CTV and were used by them in its armoured regimnet with captured BT-5s.  

ARMAMENT
1 x 45mm gun
1-3 x 7.62mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
25mm
WEIGHT
10 tonnes


P02040 
A total of 50 BT series tanks arrived in Spain in August of 1937. They formed the equipment of the elite International heavy tank regiment.  Almost all the first BT-5s were lost at Fuentes del Ebro and later replacements were later squandered just as recklessly at Teruel. A few BT-5s were captured by the Italian CTV and were used by them in its armoured regimnet with captured T-26 Bs. Like the T-26, the BT-5s supplied to the Spanish were probably equipped with radios though the Spanish crews seemed to have removed these, preferring signal flags. Its roomy interior, quick speed, and dual tracked/wheeled propulsion system were welcomed by its crews and made it more popular than the T-26 B. BT-5 light tanks featured a suspension based on that of the American Christie convertible tank. The suspension of these vehicles were designed to be operated without tracks on roads, which reduced track wear and the possibility of track failure. The tracks could then be fitted for use across terrain. 

ARMAMENT
1 x 45mm gun
1-3 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
22mm
WEIGHT
14 tonnes


P02043
This unit represents a number of horses sufficient to carry a plotone (platoon) of Ascari cavalrymen.


P02101
The Mortaio da 81/14 81mm mortar fired both light (7-lb.) and heavy (15-lb.) HE rounds, and had the longest range of any medium mortar used during the war. Like most other derivatives of the classic French Brandt mortar, the 81/14 could fire smoke, and in a pinch could fire German, American and French 81mm rounds as well. Infantry regiments in Regular, Motorized and Autotrasportabile (truckable) infantry divisions were usually allocated a company of medium mortars. 1942 Tipo-AS (North African) infantry regiments and Alpini regiments were allocated one company per battalion. Infantry and Autotrasportabile divisions (except Tipo-AS) were also allocated a divisional mortar battalion of three companies. The Pasubio and Torino divisions in Russia were allocated two such battalions. Cavalry, Libyan, and Bersaglieri regiments contained no mortars (though later in North Africa, some of them did). An 81mm mortar company generally consisted of three platoons of two mortars each.

MAX. RANGE
4000m
SHELL WEIGHT
3.3kg & 6.9kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
50kg

P02125
The Mortaio da 81/14 81mm mortar fired both light (7-lb.) and heavy (15-lb.) HE rounds, and had the longest range of any medium mortar used during the war. Like most other derivatives of the classic French Brandt mortar, the 81/14 could fire smoke, and in a pinch could fire German, American and French 81mm rounds as well. Each Blackshirt Legion was authorized one mortar company, which generally consisted of three platoons of three mortars each.

MAX. RANGE
4000m
SHELL WEIGHT
3.3kg & 6.9kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
50kg

P02102
The Cannone da 65/17 dated back to 1913, when it was first used as a mountain gun by the Alpini troops. By mid-1940 this 65mm piece was the standard infantry support weapon of the Italian Army. Infantry regiments in regular and Autotrasportabile (truckable) infantry divisions were each allocated one battery of four 65/17 guns, as was each Blackshirt Legion. About 700 were in service in 1940.

MAX. RANGE
6500m
SHELL WEIGHT
4.2kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
556kg

P02103
The Cannone da 70/15 was an ancient weapon dating back to 1902. It lacked any kind of recoil mechanism. Originally designed as a mountain gun, it was replaced by the 65/17 and relegated to the infantry support role. It was used mostly in Italian East Africa, apparently as a regimental support piece.

MAX. RANGE
6600m
SHELL WEIGHT
4.84kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
387kg

P02104
The Cannone-cc da 37/45 anti-tank gun was the German 37mm PaK 35/36 built under license by the Italians. Apparently not widely used, it was encountered by the British in the early desert campaigns. It was usually transported en portee (carried in a truck).

ARMOR PENETRATION
48mm at 500m
SHELL WEIGHT
0.97kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
435kg

P02105
The Cannone da 47/32 47mm anti-tank gun was the Austrian Bhler M1935 that Italy produced under several licenses. It was used as an anti-tank gun, for infantry support, as pack artillery, and was also used in the M13-14 tanks and the Semovente 47/32 tank destroyer. Drawbacks were that it contained no gun shield and those built before 1939 had no towing eyelet, so they had to be portaged en portee (carried in trucks) or manhandled. A 47/32 company normally consisted of eight guns in four platoons. About 3000 of these weapons were built.

ARMOR PENETRATION
43mm at 500m
SHELL WEIGHT
1.44kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
277kg

P02109
The Cannone da 75/27 75mm field gun was the standard light field piece in the artillery regiment of most Italian divisions during the war. This gun actually represents four pre-WWI gun types; the 75/27 m06, m11 and m12, and the 77/28. The m06 was a Krupp design built under license; the m11 was a French import; the m12 was a modified m06. The Skoda-built 77/28 was a combination field/mountain gun that was allocated to Italy's two Libyan divisions. A battery consisted of four guns. Over 3000 were in service by 1940.

MAX. RANGE
10240m
SHELL WEIGHT
6.35kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
900-1080kg

P02111
The Obice da 75/18 75mm howitzer consisted of two gun types: the 75/18 m34 (a modern mountain howitzer developed in 1934) and the 75/18 m35 (a normal field howitzer based on the m34). Both were used as divisional artillery in a few select units, mostly in North Africa and Russia. This same ordnance was used as the main gun in the Semovente 75/18 assault gun. About 350 (230 m34 and 122 m35) were produced.

MAX. RANGE
9560m
SHELL WEIGHT
6.3kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
780-1050kg

P02112
The Obice da 100/17 field howitzer combines three gun types: the Austro-Hungarian Skoda 10cm vz 14 howitzer (taken over by Italy in 1918), the Skoda 10cm vz 16 mountain howitzer, and (from Germany) the 10cm vz 14/19 howitzer (designated 100/22). The Italians used the 100/17 along with the 75/27 in the artillery regiments of various divisions. Each battalion of 100/17 guns consisted of twelve guns in three batteries. Over 1900 saw service during the war.

MAX. RANGE
9280m
SHELL WEIGHT
13.65kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1417kg

P02113
The Cannone da 105/28 field howitzer was a license-built version of the French 105mm mle 1913 (also known as the L 13 S). It was used by the Italians primarily as corps artillery, and occasionally was employed at divisional level in place of the 100/17. In mid 1940 the Italians had 956 in service.

MAX. RANGE
12000m
SHELL WEIGHT
15.74kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2300kg

P02114
The Obice da 149/13 150mm howitzer mainly represents two types of guns confiscated from the Austro-Hungarian Empire after WWI, which the Italians renamed the 149/12 and 149/13. Both were used primarily as corps artillery. In mid 1940 there were 1082 in Italian service.

MAX. RANGE
8790m
SHELL WEIGHT
40-41kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2344-2765kg

P02115
The Obice da 149/28 was the German 15cm sFH 18 field howitzer, 38 of which were sold to Italy in 1941. These guns were used to augment the Italians' lack of large-caliber Army-level guns, and saw action in North Africa and Russia.

MAX. RANGE
13250m
SHELL WEIGHT
43.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
5512kg

P02116
The Cannone da 149/35 was yet another example of an ancient gun still in service with the Italian Army during WWII. First produced around the turn of the century, this gun lacked a recoil mechanism and needed ramps behind the wheels to stop it from rolling too far backwards when fired. It also had large wooden plates strapped to the wheels to prevent rolling. Some 895 were in the Italian inventory in 1940. These guns saw action in North Africa and the Balkans, employed at army level.

MAX. RANGE
10,600m
SHELL WEIGHT
46kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
8220kg

P02117
The Cannone da 149/40 150mm howitzer was developed in 1935 to replace the older large-caliber army-level guns, but production was unable to meet demands. By 1942 only 51 were in service. Due to its superior quality, however, production of the 149/40 was maintained by the Germans after 1943. This howitzer saw action in Russia and North Africa.

MAX. RANGE
23700m
SHELL WEIGHT
46kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
11340kg

P02110
The Obice da 75/13 75mm mountain howitzer was the Skoda 7.5cm vz 15, perhaps the most successful mountain howitzer ever produced. Many were acquired after WWI and designated the 75/13, and were issued to the Alpini divisions to replace the 65/17 gun. An Alpini regiment, whose structure permitted independent operations away from its parent division, normally had a 75/13 battalion directly attached. One battery of four 75/13 guns could be assigned directly to each of the Alpini regiment's infantry battalions. The three Alpini divisions sent to Russia in 1942 were each allocated two 75/13 battalions in their artillery regiment. Other divisions occasionally used the 75/13 as divisional artillery. About 1200 were in service by 1940.

MAX. RANGE
8250m
SHELL WEIGHT
6.4kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
613kg

P02124
The Obice da 105/11 105mm mountain howitzer was the French "Canon Court de 105 M mle 1919" (or the very similar mle 1928) mountain gun built by Schneider. Its primary use by the Italians was in the elite Alpini divisions.

MAX. RANGE
7850m
SHELL WEIGHT
12kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
750kg

P02119
The Cannone-mitragliera da 20/65 20mm anti-aircraft gun was the standard light anti-aircraft gun of the Italian Army, which also viewed it as a heavy machinegun and light anti-tank gun. It was adopted into service in 1935. Production of the 20/65 was maintained after 1943 by the Germans. Over 2750 had been produced by September 1942.

MAX. EFFECTIVE CEILING
2500m
SHELL WEIGHT
.135kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
307kg

P02120
The Cannone-aa da 75/46 75mm anti-aircraft gun was adopted by the Italian Army in 1934. It saw action as an AA gun and as an anti-tank gun, and performed both roles very effectively. The Germans continued to use the 75/46 after 1943 when Italy switched sides. 226 had been built by late 1942.

MAX. EFFECTIVE CEILING
8300m
SHELL WEIGHT
6.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
3300kg

P02121
The Cannone-aa da 88/56 was the German 88mm FlaK 18 anti-aircraft gun. A number of these were provided to Italian forces in North Africa.

MAX. EFFECTIVE CEILING
10,600m
SHELL WEIGHT
9-9.6kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
5150kg

P02122
The Cannone-aa da 90/53 was the best anti-aircraft gun produced by Italy and arguably comparable to the German "88". It exceeded the "88" in maximum effective ceiling, and its armor penetration was nearly as good. Unfortunately for the Italian cause, the 90/53 was never available in sufficient numbers to meet the demands of the army. Only 539 had been produced by July 1943, and most were employed in fixed emplacements.

MAX. EFFECTIVE CEILING
11,400m
SHELL WEIGHT
10.33-11.25kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
6240kg

P02123
The Cannone da 47/32 Field Gun was the Austrian Bohler M1935 that Italy produced under several licenses. Light weight, it could be para-dropped and was used by the Folgore Parachute Division as divisional artillery.

MAX. RANGE
4100m
SHELL WEIGHT
1.44kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
277kg

P02201
This unit represents the standard rifle platoon. It comprised about 40 men in two squads, each of which contained a squad leader, a nine-man rifle group and an eight-man light machinegun group with two light machineguns. The rifles were often 6.5mm carbines with low muzzle velocity and inferior stopping power. The Breda modello 30 light machinegun, also of 6.5mm caliber, was a fragile design prone to jamming.


P02202
The Bersaglieri were light infantry transported on trucks, motorcycles or bicycles. A Bersaglieri platoon had the same organization as that of the regular infantry: about 40 men in two squads, each of which contained a squad leader, a nine-man rifle group and an eight-man light machinegun group with two LMGs. A Bersaglieri regiment formed the infantry element of the armored divisions, and one was present in several of the motorized divisions.


P02203
The Alpini were a recognized elite unit, recruited from Italy's alpine regions and specializing in mountain warfare. Three Alpini divisions were sent to Russia in the fall of 1942. During the great Russian counteroffensive around Stalingrad they performed admirably but were too lightly armed to withstand the Soviet onslaught, and all suffered heavy casualties.


P02204
This unit represents a typical Italian parachute infantry platoon. The Italians trained around 18,000 paratroops. These were mainly in the Folgore and Nembo divisions as well as a number of infantry, marine and colonial units. 


P02205
The CCNN were the the Italian Fascist Militia (aka the Blackshirts). They were grudgingly accepted as fighting forces by the army due to its manpower needs. Though summarily trained and lightly armed, they were often used as assault troops. From 1940 one CCNN Legion or regiment (of two Cohorts or battalions) was authorized in each infantry division, though not all divisions actually received one.


P02206
An Italian machinegun platoon generally contained four tripod-mounted machineguns. The weapons themselves varied in type, caliber, age and reliability. All suffered from inherent design flaws, and even the best - the 8mm Breda modello 37 - was less than unsatisfactory. These guns were yet another example of the poor equipment Italian soldier were forced to use.


P02207
This unit represents an anti-tank rifle section armed with two Solothurn s18-1100 semi-automatic 20mm anti-tank rifles, each with a crew of three men. The weapon itself weighed about 120 pounds (54.7kg), but came with a small two-wheel carriage for easier manhandling. It could be fired from the carriage or a bipod. The gun was introduced in early 1941, with a section generally being allotted to each infantry and Bersaglieri battalion. Later as many as three sections were authorized per battalion, but as the weapon was increasingly obsolete its use declined. Its Italian designation was "Fucile Anticarro S".


P02208
Like other nationalities, the Italians had many different types of engineers. Combat engineers were called "Guastatori", and carried a variety of assault equipment such as satchel charges and flamethrowers.


P02209
This unit represents a cavalry platoon of 40-45 men armed with sabers, rifles or carbines and three light machineguns.


P02210
Most Italian motorcycle troops were Bersaglieri. A Bersaglieri regiment often contained one or more motorcycle companies, which were often detached and used as recon units.


P02211
This unit represents primarily a platoon of four machineguns carried in motorcycle sidecars. A Bersaglieri motorcycle company usually contained one such platoon.


P02213
This unit represents a Bicycle platoon. Rifles, pistols, hand granades and a few light machineguns were typically allotted to units of this type. The bicycle was only useful on prepared surfaces and was hampered by inclement weather.


P02218 
 Carabinieri Platoon  

P02219 
 Ascari Colonial Cavalry Platoon  

P02200 
 Ascari Colonial Platoon 

P02216 
 Ascari Machinegun Platoon 


P02307
An Italian army headquarters generally might control, in addition to its subordinate corps, several motorized artillery battalions of 150mm or greater, several AA battalions, various engineer formations (bridging, construction, signals, etc.), and air liaison units.


P02306
An Italian corps headquarters generally might control, in addition to its subordinate divisions, several motorized artillery battalions of 105-150mm (the latter generally being howitzers, only occasionally field guns), one or two machinegun battalions, several engineer battalions including one of assault engineers (Guastatori), an anti-tank battalion, and several anti-aircraft batteries. 


P02301
An Italian division headquarters generally contained several hundred men. Motorization consisted mostly of automobiles, motorcycles (probably for messengers) and light trucks. Most radio equipment was not up to date and could not be operated on the move.


P02302
The Italians did not make much use of brigades per se. There were a number of coast-defense brigades and several brigades of armor or artillery, but the latter were special formations formed for a specific purpose rather than standard formations. In fact, many "brigades" referred to in English sources were actually termed Raggruppamenti by the Italians, which translates more akin to "task forces".


P02303
The headquarters of an infantry regiment typically consisted of the commanding officer and a command platoon (his staff), a signals platoon and a service platoon. Together they totaled about 250 men. Transport was a mixture of cars, trucks and motorcycles. Italian infantry divisions were unusual in being binary; i.e., they contained only two infantry regiments instead of the normal three.


P02304
An Italian infantry battalion headquarters typically consisted of the commanding officer and a command (staff) and service platoon, a signals platoon and a recon platoon. Together they totaled about 140 men.


P02305
This unit represents a motorized battalion headquarters with a number of motor vehicles sufficient to carry its men and equipment.


P02401
The Italian Army suffered from a failure in leadership. Junior officers in the Active (regular) Army were proficient, but many middle and higher commanders were WWI veterans too set in their ways. In addition, many battalion and regimental commanders were reservists called back to active duty with insufficient experience in contemporary tactics. To make matters worse, promotions were based almost entirely on seniority, so such officers were often left in command even when their lack of ability became apparent. Indeed, many of the Italian Army's failures in WWII were rooted in the combined effects of poor equipment too many ineffective officers.


P02402
The Italian Army suffered from a failure in leadership. Junior officers in the Active (regular) Army were proficient, but many middle and higher commanders were WWI veterans too set in their ways. In addition, many battalion and regimental commanders were reservists called back to active duty with insufficient experience in contemporary tactics. To make matters worse, promotions were based almost entirely on seniority, so such officers were often left in command even when their lack of ability became apparent. Indeed, many of the Italian Army's failures in WWII were rooted in the combined effects of poor equipment too many ineffective officers.


P02403
The Italian Army suffered from a failure in leadership. Junior officers in the Active (regular) Army were proficient, but many middle and higher commanders were WWI veterans too set in their ways. In addition, many battalion and regimental commanders were reservists called back to active duty with insufficient experience in contemporary tactics. To make matters worse, promotions were based almost entirely on seniority, so such officers were often left in command even when their lack of ability became apparent. Indeed, many of the Italian Army's failures in WWII were rooted in the combined effects of poor equipment too many ineffective officers.


P02404
The Italian Army suffered from a failure in leadership. Junior officers in the Active (regular) Army were proficient, but many middle and higher commanders were WWI veterans too set in their ways. In addition, many battalion and regimental commanders were reservists called back to active duty with insufficient experience in contemporary tactics. To make matters worse, promotions were based almost entirely on seniority, so such officers were often left in command even when their lack of ability became apparent. Indeed, many of the Italian Army's failures in WWII were rooted in the combined effects of poor equipment too many ineffective officers.


P02405
The Italian Army suffered from a failure in leadership. Junior officers in the Active (regular) Army were proficient, but many middle and higher commanders were WWI veterans too set in their ways. In addition, many battalion and regimental commanders were reservists called back to active duty with insufficient experience in contemporary tactics. To make matters worse, promotions were based almost entirely on seniority, so such officers were often left in command even when their lack of ability became apparent. Indeed, many of the Italian Army's failures in WWII were rooted in the combined effects of poor equipment too many ineffective officers.


P02406
The Italian Army suffered from a failure in leadership. Junior officers in the Active (regular) Army were proficient, but many middle and higher commanders were WWI veterans too set in their ways. In addition, many battalion and regimental commanders were reservists called back to active duty with insufficient experience in contemporary tactics. To make matters worse, promotions were based almost entirely on seniority, so such officers were often left in command even when their lack of ability became apparent. Indeed, many of the Italian Army's failures in WWII were rooted in the combined effects of poor equipment too many ineffective officers.


P02407
The Italian Army suffered from a failure in leadership. Junior officers in the Active (regular) Army were proficient, but many middle and higher commanders were WWI veterans too set in their ways. In addition, many battalion and regimental commanders were reservists called back to active duty with insufficient experience in contemporary tactics. To make matters worse, promotions were based almost entirely on seniority, so such officers were often left in command even when their lack of ability became apparent. Indeed, many of the Italian Army's failures in WWII were rooted in the combined effects of poor equipment too many ineffective officers.


P02408
The Italian Army suffered from a failure in leadership. Junior officers in the Active (regular) Army were proficient, but many middle and higher commanders were WWI veterans too set in their ways. In addition, many battalion and regimental commanders were reservists called back to active duty with insufficient experience in contemporary tactics. To make matters worse, promotions were based almost entirely on seniority, so such officers were often left in command even when their lack of ability became apparent. Indeed, many of the Italian Army's failures in WWII were rooted in the combined effects of poor equipment too many ineffective officers.


P02409
The Italian Army suffered from a failure in leadership. Junior officers in the Active (regular) Army were proficient, but many middle and higher commanders were WWI veterans too set in their ways. In addition, many battalion and regimental commanders were reservists called back to active duty with insufficient experience in contemporary tactics. To make matters worse, promotions were based almost entirely on seniority, so such officers were often left in command even when their lack of ability became apparent. Indeed, many of the Italian Army's failures in WWII were rooted in the combined effects of poor equipment too many ineffective officers.

P02410
The Italian Army suffered from a failure in leadership. Junior officers in the Active (regular) Army were proficient, but many middle and higher commanders were WWI veterans too set in their ways. In addition, many battalion and regimental commanders were reservists called back to active duty with insufficient experience in contemporary tactics. To make matters worse, promotions were based almost entirely on seniority, so such officers were often left in command even when their lack of ability became apparent. Indeed, many of the Italian Army's failures in WWII were rooted in the combined effects of poor equipment too many ineffective officers.

P02506
The Italian Meridonali Ro.37bis provided good ground support to Nationalist offensives begining in August 1936 the Italians sent several bomber squadrons to aid the Nationalist cause and provided these craft to Nationalist squadrons.  The IMAM (Industrie Meccaniche Aeronautiche Meridionali) Ro 37 was the standard recon plane and for army cooperation duties of the Regia Aeronautica. On June, 10th, 1940, 20 squadrons were equipped with this plane, for a total of 215 planes. Being of obsolete conception they served although on all fronts up to the 1943 armistice.

P02507
 In July 1936 Italy sent a squadron of CR.32 fighters as escort for the two freighters sent to help move the Spanish Legion from Morocco to Spain. Subsequently the Italians sent several fighter and bomber squadrons to aid the Nationalist cause and provided these craft to Nationalist squadrons. The Fiat CR 32 was widely regarded as the best fighter in the Spanish skies. 

P02508 
The Freccia (Arrow) was one of the first Italian monoplane fighters. It proved to be an adequately designed, low-wing monoplane with enclosed cockpit and retractable landing gear. The initial production of the G50 was slow (263 mph or 472km/h) with the 625kW Fiat A.74 RC38 radial engine. Due to the lack of a powerful engine the Italians installed in the G.50V a Daimler-Benz DB601 engine.  They, like most Italian aircraft, were underarmed with only two 12.7 mm machine guns in the wings, at a time when many of the British and American fighters were upgrading to eight 0.50 inch machine guns, and some were augmented with two 20 mm cannons.  The Italians made 780 in total.  12 were used in Spain in 1939.

P02509 
The first model was the SM.79-I reconnaissance bomber, and this saw considerable and effective service with the Aviazione Legionaria (Italian expeditionary force) supporting the Nationalist insurgents led by Franco against the Republican government forces in the Spanish Civil War (1936-39). It gained considerable attention for its effectiveness and reliability noting that only five aircraft were shot down with another four lost on the ground during the entire confict. Its service and reputation in Spain, led to export orders. When Italy joined the war in 1940 its air force had nearly 1,000 bombers, of which well over half were Savoia-Marchetti S.M.79 Sparviero (Hawk) medium bombers. These trimotors, were thought by many to be among the best land-based torpedo bombers of the war. They could carry 1,250 kg (2,750 lb) of bombs internally or two torpedoes.

P02510 
The Savoia-Marchetti S.M.81 Pipistrello (bat) was a development of the Savoia-Marchetti S.M.73 18-pagsenger airliner which had first flown in prototype form on 4 June 1934. Like the airliner from which it was derived, the S.M.81 was a three-engine cantilever low-wing monoplane with fixed tailwheel landing gear. First flown in early 1935, it was available in some numbers by the time that Italy invaded Abyssinia (Ethiopia) on 3 October 1935. Here in addition to its dedicated bomber role, it was used also for reconnaissance and transport. The next operational use of the type came during the Spanish Civil War, with S.M.81s being among the first aircraft provided in support of General Franco, and others served in Spain a little later as components of the Aviazione Legionaria.  Seeing later service during WWII; for that time being outdated it gradually switched its role to transport duties. Capable of a top speed of around 340 km/h was armed with 6x 7,7mm. It had a bombload of up to 2,204 lbs (1000 kg) carried internally.Typical bombload was of 8x250 kg. 

P02511 
The B.R.20, Cicogna,  was a very advanced medium bomber when it appeared in 1936. It was a low-wing monoplane with twin tail fins carrying a 1600kg bombload.  Capable of a top speed of around 430 km/h was armed with 3x 12,7mm. Typical bombload was of 4x250 kg or 2x800 kg. The B.R.20 was used in the Spanish civil war, and 85 were sold to Japan. In WWII service the old aircraft  was extensively used as a day and night bomber but did not do so well, and those that joined German operations in the Battle of Britain and against the USSR suffered heavy losses.  

P02512
Regia Aeronautica fighter-bomber of WWII, the Breda 65 entered service in 1938 and was first used by the Italians in Spain. It was an ugly, fat-looking, low-wing monoplane, intended as a fighter-bomber, but only suitable as a ground attack aircraft. It was produced in two versions, single-seat and double-seat with rear gun. It was well armed but suffered for lack of power and manouvrability, so it wasn't much loved by italian pilots.  It had two 12.7 mm and two 7.7 mm  Breda-SAFAT fixed forward firing machine-guns in the wings, plus up to 300 kg of bombs in fuselage bomb-bay and up to 200 kg of bombs on underwing racks.  It proved to be very vulnerable to modern fighters of the era as it was too slow to outrun them and too unmanoueverable to avoid them. In all only 219 were built. Production started in 1936.  A squadron served in with the Aviazione Legionaria in Spain.  Most of these planes were destroyed during the Wavell offensive in North Africa, December 1940-February 1941 and was was retired in late 1941.

P02513 
The most important italian fighter of WWII, the Macchi C.202 Fighter,  Folgore, was a development of the M.C.200, Saetta redesigned to use a copy of the Daimler-Benz DB601A iquid-cooled inverted V-12 engine. The M.C.202 was still underarmed, but it was superior to the Hurricane and P-40 that the allies were using in the Mediterranean. About 1200 were built. Speed: 595km/h Ceiling: 11000m Range: 760km Armament: 2*mg12.7mm 2*mg7.7mm 2*b160kg

P02514
The Fiat G.55 Fighter,  Centauro was an extensively redesigned development of the G.50 Freccia with the new DB 605A-1 engine, license-built in Italy by Fiat. It had good general performances and was an hard match for allied fighters in 1943-44. Deliveries of the first dozens of Centauros began in June 1943 to 51 and 53 stormo but they had practically no service before Italy's surrender. After September, 8th, 1943, around 150 served with A.N.R. in Northern Italy, fighting side by side with the Luftwaffe. The G.55 was considered the best of the Italian DB605-engined fighters, a powerful and robust high-altitude interceptor.  Production was resumed after after WWII as the G.55A. Speed: 630km/h Ceiling: 12700m Range: 1200km  Armament: 2* mg 12.7mm 3 * g 20mm 2 * 60kg bombs.

P02515  
The Cant Z.1007 Bomber,  Alcione was a product of Cantieri Riuniti dell'Adriatico (Cant) first flown in May 1937. The first aircraft joining Regia Aeronautica in late 1939. A very attractive aircraft with excellent handling qualities and built largely of wood, the Cant Z.1007 suffered from poor defensive armament. The Z.1007bis was used extensively in the Mediterranean, and also for one attack on Britain. Production of the last model, Z.1007ter, was limited. Total production was 564. Crew: 5 Engines: 3 * 1000hp Piaggio P.XI RC40 Speed: 465km/h Ceiling: 7000m Range: 2350km Armament: 2000kg 2*mg12.7mm 2*mg7.7mm
BOMBLOAD: 4,409 lb (2,000 kg) internally, 2,205 lb (1,000 kg) underwing or two 1,000 lb (454 kg) torpedoes 

P02516  
Italian air force (Regia Aeronautica) fighter of WWII, the Macchi C.200 was a monoplane single-seat fighter with radial engine. The M.C.200 originated from the same requirement as the Fiat G.50. It looked similar, had the same virtues and suffered from the same vices: It was a well-designed low-wing monoplane fighter, but underpowered and poorly armed -- the original design was armed with only one 12.7mm gun. Yet the M.C.200 was probably the most used Italian monoplane fighter, and it proved effective against older fighters like the Hurricane. 1153 were built. Very manouvrable was capable of a top speed of around 500 km/h and generally comparable with the Hurricane I. Armed with two 12.7mm guns had provision for small bomb-loading (2 x 100 kg). Served as a fighter and fighter-bomber mainly in the mediterranean area during WWII, in 1940-1943. 

P02517  
The Breda Ba.88 Ground Attack Aircraft, Lince was intended as a twin-engined multi-role fighter-bomber; it performed very well in the flight tests and the first prototypes reached more than one speed record. When equipped with full military installations the airplane showed a general decrease in performance, with great stability problems. The 148 built were briefly used in North Africa before they were retired. Crew: 2 Engines: 2 * 1000hp Piaggio P.XI RC 40
Speed: 490km/h Ceiling: 8000m Range: 1640km 
Armament: 3 * mg12.7mm, 1 * mg7.7mm, 1000kg Bombload

P02518  
The Caproni Ca 313 reconnaissance bomber, and the rest of the Caproni family of twin-engined light planes was extensively used by Regia Aeronautica for transport duties, recon, light bombing and auxiliary roles. There were several variants, Ca 308, 309, 310, 311, 312, 313, 314, 316, with minor differences; some had a solid nose, others a full trasparent one; some had 3 guns, others were unarmed. Served during WWII on almost all fronts. Some were sold to Sweden; it was also used by the Luftwaffe. 215 built. Crew: 3 Engines: 1 * 700hp Isotta Fraschini Delta RC 35 Speed: 463km/h Ceiling: 7300m Range: 1200km Armament: 3*mg7.7mm 400kg Bombload

P02519  
The IMAM (Industrie Meccaniche Aeronautiche Meridionali) or Meridionali Ro.57 Ground Attack Aircraft,was a small sized twin-engined single-seat multi-role plane. Built in small numbers had short service in 1942-43 as a fighter-bomber. When the Ro.57 entered service in 1942 after much delay, it was already obsolete. The Ro.57 was a twin-engined monoplane, designed as fighter, but developed as a ground attack aircraft because it was thought that it would be at a disadvantage when fighting single-engined fighters. Only about 50 were built. Speed: 516km/h Ceiling: 9300m Range: 1200km  Armament: 2 * mg12.7mm

P03002
In 1935, Bulgaria bought 14 L. 3/33 Carro Veloce from Italy, they received the name 'Ansaldo-Fiat', in service with the Bulgarians.  All 14 are used in the Tank Company included in the Second Cycling Battalion, Sofia.  This was their first attempt at "modernizing" the military forces.

ARMAMENT
1 x 8mm Schwarzlose 07/12 machinegun
MAX ARMOR
13.5mm
WEIGHT
3.25 tonnes

P03003
This tank is the Czech Skoda LT vz. 35, of which 26 were first bought from the Wehrmacht in February-April 1940. Another 10 were bought shortly after, but were supposed to have been delivered to Afghanistan, these were armed with the A7 gun, and were classified as the T-11.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm A3 cannon
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
25mm
WEIGHT
10.5 tonnes

P03004
This is the French R-35 light tank, designated 'Renault' in Bulgarian service. There were 40 of this model bought from the Germans in May of 1941.  They equipped the entire Second battalion in the early years, then were relegated to training use by 10/44.

ARMAMENT 
1 x 37mm gun
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
45mm
WEIGHT
10 tonnes

P03007
The Praga 38(t) was the Czech light tank  LT vz 38.  10 of these were purchased from Germany in 1943, instead of the 10 Pz Kpfw III promised, they were used in the 9th Company of the 3rd Battalion. 

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm A7 cannon
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
25mm
WEIGHT
9.7 tonnes

P03010
The Maybach T-IV is the German Pz Kpfw marks G, and H. The Bulgarians gave no distinction between the two, just the designator of Maybach T-IV. Deliveries started in April 1943, and continued until February 1944, with a total of 97 being delivered of both marks, by wars end. These tanks were used in some capacity on into the late 40's.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm L/48 cannon
2-3 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
80mm
WEIGHT
25 tonnes

P03011
The Maybach T-III was the German StuG 40 ausf. G. The first five of these vehicles were delivered to the Bulgarian army in April of 1943. The total number acquired was 55 of these machines. In Bulgarian service, there was an additional 30mm armor to their frontal area. The Maybach T-III was the mainstay in the two formed Assault Gun Battalions.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75 L/48 cannon
1 or 2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
50+30mm
WEIGHT
23.9 tonnes

P03012
The Maybach T-IV is the German Pz Kpfw marks G, and H. The Bulgarians gave no distinction between the two, just the designator of Maybach T-IV. Deliveries started in April 1943, and continued until February 1944, with a total of 97 being delivered of both marks, by wars end. These tanks were used in some capacity on into the late 40's.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm L/48 cannon
2-3 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
80mm
WEIGHT
25 tonnes

P03013
The Bulgarians bought 8 Vickers 6 ton model E, single turret tanks from Great Britain in 1936.  The tanks were deliverd to Bulgaria in the beginning of 1937, equipping the Secon Tank Company, subordinate to the commander of the First Tank Company.  They do not, however form a Battalion until February 1939.  The tanks are given the designation 'Vickers' in Bulgarian service.

ARMAMENT
1 x 47mm QFSA
1 x 7.92mm Vickers machinegun
MAX ARMOR
17mm
WEIGHT
7.12 tonnes

P03014
This tank is the Czech Skoda LT vz. 35, of which 26 were first bought from the Wehrmacht in February-April 1940.  Another 10 were bought shortly after, but were supposed to have been delivered to Afghanistan, these were armed with the A7 gun, and were classified as the T-11.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm A3 cannon
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
25mm
WEIGHT
10.5 tonnes

P03015
This is the German PSW 222 Armored car designated M-222, of which a total of 20 were eventually acquired, between April 1943 and July 1943. Also counted in this figure are the PSW 223 radio command armored car. They were used in the Armored car company of the Recon Battalion, in the Armored Units.

ARMAMENT
1 x 20mm cannon
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
8mm
WEIGHT
4.8 tonnes

P03017
The French Autocannon de 25 CA AA was the 25mm anti-aircraft gun mounted on a light truck. These vehicles were mostly field modifications rather than factory produced. Exact numbers are unknown, but it is generally accepted they were few in number. A few of these were sold to Bulgaria.

ARMAMENT
1 x 25mm gun
MAX ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
7 tonnes

P03022
The Krauss-Maffei Typ KM 11 was the German Sd Kfz. 7 tractor. 24 of these were supplied to the Bulgarian army under plan 43 in June 1943. They were used as artillery tractors for the Russian 122mm D/47 guns (390/1(r) ).

ARMAMENT
none
MAX. ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
10 tonnes

P03023
The Opel Blitz was a German supplied vehicle. I t was the most widely used truck in the Bulgarian Army, over 1,930 were delivered from the period of 1939-1944, a few 4x4 models were delivered also in 1943-1944.

P03024
This unit represents a variable number of horses, wagons and/or artillery limbers used for transport. Throughout the war the vast majority of Bulgarian divisions (i.e., the infantry-type divisions) relied almost entirely on horse-drawn transport.

P03025
This unit represents a number of horses sufficient to carry a platoon of cavalrymen.

P03026
This unit represents a variable number of motorcycles used for the transport of infantry. Comprising many different brands and types, they were used for a variety of purposes but could be found most often affiliated with some type of recon unit.

P03027
This unit represents a variable number of unarmed and unarmored powered boats used to transport infantry and equipment across water.

P03028
This unit represents a variable number of rafts used to transport infantry and equipment across water.

P03029
Bicycles are one of the least demanding forms of transportation available to any army. Requiring neither fuel nor fodder, bicycles can move troops on improved roads about as fast as can be tactically prudent, and are easily discarded at no great loss in the event of prolonged engagement. They do, however, require reasonably well surfaced roads.

P03030
The Bussing-NAG Typ BN 9 was the German Sd Kfz.6 tractor. From February to October 1941, 72 of these were supplied to the Bulgarian Army. They were divided between the Army Artillery Regiments, and the artillery section in the Armored Regiment. They were used to tow the 105mm D/56 and 150mm D/30 Howitzers.

ARMAMENT
none
MAX. ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
7.4 tonnes

P03032
This is the German PSW 223 radio command car designated M-223, of which a few were acquired, between April 1943 and July 1943. They were used in the Armored car company of the Recon Battalion, in the Armored Units.

ARMAMENT
1 x 7.92mm MG34 machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
8mm
WEIGHT
4.4 tonnes

P03033
This is the German PSW 223 radio command car designated M-223, of which a few were acquired, between April 1943 and July 1943. They were used in the Armored car company of the Recon Battalion, in the Armored Units.

ARMAMENT
1 x 7.92mm MG34 machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
8mm
WEIGHT
4.4 tonnes

P03034
This tank is the Czech Skoda LT vz. 35, armed with the Skoda 37mm A-7/L 48, built especially for Afghanistan.  There were 10 of these purchased armed with the A7 gun, and were classified as the T-11.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm A7 cannon
2 x 7.92mm ZB 53 vz.37 machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
25mm
WEIGHT
10.5 tonnes

P03035
This tank is the French H-39 tank, designated 'Hotchkiss' by the Bulgarians.  These 19 tanks were received begrudgingly in March 1944, after basically being forced by the Germans to take them instead of the Pz Kpfw I's requested for training.  They were put to use by the Military Police units for fighting bandits.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm Puteaux SA 18 L/ 21 Gun
1 x 7.5mm MG 31 machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
45mm
WEIGHT
12 tonnes

P03036
The Steyr Iztok was the German Steyr RSO tractor. 40 of these were delivered to Bulgaria on february 1943, under plan 43. Some of these were used in the Artillery Regiment of the Armored Brigade, for towing 75mm anti-tank guns Type 40.

ARMAMENT
none
MAX. ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
3.5 tonnes

P03037
The Tractor Ford maultier Typ V 3000, was the German supplied Maultier, Sd Kfz. 3b. approximately 380 were supplied till June 1943 under Plan 43. They were used to tow 20mm anti-aircraft and 75mm anti-tank guns. All machines were divided in the air-defense batteries and anti-tank battalions of the Infantry Divisions, and in the Armored Brigade.

ARMAMENT
none
MAX. ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
3.9 tonnes

P03038
The Renault AHN was a French truck, under Plan 43, the Bulgarians were supplied with 917 of these. They were used as the other truck types to transport everyday goods, troops, as well as prime movers. They were divided evenly between the various units of the Bulgarian Army.

P03039
The Tractor 'Pavesi' was the Italian Prime mover, Fiat Typ P.4-100 P.C. 30 A.  The Bulgarians received over 100 of these, from 1930-1938. They were used for towing 105mm, 150mm howitzers, and also for 88mm air defense weapons.

P03103
The GrW 34 81mm mortar section represents two 81mm mortars. The mortar was a smoothbore, muzzle loading, and portable weapon that allowed shells to be fired at a high angle of attack. Generally they were broken down into pieces and carried by their crew. In motorized units the mortars were carried in trucks, but in foot-infantry units they could be transported in wagons. The GrW 34 lacked the range of the U.S. 81mm mortar but fired a heavier shell.

MAX. RANGE
2200m
SHELL WEIGHT
3.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
56.7kg

P03104
The GrW 34 81mm  mortar was a smoothbore, muzzle loading, and portable weapon that allowed shells to be fired at a high angle of attack. Generally they were broken down into pieces and carried by their crew. In motorized units the mortars were carried in trucks, but in foot-infantry units they could be transported in wagons. The GrW 34 lacked the range of the U.S. 81mm mortar but fired a heavier shell.

MAX. RANGE
2200m
SHELL WEIGHT
3.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
56.7kg

P03105
The mle 27/31 81mm Mortar was designed by the Edgar Brandt company. This represents a section of two such tubes. The Bulgarian Army received numerous amounts of these as war booty from the Germans, and continued to use them as supplies allowed. The 81mm mortar could fire light and heavy bombs, and smoke.

MAX RANGE
2850m
SHELL WEIGHT
3.25kg & 6.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
59.7kg

P03106
The mle 27/31 81mm Mortar was designed by the Edgar Brandt company. The Bulgarian Army received numerous amounts of these as war booty from the Germans, and continued to use them as supplies allowed. The 81mm mortar could fire light and heavy bombs, and smoke.

MAX RANGE
2850m
SHELL WEIGHT
3.25kg & 6.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
59.7kg

P03107
The PaK 35/36 37mm was the standard German anti-tank weapon at the beginning of the war. It was a relatively light weapon that could be pushed around for short distances by its crew and due to its small size, it was easy to conceal. The Bulgarians received numbers of these in 1941, and even used them well after they were obsolete in desperation.

ARMOR PENETRATION
50mm at 500m (APCR ammo)
SHELL WEIGHT
0.97kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
435kg

P03108
The PaK 35/36 37mm was the standard German anti-tank weapon at the beginning of the war. It was a relatively light weapon that could be pushed around for short distances by its crew and due to its small size, it was easy to conceal. The Bulgarians received numbers of these in 1941, and even used them well after they were obsolete in desperation.

ARMOR PENETRATION
50mm at 500m (APCR ammo)
SHELL WEIGHT
0.97kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
435kg

P03109
This was the KPUV vz 37 37mm Anti-Tank Gun built by Skoda. It was a modern and efficient design for the late 1930's, but by 1941 it was obsolete . The Bulgarians purchased many of these guns in 1941, and continued to use them as necessary.

ARMOR PENETRATION
35mm at 500m
SHELL WEIGHT
0.85kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
370kg

P03110
The 105mm Gun 336(j),was the Yugoslavian 105mm M.13 Howitzer. Numbers of these guns were sold and/or appropriated as war booty by the Bulgarians. These were used in Bulgarian coastal Artillery units.

MAX RANGE
16,000m
SHELL WEIGHT
?kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1627-1722kg

P03111
The 105mm Gun 338(j),was the Yugoslavian 105mm M.35 Howitzer. Numbers of these guns were sold and/or appropriated as war booty by the Bulgarians. These were used in Bulgarian coastal Artillery units.

MAX RANGE
17,500m
SHELL WEIGHT
?kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1627-1722kg

P03112
The mle 36 APX 47mm Anti-Tank Gun was French war booty received from the Germans. They were used mostly in 2nd line units, and weren't found very often in use, as other types replaced them.

ARMOR PENETRATION
89mm at 500m
SHELL WEIGHT
1.725kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1070kg

P03113
This unit represents a platoon of three towed German supplied PaK 38 50mm anti-tank guns. These guns were supplied to the Bulgarians in july 1943. Despite being some 200kg heavier than the 37mm anti-tank gun, the PaK 38 could still be manhandled by its crew.

ARMOR PENETRATION
120mm at 500m (APCR ammo)
SHELL WEIGHT
2.73kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
986kg

P03114
The PaK 97/38 was a 75mm anti-tank gun based on the famous Model 1897 French field piece. In 1941, when the standard German anti-tank guns were found to be ineffective against the Russian T-34 and KV tanks, some 700 of these French gun barrels were adapted to the PaK 38 carriage, thus creating the PaK 97/38. The German supplied the Bulgarians with numbers of these, as they phased them out in favor of other, more powerful guns.

ARMOR PENETRATION
75mm at 500m
SHELL WEIGHT
5.98kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1190kg

P03115
The PaK 40 was a 75mm anti-tank gun introduced at the start of 1942. Basically it was an enlarged version of the PaK 38 50mm gun. It proved to be a very successful design, and remained the standard divisional anti-tank gun for the remainder of the war. One drawback was its weight, which was too great to allow its crew to manhandle it. This made it difficult to change positions quickly to meet new enemy threats. The Bulgarians received numbers of these guns in July 1943.

ARMOR PENETRATION
154mm at 500m (APCR ammo)
SHELL WEIGHT
9.55kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1425kg

P03116
The Canone de 75mm TR, was of Belgian design, and many were incorporated into the Bulgarian Infantry Artillery Regiments.

MAX RANGE
8000m
SHELL WEIGHT
6.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1050kg

P03117
The 75mm FK-Krupp Schneider, was an early designed Field howitzer incorporated into the Bulgarian Infantry Artillery Regiments.

MAX RANGE
5250m
SHELL WEIGHT
6.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
508kg

P03118
The leFH 18 105mm Howitzer was an artillery piece capable of direct or indirect fire. It was well praised for its ease of setup, rate of fire, and reliability. The Germans Supplied the Bulgarian Army with this gun for use in the Artillery Regiments.

MAX. RANGE
10670m
SHELL WEIGHT
14.8kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1985kg

P03119
The Obusier de 105 GP was of Belgian origin, Numbers of these guns were sold and/or appropriated as war booty by the Bulgarians. 

MAX RANGE
11,000m
SHELL WEIGHT
16.3kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2336kg

P03120
The sFH Krupp L30 1939 150mm Howitzer, was the German 15cm Kanone 39. This was a dual purpose gun, for use in the field on a split-trail carriage, or in the coast defense mode, on a special turntable platform.

MAX RANGE
24,700m
SHELL WEIGHT
43kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
12,200kg

P03122
The Skoda Model 15 75mm Mtn Howitzer was the Skoda vz 15, one of the most successful and widely used of all mountain guns. It first entered service with the Austro-Hungarian Army, and after 1918 passed into service with the Czech, Austrian and Hungarian armies as well as those of several other nations. 

MAX. RANGE
7000m
SHELL WEIGHT
6.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
620kg

P03123
The French mle 17 S 155mm Howitzer C 17 S was originally designed as a 152mm howitzer for Czarist Russia. These guns were supplied to the Bulgarians by their German Allies.

MAX RANGE
11,300m
SHELL WEIGHT
43.6kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
3300kg

P03124
The FlaK 38 20mm was a single-barreled anti-aircraft weapon. The Bulgarian Army acquired many of these from the Germans under the "Barbara" program, in 1943.

MAX. EFFECTIVE CEILING
2000m
SHELL WEIGHT
0.3kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
405kg

P03125
The Madsen 20mm Anti-Aircraft Gun was a Danish light AA weapon. Bulgaria was one of many countries who purchased the weapon for their armories.

MAX. EFFECTIVE CEILING
1500m
SHELL WEIGHT
0.12kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
295kg

P03126
The FlaK 36 37mm was a single barreled anti-aircraft weapon. It had an automatic action that operated off of gas pressure and barrel recoil. It took a multi-round ammo clip that allowed the gun to have a practical rate of fire of 80 rounds per minute. Mounted on a triangular platform it was generally carried by a two-wheeled trailer. The Bulgarian Army acquired many of these from the Germans under the "Barbara" program, in 1943.

MAX. EFFECTIVE CEILING
2000m
SHELL WEIGHT
0.635kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1544kg

P03127
The Letov vz32 75mm Anti-Aircraft Gun was a Skoda 75mm AA-AT dual purpose weapon.

MAX. EFFECTIVE CEILING
9750m
SHELL WEIGHT
6.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2545kg

P03128
The FlaK 37 was a three-piece barrelled 88mm anti-aircraft weapon. The 37 model of the '88' differed in the system of Selsyn synchronous motors, for gunlaying ease. The Bulgarian Army acquired many of these from the Germans under the "Barbara" program, in 1943.

MAX. EFFECTIVE CEILING
9900m
SHELL WEIGHT
9-9.6kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
4985kg

P03129
The H vz 14/19 100mm Howitzer was the Skoda vz 14/19. Essentially a revised and updated version of the vz 14, the Bulgarians had numbers of these available early in the war.

MAX. RANGE
9800m
SHELL WEIGHT
16kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1490kg

P03130
The Skoda 37mm anti-aircraft gun was, in fact a dual purpose AA-AT weapon. The Bulgarians purchased numbers of these early in their rearmament.

MAX. EFFECTIVE CEILING
3000m
SHELL WEIGHT
.785kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2100kg

P03131
The 105mm Gun 331(f),was the French mle 35 B 105mm Howitzer. Numbers of these guns were sold and/or appropriated as war booty by the Bulgarians. These were used in Bulgarian coastal Artillery units.

MAX RANGE
10,700m
SHELL WEIGHT
15.6kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1627-1722kg

P03132
The Russian 122mm Gun 390/1 (r) was an excellent design. This gun, provided as booty by the Germans to the Bulgarian army, was employed both in the field, and in coastal positions.

MAX. RANGE
11,800m
SHELL WEIGHT
21.76kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2450kg

P03133
The GrW 42 120mm mortar was basically a direct copy of the excellent Russian 120mm mortar. Due to its weight it could not be carried by its crew, so like its Soviet counterpart it came with a small two-wheeled trailer that allowed it to be towed by a vehicle. Generally four mortars could be found in the mortar platoon of the infantry battalion. The Bulgarian army received a number of these mortars from the Wehrmacht in July of 1943.

MAX. RANGE
6050m
SHELL WEIGHT
16kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
281kg

P03134
The 155mm Gun 418(f) was the 155mm GPF gun from French inventory. They were used in Bulgarian coast artillery units.

MAX RANGE
18,600m
SHELL WEIGHT
43kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
10,750kg

P03135
The Russian 122mm Gun 390/1 (r) was an excellent design. This gun, provided as booty by the Germans to the Bulgarian army, was employed both in the field, and in coastal positions.

MAX. RANGE
11,800m
SHELL WEIGHT
21.76kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2450kg

P03136
The 220mm Gun 531(f) was a French 220mm cannon, used in Bulgarian coast artillery.

MAX RANGE
22,800m
SHELL WEIGHT
103.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
25,000kg

P03137
The mle 27/31 81mm Mortar was designed by the Edgar Brandt company. The Bulgarian Army received numerous amounts of these as war booty from the Germans, and continued to use them as supplies allowed. The 81mm mortar could fire light and heavy bombs, and smoke.

MAX RANGE
2850m
SHELL WEIGHT
3.25kg & 6.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
59.7kg

P03138
The GrW 34 81mm  mortar was a smoothbore, muzzle loading, and portable weapon that allowed shells to be fired at a high angle of attack. Generally they were broken down into pieces and carried by their crew. In motorized units the mortars were carried in trucks, but in foot-infantry units they could be transported in wagons. The GrW 34 lacked the range of the U.S. 81mm mortar but fired a heavier shell.

MAX. RANGE
2200m
SHELL WEIGHT
3.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
56.7kg

P03139
The sFH Krupp L30 1939 150mm Howitzer, was the German 15cm Kanone 39. This was a dual purpose gun, for use in the field on a split-trail carriage, or in the coast defense mode, on a special turntable platform.

MAX RANGE
24,700m
SHELL WEIGHT
43kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
12,200kg

P03140
The Obusier de 105 GP was of Belgian origin, Numbers of these guns were sold and/or appropriated as war booty by the Bulgarians. 

MAX RANGE
11,000m
SHELL WEIGHT
16.3kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2336kg

P03141
The 152mm Howitzer 445(r) was the Russian 152mm Obr.37. Numbers of this excellent gun were provided to the Bulgarian army.

MAX. RANGE
17,265m
SHELL WEIGHT
43.56kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
7128kg

P03201
This unit represents the typical early rifle platoon in the Bulgarian Army. Generally there were the usual 3 squads of troops, anywhere from 33-40 soldiers, armed with a variety of rifles, from the 8mm Mannlicher, to the Mauser, Lebel, and even Soviet rifles. Also there were German supplied grenades, but the LMG's were supplied to the company level at 2-3 per company. Also included would be AT-rifles, and some ZK 383 submachine guns.

P03202
This unit represents a Mountain Infantry Platoon in the Bulgarian Mountain Brigade.  Similarly equipped as the regular infantry unit, they seem to have been disbanded by 1944.

P03203
This unit represents the engineer platoon of the Bulgarian Army. These would be armed with a variety of rifles, submachine guns, satchel charges, and flamethrowers.  The primary function was to take out bunkers, and other obstacles, but be able to function as a rifle unit also.

P03204
This unit represents a Schwarzlose MG section of 2 weapons.

P03205
This unit represents a Schwarzlose MG platoon of 4 weapons.

P03206
This unit represents a Bulgarian Cavalry Platoon. They were equipped with carbines, grenades, and Light machine guns.

P03207
This unit represents the Motorcycle platoon, used mostly in the recon units.

P03208 
This unit represents the Motorcycle Machinegun Platoon, of the recon units. They usually consisted of 4 weapons, with accompanying crews.

P03209
This unit represents the ATR platoon of the Bulgarian Army. They used the 20mm Solothurn, and German Panzerbuchse 39 models.

P03210
This unit represents a MG34 platoon of 4 weapons on tripods.

P03211
This unit represents a MG34 Section of 3 weapons on tripods.

P03212
This unit represents the typical 1944 rifle platoon in the Bulgarian Army. Generally there were the usual 3 squads of troops, anywhere from 33-40 soldiers, armed with a variety of rifles, from the 8mm Mannlicher, to the Mauser, Lebel, and even Soviet rifles. There were German supplied grenades, but the LMG's were supplied to the company level at 2-3 per company. Also included now would be a number of the Panzerfaust anti-tank launchers from Germany, and some ZK 383 submachine guns.

P03213
This unit represents the LMG sections of the Bulgarian Infantry Companies.  There were anywhere from 2-4 LMG's in this unit, using a variety of different weapons, such as the 8mm Madsen, .303 inch, and the LMG34.

P03214
This unit represents the Frontier rifle platoon. They were equipped similiar to the regular rifle units, but were primarily used to guard their borders.

P03215
This unit represents the Military Police platoons, of the Military Police company attached to each Infantry Division in the Bulgarian Army.

P03216
This unit represents the motorcycle rider Military Police platoons, of the Military Police company attached to each Infantry Division in the Bulgarian Army.

P03238
This unit represents various forms of pack animals, be it horses, mules, or otherwise. Many countries used this form of conveyance in rough terrain, where the use of wheeled or other transport was either unavailable, or unable to be used under rough conditions.

P03307
This unit represents the Army level of command in the Bulgarian Army.

P03306
This unit represents the Corps level of command in the Bulgarian Army.

P03301
This unit represents the Divisional level of command in the Bulgarian Army.

P03302
This unit represents the Brigade level of command in the Bulgarian Army.

P03303
This unit represents the Regimental level of command in the Bulgarian Army.

P03304
This unit represents the Leg Battalion level of command in the Bulgarian Army.

P03305
This unit represents the Motorized Battalion level of command in the Bulgarian Army.

P03401
This represents the individual commanders of a Bulgarian unit.

P03402
This represents the individual commanders of a Bulgarian unit.

P03403
This represents the individual commanders of a Bulgarian unit.

P03404
This represents the individual commanders of a Bulgarian unit.

P03405
This represents the individual commanders of a Bulgarian unit.

P03406
This represents the individual commanders of a Bulgarian unit.

P03407
This represents the individual commanders of a Bulgarian unit.

P03408
This represents the individual commanders of a Bulgarian unit.

P03409
This represents the individual commanders of a Bulgarian unit.

P03410
This represents the individual commanders of a Bulgarian unit.

P03501
The Bf 109E-4 was a German supplied fighter under the Plan 43.

ARMAMENT
2 x 7.92mm MG17 Machineguns
2 x 20mm MG FF Cannon

P03502
The Ju 87D was a German supplied dive-bomber, there were 32 of the D-5 variant in the AF.

ARMAMENT
2 x 7.9mm MG 17 Machineguns
1,800 kg Bomb-load

P03503
The Avia B 534.IV was a Czech-built Fighter, Bulgaria had 48 of these bi-winged craft in their Air Force.

ARMAMENT
4 x 7.7mm MK 30 Machineguns

P03504
The Ju 87R-2/R-4 was a German supplied dive-bomber, there were 12 of this B-1 variant in their AF.

ARMAMENT
2 x 7.9mm MG 17 Machineguns
500 kg Bomb-load

P03505
The Bf 109G-6/G-10 was a German Fighter supplied under the Plan 43.

ARMAMENT
Either of following;
2 x 7.92mm MG17 Machineguns, or
2 x 13,, MG131 Machineguns
1 x 30mm MK 108 Cannon

P03506
The Bf 109G-2 was a German supplied Fighter/Bomber under the Plan 43.

ARMAMENT
1 x 20mm MG151/20 Cannon
2 x 7.92mm MG17 Machineguns
1 x 250 kg Bomb

P03507
The PZL. P43 Czajka was a Polish made to order Light Bomber used from 1941 through-out the end of the war for Bulgaria. It was used in four bomber-reconnaissance squadrons, with limited operational scale service.

ARMAMENT
2 x 7.7mm KM Wz 36 Machineguns
700 kg Bomb-load underwing

P03508
The PZL. P43 Czajka was a Polish made to order Light Bomber used from 1941 through-out the end of the war for Bulgaria. It was used in four bomber-reconnaissance squadrons, with limited operational scale service.

ARMAMENT
2 x 7.7mm KM Wz 36 Machineguns
700 kg Bomb-load underwing

P04001
The FT-17 Tankette was of WWI design. With its rear engine compartment and turret-mounted armament, it pioneered the layout for all future tank designs. The first FT-17 tanks were aquired from France in 1921. They took part in the Rif war. Some of these tanks were still in service when the Civil war broke out. It operated with the Nationalist 2nd Tank Regiment in 1936 in Aragon and outide of Madrid, but were soon outclassed and supplanted by newer tanks. Though obsolete by the 1930's these vehicles continued to soldier on due to the lack of armored vehicles. 

ARMAMENT
1 x 7mm machinegun
or
1 x 37mm gun?
MAX ARMOR
16mm
WEIGHT
6.7 tonnes


P04002
The Trubia was an indigenous tank design heavily influenced by the FT-17. Though this vehicle was approved for full production, budget constraints limited numbers to six. Three of these vehicles taken in Oviedo operated with the Nationalist 2nd Tank Regiment in 1936 in Aragon and outide of Madrid, but were soon outclassed by newer tanks. The tank was designed by army officer Captain Ruiz de Toledo, and built by Trubia in 1926 (hence the name). 

ARMAMENT
1 x 40mm gun
2 x 7mm machineguns
or
3 x 7mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
15mm
WEIGHT
6 tonnes


P04003
The T-26 was the most powerful armored vehicle on the Spanish battlefield (with the exception of the rare BT-5). Around 300 of these tanks were shipped to Spain by the Soviet Union beginning in October 1936. The first T-26 were operated by Soviet-Spanish crews and later all Spanish crews. Though  the arrival of Russian tanks in the Republican arsenal gave the Loyalists considerable armoured superiority as the cannon bearing T-26 Bs greatly outclassed the Italian and German light tanks being supplied to the Nationalists. However, poor tactics led the Republic to squander most of these tanks in costly armoured assaults, unsupported by infantry, or to diffuse their offensive capability by allotting them to static defense or infantry support roles. Though most T-26 Bs were found in Republican service, the Nationalist troops resorted to a number of measures to capture these tanks, going so far as to offer a bounty for each tank captured intact, as the only means of achieving armoured parity with the Republicans.  Poor performace of tanks in the Spanish civil war reinforced the opinion held by many armies (France in particular) that tanks were best used for infantry support. T-26 light tanks were based on a British Vickers-Armstrong design imported into the Soviet Union in 1930. Typically employed by tank units as close support for infantry, 1200 T-26s were produced from 1931 to 1941, more than the total tank production of France and Germany combined. Most of these were the T-26 Model 1933s, and T-26 Model 1937s, which are represented together in the game.  Right up to the beginning of the war with Germany in 1941, the main gun on this tank was more powerful than most tanks in the German army. A good - solid tank, it's only drawback was the poor maintenance practices of the Red Army compounded by poor conditions and supplies in Spain  The Spanish designation for this tank was Carro Ligero de Infanteria T-26 B. 

ARMAMENT
1 x 45mm gun
1-3 x 7.62mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
25mm
WEIGHT
10 tonnes


P04004
The PzKpfw IB was the first and the smallest of Germany's mass-produced tanks. Production started in 1934, and by 1937 it had already seen combat in the Spanish Civil War. Along with Condor Legion advisors, a good number of these German tanks were supplied to the Nationalist army where they formed some of the first Nationalist armoured battalions. Though intended as a training vehicle, having only a two-man crew, twin machine guns on a rotating turret and lightly armoured compared to the Russian T-26 B, the Pz. IB was still utilized on a number of fronts in Spain. However, the inability of Nationalist light tanks to stand up to Russian armour in the field led Nationalist officers to develop tactics based on artillery rather than tank striking force. The French doctrine of tanks as infantry support maintained its hold on Spanish tactics.  The Nationalists resorted to capturing T-26 and BT-5 tanks to blolster thier armour formations.  Some later Spanish versions of this tank were actually supplied with a 20mm canon instead of the twin Dreyse 7.92 mm. machine guns. Though initially manned by German Condor Legion personnel, these vehicles were very quickly turned over to Spanish Nationalist troops. The Spanish designation for this tank was Carro Ligero Pz Kpfw I uasf. B. but it was nicknamed "Negrillo".

ARMAMENT
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
13mm
WEIGHT
5.8 tonnes


P04005
A total of 50 BT series tanks arrived in Spain in August of 1937. They formed the equipment of the elite International heavy tank regiment. They were considered by the Soviet advisers to be the most modern and best tanks in Spain, and were held in reserve through the late summer and early autumn, waiting for a major opportunity to exploit their capabilities. For many of the Soviet advisors in Spain, the International Tank Regiment was the last, best hope to display the power of tanks on the modern battlefield. These hopes would be crushed in the autumn of 1937 during the Saragossa campaign. Almost all the first BT-5s were lost at Fuentes del Ebro and later replacements were later squandered just as recklessly at Teruel. A few BT-5s were captured by the Nationalists and were used by them in formations with captured T-26 Bs.  Like the T-26, the BT-5s supplied to the Spanish were probably equipped with radios though the Spanish crews seemed to have removed these, preferring signal flags. Its roomy interior, quick speed, and dual tracked/wheeled propulsion system were welcomed by its crews and made it more popular than the T-26 B. BT-5 light tanks featured a suspension based on that of the American Christie convertible tank. The suspension of these vehicles were designed to be operated without tracks on roads, which reduced track wear and the possibility of track failure. The tracks could then be fitted for use across terrain. The resulting speed of such a flexible design found the BT series normally assigned to independent tank brigades or to cavalry formations rather than to the slower infantry.  Some 7,000 BT series tanks were produced during the period 1932-41 in many variants, the most numerous being the 45mm gunned versions represented in the game.  The Spanish designation for this tank was Carro Medio Rapido BT-5. 



ARMAMENT
1 x 45mm gun
1-3 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
22mm
WEIGHT
14 tonnes


P04006
The Italian Fiat-AnsaldoCarro Veloce 3-35 fast tank was developed along the lines of the British Carden-Loyd Mk VI and first appeared as the L3/33 in 1933, but was retrofitted in 1935 and became the L3/35. It was the most common Italian AFV to be found in the Spanish Civil War. With the Nationalists petitioning for material support, Mussolini sent Italian tank advisors along with the CV 3-35s in September, 1936 and the Italians soon entered battle dressed in the uniforms of the Spanish Foreign Legion. Later, Spanish Nationalist crews were trained to take over operation of the tankettes while more CV 3-35s arrived as part of Italian units operating independently. Many of these tankettes were lost or captured during the battle of Guadalajara where the CV 3-35, armed only with a machine gun, showed itself unable to stand up to cannon bearing Russian T-25s used by the Republican Forces. The Spanish designation for this tank was Carro Ligero Rapido CV 3-35.

ARMAMENT
2 x 8mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
15mm
WEIGHT
3.5 tonnes


P04007
The L3 Lf ("Lanciafiamme"; flamethrower) was another variant of the L3. Development began in 1935. The flamethrower nozzle replaced one of the machineguns, and the flame fuel was carried in an armored trailer towed by the tankette. Later versions had the fuel carried in a box-shaped tank mounted above the L3's engine compartment.  This Italian flamethrower tankette featured prominently in fighting by Italian troops at Guadalajara where they inflicted considerable damage on defending Republican soldiers. However, constrained to the roads by bad weather, many of these tanks were destroyed or captured by the Republican counter offensive. Spanish designation for this tank was Carro Ligero Rapido CV 3-35 version Lanzallamas. 

ARMAMENT
1x flamethrower
1 x 8mm machine gun
MAX. ARMOR
15mm
WEIGHT
5 tonnes


P04008
The first use of this Soviet armoured car was in the Northern Campaigns where Navarese Requets fighting their way into Bilbao, encountered defending Basques using this vehicle and other Soviet equipment which had been sent to try and save the city. After the fighting, the Nationalists took the BA-6 into their own arsenal.  BA-6 heavy armored cars, although a 1930s design based on a 6x4 truck chassis , remained the standard Soviet heavy armored car throughout the second world war. They mounted a 45mm gun in an enclosed turret.  This vehicle had a crew of 4. Spanish designation was Autoblindado BA-6. 

ARMAMENT
1 x 45mm gun
1 x 7.62mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
15mm
WEIGHT
5.1 tonnes

 
P04009
This unit represents the Nationalist armoured vehicle that was used as a primitive armoured assault car and carried up to 12 men who held onto handholds in the back and jumped off as the truck crashed into an objective or they were simply carried as close as possible to the fighting whereupon the disembarking passengers would attack while the truck provided mobile support with its machine guns and 81mm mortar. Utilizing 3 hatches in its box like top, to fire the mortar, the crew of 14 plus men would have to expose themselves, while machine gun fire could be provided through forward slits.

ARMAMENT
1 x 81mm mortar
1 x machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
14.5mm


P04010
SdKfz7 was the German prime mover for the famous 88mm AA and AT gun. An unknown number were sent to Spain during the war with the Condor Legion.


P04012
This unit represents a group of about 6 trucks used by Republican forces. These trucks would have been from various sources, both military and commercial.


P04013
This unit represents a group of about 6 trucks used by Republican forces. These trucks would have been from various sources, both military and commercial.


P04014
This unit represents a group of horse-drawn wagons used by Republican forces. These wagons would have been from various sources, both military and commercial.


P04015
This unit represents a group of horses used by Nationalist forces. The Nationalists were strong in cavalry. This was mostly due to the bulk of the army and Legion units going over to the rebel cause. 


P04016
This unit represents small boats used for crossing small bodies of water such as rivers or lakes.


P04017
This unit represents rafts for carrying infantry across small bodies of water.


P04019
At the outbreak of the Civil War, the shipyards of Valencia immediately began military production. The Russian engineer Nikolai N. Alymov was entrusted with the design of a new armored car. This vehicle was based on the FA/BA series, but in many ways the vehicle was superior with better mobility and a better hull design. The vehicle was produced from January 1937 into the 1950's, and used by the victorious Nationalists.

ARMAMENT
2 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
8-9mm
WEIGHT
2-3 tons


P04021
The Lancia 1ZM Armored Car began development in 1912. It saw action in World War I, and in 1928 was fitted with more modern machineguns. An interesting feature of the IZM was a set of rails that allowed the vehicle to drive through and cut barbed wire. The vehicle saw action in Ethiopia, during the Spanish Civil War, and in Italian East Africa. This vehicle performed well against poorly trained and armed troops in the fairly open countryside and hills of Andalucia in the drive for Mlaga, but again was outclassed by the heavier modern Soviet tanks making their debut in the Republican arsenal. The IZII was maintained by up to six crewmen. Spanish designation for this vehicle was Autoametralladora Lancia Ansaldo IZII

ARMAMENT
2 x 8mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
6mm
WEIGHT
4 tonnes


P04022
The Bilbao M32 Armored Car was based on  the Dodge  1930 truck. It carried one machinegun: in the front of the turret, and one each at the rear of the turret and hull. The body had a strong appearance although the armour was poor, access doors could be opened from both ends, and there were 6 shielded windows along the front and sides plus a seventh rear window. The rear hull was extended by a bin for luggage and spares.  On the centre of the roof was a fully rotateable cylindrical turret, with a flat mantles with a ball and socket for the 7mm Hotchkiss 1924 MMG, it had upright spotting slots and an access lid on the top.  The Bilbao was produced through 2 series, the first of 36 vehicles were supplied to the 18 assault guard companies, and a second series of 14 supplied to the cavalry "Grupo de auto ametalladoras - canon". 

ARMAMENT
1 x 7mm Hotchkiss 1924 machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
3mm
WEIGHT
5.2 tonnes


P04025
Spain aquired at 20  StuG IIIG assault gun in 1944 for an experimental assault gun Company.  It was based on previous versions of the PzKpfw III chassis. The original StuG III had been designed as an infantry support tank, but by 1943, StuGs were being used increasingly in an anti-tank role. This was made possible by the introduction of a longer barreled 75mm cannon and additional armor. The G model was the most common StuG built. Production started in late 1942 and continued through the end of the war, with some 7800 examples produced. In the game this unit also represents the earlier F and F/8 models, of which 359 and 354 were built respectively..

ARMAMENT
1 x 75 L/48 cannon
1 or 2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
80mm
WEIGHT
23.9 tonnes


P04027
Spain aquired at least 20 PzKpfw IVH in 1944 for its one Armoured Division.  It was the next evolutionary step in the development of the Pz IV series. It featured a substantial increase in the front armor and a longer, more powerful L/48main gun. The Model H was by far the most numerous of the series, with 3774 produced. In addition, this unit represents part of the production run of the Pz IVG with the new gun and increased armor, plus the 1758 PzKpfw IVJ that were built subsequent to the Pz IVH. Having been built from October 1937 through March 1945, the Pz IV was the only German tank to remain in production throughout the war, proving the soundness of its design.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm L/48 cannon
2-3 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
80mm
WEIGHT
25 tonnes


P04034
This unit represents a group of horses used by Morrocan Nationalist forces and provides distinctive Morrocan cavalry when mounted. The Morrocans provided good cavalry units. 


P04034
This unit represents a group of pack horses.  Able to traverse difficult going with the cavalry and infantry where wheeled traffic could not pack horses were used for carrying mortars, machineguns, and Mountain guns for the Mountain Infantry and Cavalry units. 


P04101
This was a 50mm light mortar of pre-war domestic design used by both sides in the Spanish Civil war or a 45mm mortar of Italian design used in the later part of the war by the Nationalists.


P04102
Possessed by both sides, 81mm mortars became more popular than the 51mm as the war progressed. The mle 27/31 81mm Mortar was designed by the Edgar Brandt company. The 81mm mortar could fire light and heavy bombs, and smoke.

MAX RANGE
2850m
SHELL WEIGHT
3.25kg & 6.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
59.7kg


P04103
As the access to French Ordnance became more restricted to both sides, the Nationalists were supplied 8cm GrW 34 by the Germans. 

MAX. RANGE
2200m
SHELL WEIGHT
3.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
56.7kg


P04106
Supplied to the Nationalists, this gun was featured in the fighting for Madrid. Also, a common element of the Italian forces at Guadalahara, many of these guns were captured by the Republic. The Cannone da 65/17 dated back to 1913, when it was first used as a mountain gun by the Alpini troops. By mid-1940 this 65mm piece was the standard infantry support weapon of the Italian Army. Infantry regiments in regular and Autotrasportabile (truckable) infantry divisions were each allocated one battery of four 65/17 guns, as was each Blackshirt Legion. About 700 were in service in 1940.

MAX. RANGE
6500m
SHELL WEIGHT
4.2kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
556kg


P04107
The PaK 35/36 37mm was provided early on to the Nationalists was the standard German anti-tank weapon at the beginning of WW2.  This gun was used both by the Italians and the Spanish Nationalists. Captured models were acquired by the Republicans after Guadalahara. The Cannone-cc da 37/45 anti-tank gun was the German 37mm PaK 35/36 built under license by the Italians. 
It was a relatively light weapon that could be pushed around for short distances by its crew and due to its small size, it was easy to conceal.

ARMOR PENETRATION
48mm at 500m
SHELL WEIGHT
0.97kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
435kg


P04108
The FlaK 18 was a single barreled 88mm anti-aircraft weapon. One of the more famous weapons developed by Germany, it first entered service in the mid 1930s. Originally intended strictly for anti-aircraft purposes only, it was soon discovered that its rapid rate of fire and pinpoint accuracy allowed it to accomplish many jobs.  The escalation of German involvement in the Spanish conflict saw the field use of some of their best equipment in the test of actual battle experience. "88" guns shipped to Spain were serviced by Condor Legion personnel, maintaining the guns for use in Franco's offensive. It was in Spain that the Germans realized the "88's" potent anti-tank capabilities. 

MAX. EFFECTIVE CEILING
10,600m
SHELL WEIGHT
9-9.6kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
5150kg


P04109
The sK 18 105mm was the standard medium artillery gun. It used the same mount as the sFH 18, but supported a much longer barrel. Originally developed in the late 1920s it entered service in 1933. It was a large weapon for its caliber size, and difficult to operate off-road unless some type of mechanized assistance was available.  Supplied to Nationalists or manned by Condor Legion personnel. 

MAX. RANGE
19000m
SHELL WEIGHT
15.14kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
5642kg


P04110
The mle 35 B 105mm Howitzer was the design chosen to replace France's WWI-vintage 155mm howitzers.  This unit also represents the similar 105 C mle 34 S. 

MAX RANGE
10,700m
SHELL WEIGHT
15.6kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1627-1722kg


P04111
The Famous "French 75" saw considerable use by both sides in the Spanish Civil War. The mle 1897 75mm Field Gun was the famous Model 1897 field piece, the first gun with a modern recoil system and fast-acting breech block. It revolutionized field artillery, and became the most widely used field gun ever produced. 

MAX RANGE
11,100m
SHELL WEIGHT
6.2kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1140kg


P04112
Exported to the Nationalists, the Cannone da 75/27 75mm field gun was the standard light field piece in the artillery regiment of most Italian divisions during the war. This gun actually represents four pre-WWI gun types; the 75/27 m06, m11 and m12, and the 77/28. The m06 was a Krupp design built under license; the m11 was a French import; the m12 was a modified m06. The Skoda-built 77/28 was a combination field/mountain gun that was allocated to Italy's two Libyan divisions. A battery consisted of four guns. Over 3000 were in service by 1940.

MAX. RANGE
10240m
SHELL WEIGHT
6.35kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
900-1080kg


P04113
This is weapon was probably also supplied to the the Spanish Republic. P obr. 02/30 76mm field guns were modernized pieces dating from the days of Tsar Nicholas II. A confusing array of more efficient propellants and projectiles were specified for the updated guns, which combined with the fact that some cases longer barrels were fitted as well led to the necessity of issuing four different range tables for one type of gun. Many 02/30s were still in service at the beginning of the war, a good number of them seeing service with the Germans as well.

MAX. RANGE
13,290m (L40)
SHELL WEIGHT
6.4kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1350kg (L/40)


P04114
This gun was utilized by both sides in the Spanish Civil War. The mle 13 S 105mm Field Gun was based on a Russian 107mm design. First produced in 1914, some 897 of these pieces were available in May 1940, used mainly as corps artillery. The Nationalists used it in the battles for the Guadarrama Mountains.

MAX RANGE
12,000m
SHELL WEIGHT
15.7kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2300kg


P04115
This weapon is included to represent Italian weapons captured by the Republicans and subsequently used. The Cannone da 105/28 field howitzer was a license-built version of the French 105mm mle 1913 (also known as the L 13 S). It was used by the Italians primarily as corps artillery, and occasionally was employed at divisional level in place of the 100/17.  This gun saw use with Italians and was also provided to their Nationalist allies. Some might have been captured by the Republic in the aftermath of Guadalahara. 

MAX. RANGE
12000m
SHELL WEIGHT
15.74kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2300kg


P04116
The Obice da 149/13 150mm howitzer mainly represents two types of guns confiscated from the Austro-Hungarian Empire after WWI, which the Italians renamed the 149/12 and 149/13. Both were used primarily as corps artillery. This gun was used by both the Spanish Nationalists and the Italians fighting in Spain

MAX. RANGE
8790m
SHELL WEIGHT
40-41kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2344-2765kg


P04117
The FlaK 36 37mm was a single barreled anti-aircraft weapon. It had an automatic action that operated off of gas pressure and barrel recoil. It took a multi-round ammo clip that allowed the gun to have a practical rate of fire of 80 rounds per minute. Mounted on a triangular platform it was generally carried by a two-wheeled trailer, but could also be found mounted in a wide variety of vehicles.  This AA gun was provided by Germany to the Nationalists with appropriate Condor Legion personnel for training and use. 

MAX. EFFECTIVE CEILING
2000m
SHELL WEIGHT
0.635kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1544kg


P04118
This gun was inherited by both sides from vestiges of the Regular army and saw much use in early battles. Until supplemented by Russian equipment, this gun provided much of the Republics heavy fire support. The mle 17 S 155mm Howitzer C 17 S was originally designed as a 152mm howitzer for Czarist Russia. Adopted for use by France during WWI, most C 17 S were horse-drawn.  

MAX RANGE
11,300m
SHELL WEIGHT
43.6kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
3300kg


P04119
This piece saw frequent use by both sides as field artillery, especially in the early conflicts for the Guadarrama mountains. The mle 28 75mm Mountain Gun was designed as a replacement for the mle 06 65mm mountain gun.

MAX RANGE
9000m
SHELL WEIGHT
7.25kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
660kg


P04120
The FlaK 30 20mm was a single-barreled anti-aircraft weapon. Standard light AA gun supplied by Germany to the Nationalists.

MAX. EFFECTIVE CEILING
2000m
SHELL WEIGHT
0.3kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
405kg


P04121
The Cannone-mitragliera da 20/65 20mm anti-aircraft gun was the standard light anti-aircraft gun of the Italian Army, which also viewed it as a heavy machinegun and light anti-tank gun. It was adopted into service in 1935 and provided by Italy to the Nationalists and commonly utilized by their own troops in Spain.

MAX. EFFECTIVE CEILING
2500m
SHELL WEIGHT
.135kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
307kg


P04122
These naval guns represent the secondary armament of the Nationalist battleship Espana, the secondary armament of cruisers of the Cervera class, and the primary armament of destroyers of the Alsedo class of the Nationalists. These vessels were sometimes used for shore bombardment. 


P04123
These naval guns represent the primary armament of the Nationalist Churruca class destroyers. These vessels were sometimes used for shore bombardment.


P04124
These naval guns represent the primary armament of the Nationalist Cervera and Mendez Nunez class cruisers. These vessels were sometimes used for shore bombardment.


P04125
These naval guns represent the primary armament of the Nationalist battleship Espana. Espana was sometimes used for shore bombardment.


P04143
The Spanish Nationalists used batteries of 210mm howitzers in their major campaigns. It was used by the Nationalists during the the battle for Madrid, Teruel and the Ebro.

MAX RANGE
9500m
SHELL WEIGHT
90kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
9112kg


P04144
The Spanish Nationalists used the Schneider 260mm Mortar model 1916, manufactued under licence by Ansaldo, in Italy.  It was used by the Nationalists in major campaigns during the Spanish Civil War in the battles of Madrid, Teruel and the Ebro.

Shell weight: 204? kg
Range: 8,800m - 10,750? m


P04145
The Spanish Nationalists used a battery of 305mm Heavy Mortar most likely it was the Austrian Skoda 305mm model 1911.  These may have been some of the ones captured by the Italians or purchased after WW1 like much of Spain's artillery.  It was used by the Nationalists in major campaigns during the Spanish Civil War in the battles of Teruel and the Ebro.

Skoda 305mm model 1911 Heavy Mortar
Shellweight: 384kg
Range: 12,592m


P04201
Moroccan Regulares (aka Fuerzas Regulares Indgenas)  Recruited in Morocco and officered by Spaniards, the Regulares were all volunteers, brave to the point of fearlessness, and represented the best troops on the Nationalist side. Though recruitment in Morocco continued throughout the war, the Regulares took heavy losses in the battles for Madrid, decimating their ranks. 


P04202
Spanish Foreign Legion (Tercio de Extranjeros) or The Tercio, which was largely Spanish unlike its French counterpart, had a number of combat veterans from the Rif war in its ranks and would include a number of elite platoons.  The Spanish Foreign Legion, whose battle cry was Viva la Muerte (Long Live Death), was the elite portion of the Spanish Army, garrisoned in Spanish Morocco and which formed some of the best units on the Nationalist side. Like the Moroccan Regulares, the Spanish Foreign Legion took such heavy losses in the battles for Madrid through the Jarama that it virtually ceased to exist thereafter as an elite unit. 

P04203
A large number of the paramilitary police, the Guardia Civil, and a lesser number of Asaltos declared for the nationalists. The Guardia Civil were the main police force in the countryside, towns and villages. The Carabineros were another pre-civil war paramilitary force. They were primarily a border police force. Like most of the other paramilitary forces proved to be very good soldiers. They were a confident force, well trained and armed. 


P04204
The Falange was a paramilitary facist orientated political organization which contributed many volunteers to the Nationalist insurrection, but whose troops, though motivated, had little training. Not as initially combat reliable as regular troops, Falangists were often used to garrison conquered areas. Note: both Requets and Falangists became like regular army platoons in later war scenarios, reflecting both battle experience and training by the German Condor Legion. Falangists wore Black or dark blue gorillo cap, piped and tasselled in white or red and a dark blue shirt, later they were like Nationalist Army units but retained the distincive cap.


P04205 
 The Carlist Requtes came mostly from Navarre and were highly religious, many regarding the war as a holy crusade. They would often be accompanied by priests, who risked their lives to perform last sacrament on the battlefield and who urged the men on.  Requets became like regular army platoons in later war scenarios, reflecting both battle experience and training by the German Condor Legion.  Carlists wore a Red berret, later they were like Nationalist Army units but retained the distincive cap.


P04206
Regular army units provided the base of the Nationalist revolt in 1936.  Unlike the Morrocan Army Corps, veterans of the Rif War, the mainland regular army was considered to be a poorly trained and badly led force of conscripts and would include a number of second line troops in its ranks as well as the first line.  2nd line platoons represent troops such as Falange volunteers. These platoons would also represent some regular army soldiers that declared for the revolution early in the war, reflecting the pitiful state of much of the pre-war Spanish army.


P04207
Regular army units provided the base of the Nationalist revolt in 1936.  The Spanish troops in the Morrocan Army Corps, veterans of the Rif War, were the core of the revolt and the best troops in the Spanish Army.  The mainland regular army was considered to be a poorly trained and badly led force of conscripts.  However later in the war more troops became first class infantry, reflecting both battle experience and training by the German Condor Legion. 


P04208
At the begining of the War most of the regular Cavalry units joined the Nationalist cause. The Nationalist cavalry  were generaly better than anything the Republicans had.


P04209
At the begining of the War most of the regular Cavalry units joined the Nationalist cause. Some of the Nationalist cavalry   were quite good. 1st Division broke Republican units with a cavalry charge on one occasion.


P04210 
 This unit represents the Carlist Requtes of the later part of the war, reflecting both battle experience and training by the German Condor Legion. Carlists now were uniformed like the rest of the army but still wore the distinctivv Red berret.


P04211
This unit represents an Engineer platoon.


P04212
This unit represents a 2 machinegun platoon equipped with pre-war Spanish army and used by both sides was the Hotchkiss 7 mm The Nationalist infantry also used the Germans Mg-13 and Mg-15 7.92 mm and the Italian Fiat-Revelli 7.65 mm Breda 8 mm respectively.


P04213
This unit represents a 3 machinegun platoon equipped with pre-war Spanish army and used by both sides was the Hotchkiss 7 mm The Nationalist infantry also used the Germans Mg-13 and Mg-15 7.92 mm and the Italian Fiat-Revelli 7.65 mm Breda 8 mm respectively.


P04214
This unit represents a Legion 4 machinegun platoon equipped with pre-war Spanish army and used by both sides was the Hotchkiss 7 mm The Nationalist infantry also used the Germans Mg-13 and Mg-15 7.92 mm and the Italian Fiat-Revelli 7.65 mm Breda 8 mm respectively.


P04215 
 This unit represents the Falangist troops of the later part of the war, reflecting both battle experience and training by the German Condor Legion.  Later Falangists wore uniforms like Nationalist Army units but retained the distincive Black or dark blue gorillo cap, piped and tasselled in white or red.


P04216
This unit represents a groups of pro-Nationalist citizen militias, police and partisans. Many such groups operated behind Nationalist lines throughout the Civil War Period as local security or garrison units. 


P04217
 This unit represents  a platoon of motorcycle troops.


P04218
 This unit represents primarily a platoon of four machineguns carried in motorcycle sidecars.


P04219
 This unit represents a Bicycle platoon. Rifles, pistols, hand granades and a few light machineguns were typically allotted to units of this type. The bicycle was only useful on prepared surfaces and was hampered by inclement weather.


P04220
 The Guardia Asaltos (Assault Guards) were a paramilitary urban police force, similar to the Guardia Civil, whose loyalties mostly lay with the Republic and were relied on to be a force loyal to the government should there be an insurrection. Not as numerous as the Guardia Civil, the Asaltos personnel were drawn from ex-Army of Africa and Foreign Legion and were considered better trained and equipped for street fighting than army conscripts. Where the Assaultos went over to the Nationalists the military rising succeaded, where they opposed it failed. 


P04301
This unit represents a Division HQ. Many Spanish officers went over to the Nationalist forces providing better organization to its forces in the early part of the Civil War, and this included the headquarters units. 


P04302
This unit represents a Brigade HQ. Many Spanish officers went over to the Nationalist forces providing better organization to its forces in the early part of the Civil War, and this included the headquarters units. 


P04303
This unit represents a regiment HQ. Many Spanish officers went over to the Nationalist forces providing better organization to its forces in the early part of the Civil War, and this included the headquarters units. 


P04304
 This unit represents a battalion HQ. Many Spanish officers went over to the Nationalist forces providing better organization to its forces, and this included the headquarters units. However Carlist militia had some training and Falange militia were untrained, in the early part of the war.  German training raised them to regular status in the later part of the war. 


P04305
 This unit represents a battalion HQ. Many Spanish officers went over to the Nationalist forces providing better organization to its forces in the early part of the Civil War, and this included the headquarters units. 
 

P04306
This unit represents a Corps HQ. Many Spanish officers went over to the Nationalist forces providing better organization to its forces in the early part of the Civil War, and this included the headquarters units. 


P04307
This unit represents a Army HQ. Many Spanish officers went over to the Nationalist forces providing better organization to its forces in the early part of the Civil War, and this included the headquarters units. 


P04401
Most of the professional officers went over to the Nationalist cause and had many field commanders of good quality early in the war, especially in the Army of Africa, veterans of the Rif War. However, as casualties mounted, they turned to quickie schools to turn out young officers with minimal if any experience, dedicated but not learned. Since many of these young men were drawn from aristocratic or educated backrounds, they would have fairly good morale, but would suffer in leadership. Because of the extreme bravery and equally tragic tactical stupidity shown by many  Nationalist junior officers, These leaders, would take front line stances with their troops when able. Historical accounts relate that the combat lifetime of some Nationalist junior officers could be measured in days, sometimes hours, of service. The Carlists produced good and able leaders as shown by their ability to keep their troops in action. They had made use of secret training centers before the war, always awaiting the chance for a new rising. Falangists would have the poorist leadership representation among the Nationalists until later in the war, when German training started to help.


P04402
Most of the professional officers went over to the Nationalist cause and had many field commanders of good quality early in the war, especially in the Army of Africa, veterans of the Rif War. However, as casualties mounted, they turned to quickie schools to turn out young officers with minimal if any experience, dedicated but not learned. Since many of these young men were drawn from aristocratic or educated backrounds, they would have fairly good morale, but would suffer in leadership. Because of the extreme bravery and equally tragic tactical stupidity shown by many  Nationalist junior officers, These leaders, would take front line stances with their troops when able. Historical accounts relate that the combat lifetime of some Nationalist junior officers could be measured in days, sometimes hours, of service. The Carlists produced good and able leaders as shown by their ability to keep their troops in action. They had made use of secret training centers before the war, always awaiting the chance for a new rising. Falangists would have the poorist leadership representation among the Nationalists until later in the war, when German training started to help.


P04403
Most of the professional officers went over to the Nationalist cause and had many field commanders of good quality early in the war, especially in the Army of Africa, veterans of the Rif War. However, as casualties mounted, they turned to quickie schools to turn out young officers with minimal if any experience, dedicated but not learned. Since many of these young men were drawn from aristocratic or educated backrounds, they would have fairly good morale, but would suffer in leadership. Because of the extreme bravery and equally tragic tactical stupidity shown by many  Nationalist junior officers, These leaders, would take front line stances with their troops when able. Historical accounts relate that the combat lifetime of some Nationalist junior officers could be measured in days, sometimes hours, of service. The Carlists produced good and able leaders as shown by their ability to keep their troops in action. They had made use of secret training centers before the war, always awaiting the chance for a new rising. Falangists would have the poorist leadership representation among the Nationalists until later in the war, when German training started to help.


P04404
Most of the professional officers went over to the Nationalist cause and had many field commanders of good quality early in the war, especially in the Army of Africa, veterans of the Rif War. However, as casualties mounted, they turned to quickie schools to turn out young officers with minimal if any experience, dedicated but not learned. Since many of these young men were drawn from aristocratic or educated backrounds, they would have fairly good morale, but would suffer in leadership. Because of the extreme bravery and equally tragic tactical stupidity shown by many  Nationalist junior officers, These leaders, would take front line stances with their troops when able. Historical accounts relate that the combat lifetime of some Nationalist junior officers could be measured in days, sometimes hours, of service. The Carlists produced good and able leaders as shown by their ability to keep their troops in action. They had made use of secret training centers before the war, always awaiting the chance for a new rising. Falangists would have the poorist leadership representation among the Nationalists until later in the war, when German training started to help.


P04405
Most of the professional officers went over to the Nationalist cause and had many field commanders of good quality early in the war, especially in the Army of Africa, veterans of the Rif War. However, as casualties mounted, they turned to quickie schools to turn out young officers with minimal if any experience, dedicated but not learned. Since many of these young men were drawn from aristocratic or educated backrounds, they would have fairly good morale, but would suffer in leadership. Because of the extreme bravery and equally tragic tactical stupidity shown by many  Nationalist junior officers, These leaders, would take front line stances with their troops when able. Historical accounts relate that the combat lifetime of some Nationalist junior officers could be measured in days, sometimes hours, of service. The Carlists produced good and able leaders as shown by their ability to keep their troops in action. They had made use of secret training centers before the war, always awaiting the chance for a new rising. Falangists would have the poorist leadership representation among the Nationalists until later in the war, when German training started to help.


P04406
Most of the professional officers went over to the Nationalist cause and had many field commanders of good quality early in the war, especially in the Army of Africa, veterans of the Rif War. However, as casualties mounted, they turned to quickie schools to turn out young officers with minimal if any experience, dedicated but not learned. Since many of these young men were drawn from aristocratic or educated backrounds, they would have fairly good morale, but would suffer in leadership. Because of the extreme bravery and equally tragic tactical stupidity shown by many  Nationalist junior officers, These leaders, would take front line stances with their troops when able. Historical accounts relate that the combat lifetime of some Nationalist junior officers could be measured in days, sometimes hours, of service. The Carlists produced good and able leaders as shown by their ability to keep their troops in action. They had made use of secret training centers before the war, always awaiting the chance for a new rising. Falangists would have the poorist leadership representation among the Nationalists until later in the war, when German training started to help.


P04407
Most of the professional officers went over to the Nationalist cause and had many field commanders of good quality early in the war, especially in the Army of Africa, veterans of the Rif War. However, as casualties mounted, they turned to quickie schools to turn out young officers with minimal if any experience, dedicated but not learned. Since many of these young men were drawn from aristocratic or educated backrounds, they would have fairly good morale, but would suffer in leadership. Because of the extreme bravery and equally tragic tactical stupidity shown by many  Nationalist junior officers, These leaders, would take front line stances with their troops when able. Historical accounts relate that the combat lifetime of some Nationalist junior officers could be measured in days, sometimes hours, of service. The Carlists produced good and able leaders as shown by their ability to keep their troops in action. They had made use of secret training centers before the war, always awaiting the chance for a new rising. Falangists would have the poorist leadership representation among the Nationalists until later in the war, when German training started to help.


P04408
Most of the professional officers went over to the Nationalist cause and had many field commanders of good quality early in the war, especially in the Army of Africa, veterans of the Rif War. However, as casualties mounted, they turned to quickie schools to turn out young officers with minimal if any experience, dedicated but not learned. Since many of these young men were drawn from aristocratic or educated backrounds, they would have fairly good morale, but would suffer in leadership. Because of the extreme bravery and equally tragic tactical stupidity shown by many  Nationalist junior officers, These leaders, would take front line stances with their troops when able. Historical accounts relate that the combat lifetime of some Nationalist junior officers could be measured in days, sometimes hours, of service. The Carlists produced good and able leaders as shown by their ability to keep their troops in action. They had made use of secret training centers before the war, always awaiting the chance for a new rising. Falangists would have the poorist leadership representation among the Nationalists until later in the war, when German training started to help.


P04409
Most of the professional officers went over to the Nationalist cause and had many field commanders of good quality early in the war, especially in the Army of Africa, veterans of the Rif War. However, as casualties mounted, they turned to quickie schools to turn out young officers with minimal if any experience, dedicated but not learned. Since many of these young men were drawn from aristocratic or educated backrounds, they would have fairly good morale, but would suffer in leadership. Because of the extreme bravery and equally tragic tactical stupidity shown by many  Nationalist junior officers, These leaders, would take front line stances with their troops when able. Historical accounts relate that the combat lifetime of some Nationalist junior officers could be measured in days, sometimes hours, of service. The Carlists produced good and able leaders as shown by their ability to keep their troops in action. They had made use of secret training centers before the war, always awaiting the chance for a new rising. Falangists would have the poorist leadership representation among the Nationalists until later in the war, when German training started to help.


P04410
Most of the professional officers went over to the Nationalist cause and had many field commanders of good quality early in the war, especially in the Army of Africa, veterans of the Rif War. However, as casualties mounted, they turned to quickie schools to turn out young officers with minimal if any experience, dedicated but not learned. Since many of these young men were drawn from aristocratic or educated backrounds, they would have fairly good morale, but would suffer in leadership. Because of the extreme bravery and equally tragic tactical stupidity shown by many  Nationalist junior officers, These leaders, would take front line stances with their troops when able. Historical accounts relate that the combat lifetime of some Nationalist junior officers could be measured in days, sometimes hours, of service. The Carlists produced good and able leaders as shown by their ability to keep their troops in action. They had made use of secret training centers before the war, always awaiting the chance for a new rising. Falangists would have the poorist leadership representation among the Nationalists until later in the war, when German training started to help.


P04413
Represent priests serving with the Carlist troops on the Nationalist side. The Carlist Requtes came mostly from Navarre and were highly religious, many regarding the war as a holy crusade. They would often be accompanied by priests, who risked their lives to perform last sacrament on the battlefield and who urged the men on.  The priest has moral modifiers but no combat modifiers and should be placed in front line positions.


P04501
Breguet Br. XIX A2 the mainstay of the pre-war Spanish light bomber and reconaissance force. At the outbreak of hostilities most of the 60 Breguet XIX recon bombers went to the Republicans but the Nationalists had almost a dozen.  These were soon supplemented and replaced by Italian and German aircraft. 


P04502
The Italian Meridonali Ro.37bis provided good ground support to Nationalist offensives begining in August 1936 the Italians sent several bomber squadrons to aid the Nationalist cause and provided these craft to Nationalist squadrons.


P04503
 In July 1936 Italy sent a squadron of CR.32 fighters as escort for the two freighters sent to help move the Spanish Legion from Morocco to Spain. Subsequently the Italians sent several fighter and bomber squadrons to aid the Nationalist cause and provided these craft to Nationalist squadrons. The Fiat CR 32 was widely regarded as the best fighter in the Spanish skies. After the civil war some examples were produced by Hispano as the Ha-132.  In 1940 Spain had 121 of these craft which they retained until the end of WW2.


P04504 
In August 1936 six He51 C were established at Tablada airfield near Sevilla as part of a German volunteer detachment, ostensibly to train Spanish pilots to fly the new equipment.  By October the German Kondor Legions air unit had 36-48 He51s.  These aircraft provided good ground support to Nationalist offensives for the rest of the war. Nationalist airmen began flying these in 1937 and they stayed in service through WW2. 


P04505 
In April 1937 the Kondor Legion is upgraded with the arriveal of the Bf109B-1.  Introduced in small numbers at first, by July of 1937 it was included in the Nationalist airforce.  At wars end the Nationalists had 34 and aquired over a dozen more that stayed in service beyond WW2. 


P04506 
In October 1938 5 Ju87B-1 were added to the Kondor Legion for field testing.  They were withdrawn by the Germans at the end of the Civil War.


P04507
The Polikarpov I-15 formed the backbone of Republican fighter forces. This was for its time a very effective aircraft, superior to the Heinkel 51 and equal to the Fiat CR-32. When ME-109s began to appear, however, the I-15 was outclassed.
With the surrender of the Republic the Nationalists aquired over 100 of these craft which they retained till the end of WW2.


P04508 
Heinkel He112 fighter. Originally designed in 1936 as the rival to the Me 109.  The He112 was not placed in large production; only 68 were built, mostly for export to Spain and Romania. 18 flew for the Condor Legion. At wars end the Nationalists had 9 that stayed in service beyond WW2. 


P04509 
Despite its low speed, in the Spanish civil war the Ju52 was used as a bomber as well as for transport, until more capable aircraft were available for the bomber role.  66 flew with the Condor Legion. At wars end the Nationalists had 13 that they flew into the early years of WW2. 


P04510
Dornier Do17 medium bomber, called the Bacalao by the Spanish, a carried a 1.000 kg  bombload.  31 flew with the Condor Legion. At wars end the Nationalists had 9 that stayed in service beyond WW2. 


P04511
The mainstay of the pre-war Spanish fighter force, the Nieuport-Delage NiD 52, was built in Spain under licence. The serving aircraft at the outbreak of hostilities were divided between the two sides.  15 went over to  to the nationalists 3 in Sevilla, 12 in Morrocco.


P04512 
The He111, called the Pedro by the Spanish, was a medium bomber that was also used in small numbers as civil transport. The early versions of the He 111 flew in the Spanish civil war in 1936. The He 111 was a good medium bomber, and could carry a 1500 kg  bomb load. The plane performed very well in the civil war, being fast enough to evade Republican fighters, and the Spanish Air Force continued flying the He-111 until 1965.


P04513 
Heinkel He70 Bomber , called the Rayo by the Spanish, was the first modern German bomber. One squadron sent to Spain in 1936 and the remaining 12 were given to Spain in 1938, they flew to the end of WW2. 


P04514
Six Hs 123A-1s were sent to Spain where the Condor Legion pioneered close ground support operations (Schlachtfliegen) with great success. The Spanish Nationalists were so impressed that they requested more of the type. The six Condor Legion aircraft were later bolstered by 11 supplied directly to the Nationalists, and continued in Spanish service long after the end of the civil war. 

P04515 
The first model was the SM.79-I reconnaissance bomber, and this saw considerable and effective service with the Aviazione Legionaria (Italian expeditionary force) supporting the Nationalist insurgents led by Franco against the Republican government forces in the Spanish Civil War (1936-39). It gained considerable attention for its effectiveness and reliability noting that only five aircraft were shot down with another four lost on the ground during the entire confict. Its service and reputation in Spain, led to export orders.  They could carry 1,250 kg (2,750 lb) of bombs internally or two torpedoes. Over 60 Savoia Marchetti S.M.79 Bombers were turned over to the Spanish airforce toward the end of the Civil War and provided Spain with its main medium bomber force through WW2. 

P04516 
Over 30 Savoia Marchetti S.M.81 Bomber components of the Aviazione Legionaria were turned over to the Spanish airforce toward the end of the Civil War. Here in addition to its dedicated bomber role, it was used also for reconnaissance and transport. It had a bombload of up to 2,204 lbs (1000 kg) carried internally and provided Spain with nearly half of its heavy bomber force through WW2. 

P04517 
The He 46 was a parasol wing monoplane designed for reconnaissance and ground atttak.  By December of 1936 30 He 46 or  Pava were used in combat in Spain with the German Kondor Legion. These aircraft provided good ground support to Nationalist offensives for the rest of the war.  Armed with one 7.92mm MG 15 Machine gun in the observers cockpit, it could drop a payload of twenty 22 lb. (10 kg) bombs.  Nationalist airmen began flying these in 1937 and they stayed in Spanish service through WW2, but in Germany was almost entirely replaced by the Hs 126 in 1940. Some were nevertheless in service until 1943. 


P07001
Several intact L3 series tankettes were captured by the Ethiopians in the opening rounds of the first Italian and the subsequent Ethiopian offensives. These vehicles could have been rather easily repaired and put into service. This was most certainly not done, however, do to the shortage of trained personnel in Ethiopia. This unit has been included strictly for hypothetical scenarios.
The L3/35 Tankette was developed along the lines of the British Carden-Loyd Mk VI and first appeared as the L3/33 in 1933, but was retrofitted in 1935 and became the L3/35. In June 1940, when Italy entered the war, this tankette was found in all three armored divisions (except for two tank battalions), the tank battalions in the motorized divisions, the light tank squadron group in each Celere (Fast or Rapid) division, and numerous independent tank battalions. In addition to seeing action in the Ethiopian War and Spanish Civil War, the L3 was used everywhere Italians fought in WWII. Some 2000-2500 were built in different models and variants.

ARMAMENT
2 x 8mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
15mm
WEIGHT
3.5 tonnes


P07002
Three Fiat 3000 or L5 series Italian tanks were in Ethiopian service. Two vehicles were purchased outright from Italy. One was a gift from the Italian government as a coronation gift to Haile Selassie. These tanks were used on the Southern or Ogaden front.
The L5 was Italy's first series production tank. Based loosely on the French FT-17, the FIAT 3000, as it was originally designated, was armed with two coaxially mounted machineguns. A later version carried a 37mm gun instead, and was used as a platoon- and company-commander's vehicle. Eventually their designations were changed to L5/21 and L5/30 respectively. The L5 was considered a first- line tank until mid 1939, seeing action in Libya in 1926 and in Ethiopia in 1936. It also fought along the French-Italian border in 1940 and in Sicily in 1943. Some 100 were built.

ARMAMENT
2 x 8mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
16mm
WEIGHT
5.5 tonnes


P07003
According to some sources, Ethiopia had up to 7 armored cars at the beginning of the conflict. It is possible that there is some confusion with the various "armed cars' or "assault cars" that were also on hand; some sources state that Ethiopia only possed one or two "true" armored cars.


P07004
Ethiopia made some use of armed but unarmored trucks and cars (usually based on Fiat vehicles). These usually mounted a machinegun in an open mount.


P07005
This unit represents a group of trucks of various make. Both trucks and drivers were rather scarce in Ethiopia.

P07006
This unit represents a group of wagons used to transport heavy equipment and supplies.


P07007
This unit represents horses for cavalry. Native Galla horsemen used sturdy, small local horses or mules. The cavalry of the Imperial Guard rode large chargers imported from Australia.


P07101
Ethiopia used several types of mortars of both Stokes and Brandt varieties. The Brandt type were more common and were used with great accuarcy by the Imperial Guard and Mai'Ceu.


P07102
This unit represents a battery of light guns. There were many such guns in Ethiopia all were old (many captured at Adowa), there was little ammunition, and most of the gunners were inexperienced in their use.


P07103
Germany still smarting from Italy's refusal to allow the annexation of Austria (for the time being) sold to Ethiopia a dozen modern Pak 35/36 anti-tank guns.


P07104
Some sources mention the use of anti-tanks guns by the Ethiopian 2nd Battalion of Gideon force. If these were truely anti-tank guns and not ant-tank rifles, then they probably would have been British 2-pounders.


P07105
The unit represents a battery of heavy guns. There were many such guns in Ethiopia all were old (many captured at Adowa), there was little ammunition, and most of the gunners were inexperienced in their use.


P07106
The artillery battery of the Imperial Guard was equipped with mle 28 75mm mountain guns. They were very skilled in the use of these weapons, as demonstrated at Mai'Ceu


P07107
One of the more famous weapons used by the Ethiopians, because one was operated by Haile Selassie, the Oerlikon anti-aircraft guns were effective and numerous enough to cause Italian pilots problems during several major engagements.


P07201
The term Kebur Zabanga meant "Great" or "Big" Zabanga, although it was also used for the officer corps of the Imperial Guard. The guardsmen numbered around 25,000 by 1935 and included many soldiers who had served with the Italian army in Libya or in the British King's African Rifles in Kenya. They were the Pride of the Ethiopian army, being equipped with new Mauser rifles and German belts worn over a European-style khaki uniform.


P07202
This unit represents a platoon of the Ethiopian Zabanga ("watchman") gendarmie. The Imperial Guard was effectively an offshoot of the Zabanga, while the Zabanga itself, though uniformed in European style, was never as well equipped as the Imperial Guard. They were however given second choice of military equipment in Ethiopia. They were armed with Manlicher rifles. They were Zabanga formations in every major city, and in every region.


P07203
The Mahel Safari under the command of the Emporer Haile Selassie largely consisted of Selfegna, oridnary soldiers equipped according to European standards. Their uniforms were, however, locally made. Such soldiers were armed with whatever rifles were available, including modern Mausers, Mannlichers, Lebels, Lee-Metfords, Moisins and Italian Mannlicher Carcanos, as well as much older Vetterlis, le Gras and Marini-Henry guns.


P07204
The term gascegna referred to feudal or tribal warriors. Many were armed with a shotel, which was the caracteristic Ethiopian curved saber. A traditional medieval concept of warfare remained virtually unchanged among such people. Their costume consisted of a shamma, or length of cotton which served as a body and head covering, with more moder jodhpur-style trousers which had been added at the insistence of the Emporer Menelik II in the late 19th century. Most photographic evidence indicates that most of these men were armed with guns of various types.


P07205
This unit represents a group or bande of resistance fighters or "patriots". Many such groups formed after the Italian conquest.


P07206
This unit represents a group or bande trained and equipped by the British and forming part of Gideon force which invaded Italian East Africa. There were around 3 or 4 battalions of such men involved in the force.


P07207
This unit represents a machinegun platoon. Many different types of machineguns could be found in Ethiopia. Most of the photographic evidence pictures Hotchkiss machineguns, the gun upon which this unit is based.


P07208
The term Kebur Zabanga meant "Great" or "Big" Zabanga, although it was also used for the officer corps of the Imperial Guard. The guardsmen numbered around 25,000 by 1935 and included many soldiers who had served with the Italian army in Libya or in the British King's African Rifles in Kenya. They were the Pride of the Ethiopian army, being equipped with new Mauser rifles and German belts worn over a European-style khaki uniform. Cavalry consisted of one squadron.


P07209
Most Ethiopian cavlry came from the Oromo tribesmen, part of the largely nomadic Galla people, who were sometimes allied to the Negus (emporer) and sometimes fought against him as the Azebo Galla did at the battle of May'Ceu.


P07301
Ethiopian units were not strictly organized along European standards. Commanders commands could rather variable. Only Ras and Army commanders possed radios. Most other leaders would be surrounded by whatever body-guards, messengers, priests, etc. they considered important.


P07302
Ethiopian units were not strictly organized along European standards. Commanders commands could rather variable. Only Ras and Army commanders possed radios. Most other leaders would be surrounded by whatever body-guards, messengers, priests, etc. they considered important.


P07303
Ethiopian units were not strictly organized along European standards. Commanders commands could rather variable. Only Ras and Army commanders possed radios. Most other leaders would be surrounded by whatever body-guards, messengers, priests, etc. they considered important.


P07304
Ethiopian units were not strictly organized along European standards. Commanders commands could rather variable. Only Ras and Army commanders possed radios. Most other leaders would be surrounded by whatever body-guards, messengers, priests, etc. they considered important.


P07305
Ethiopian units were not strictly organized along European standards. Commanders commands could rather variable. Only Ras and Army commanders possed radios. Most other leaders would be surrounded by whatever body-guards, messengers, priests, etc. they considered important.


P07306
Ethiopian units were not strictly organized along European standards. Commanders commands could rather variable. Only Ras and Army commanders possed radios. Most other leaders would be surrounded by whatever body-guards, messengers, priests, etc. they considered important.


P07307
Ethiopian units were not strictly organized along European standards. Commanders commands could rather variable. Only Ras and Army commanders possed radios. Most other leaders would be surrounded by whatever body-guards, messengers, priests, etc. they considered important.


P07401
Ethiopian commanders were not tactitions. They were up-front leaders. Their primary roles were to serve as focus and ralling points for their men, and to lead charges. Their death could be a catastrophe, for panic often set in soon after amongs their troops. Some of the more senior commanders notably Ras Imru showed considerable operational skill.


P07402
Ethiopian commanders were not tactitions. They were up-front leaders. Their primary roles were to serve as focus and ralling points for their men, and to lead charges. Their death could be a catastrophe, for panic often set in soon after amongs their troops. Some of the more senior commanders notably Ras Imru showed considerable operational skill.


P07403
Ethiopian commanders were not tactitions. They were up-front leaders. Their primary roles were to serve as focus and ralling points for their men, and to lead charges. Their death could be a catastrophe, for panic often set in soon after amongs their troops. Some of the more senior commanders notably Ras Imru showed considerable operational skill.


P07404
Ethiopian commanders were not tactitions. They were up-front leaders. Their primary roles were to serve as focus and ralling points for their men, and to lead charges. Their death could be a catastrophe, for panic often set in soon after amongs their troops. Some of the more senior commanders notably Ras Imru showed considerable operational skill.


P07405
Ethiopian commanders were not tactitions. They were up-front leaders. Their primary roles were to serve as focus and ralling points for their men, and to lead charges. Their death could be a catastrophe, for panic often set in soon after amongs their troops. Some of the more senior commanders notably Ras Imru showed considerable operational skill.


P07406
Ethiopian commanders were not tactitions. They were up-front leaders. Their primary roles were to serve as focus and ralling points for their men, and to lead charges. Their death could be a catastrophe, for panic often set in soon after amongs their troops. Some of the more senior commanders notably Ras Imru showed considerable operational skill.


P07407
Ethiopian commanders were not tactitions. They were up-front leaders. Their primary roles were to serve as focus and ralling points for their men, and to lead charges. Their death could be a catastrophe, for panic often set in soon after amongs their troops. Some of the more senior commanders notably Ras Imru showed considerable operational skill.


P07408
Ethiopian commanders were not tactitions. They were up-front leaders. Their primary roles were to serve as focus and ralling points for their men, and to lead charges. Their death could be a catastrophe, for panic often set in soon after amongs their troops. Some of the more senior commanders notably Ras Imru showed considerable operational skill.


P07409
Ethiopian commanders were not tactitions. They were up-front leaders. Their primary roles were to serve as focus and ralling points for their men, and to lead charges. Their death could be a catastrophe, for panic often set in soon after amongs their troops. Some of the more senior commanders notably Ras Imru showed considerable operational skill.


P07410
Ethiopian commanders were not tactitions. They were up-front leaders. Their primary roles were to serve as focus and ralling points for their men, and to lead charges. Their death could be a catastrophe, for panic often set in soon after amongs their troops. Some of the more senior commanders notably Ras Imru showed considerable operational skill.


P07501
The Ethiopian airforce had 12 aircraft. They included four Potez 25 recon/light bombers, two Fokker monoplanes, a Junkers 52, a Farman monoplane, a Breda, and a 12 seater Beechcraft. None of these aircraft was used in combat. This unit is included for hypothetical scenarios.


P08001
The FT-17 Tankette was of WWI design. With its rear engine compartment and turret-mounted armament, it pioneered the layout for all future tank designs. The French Army had some 1600 available in May 1940; however, around 500 were in service in metropolitan France. Most were deployed in independent tank companies (CACC).

ARMAMENT
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
or
1 x 37mm gun
MAX ARMOR
16mm
WEIGHT
6.7 tonnes

P08002
The AMR 33 was designed with local reconnaissance in mind. Lightly armed and armored, it also suffered from weak tracks and suspension. 120 were built. They were found mainly in the motorized dragoon regiments (RDP) of cavalry divisions (DLC).

ARMAMENT
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
13mm
Weight
5.5 tonnes

P08003
The AMR 35 incorporated several significant improvements over the AMR 33. This included a more powerful engine and better suspension which imparted greater speed and maneuverability. 167 were built. About half of these carried a 13.2mm machinegun, the rest the standard French 7.5mm machinegun. AMR 35 were found mainly in the motorized dragoon regiments (RDP) of light mechanized divisions (DLM).

ARMAMENT
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
or
1 x 13.2mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
13mm
WEIGHT
6.5 tonnes

P08004
The R35 Light Tank was designed to replace the FT-17 as the main infantry support tank in the French Army. As such, it was issued to some 20 independent tank battalions (BCC) which supported the infantry divisions. 900 were in service in May 1940.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
45mm
WEIGHT
10 tonnes

P08005
The H35 was the French Army cavalry tank. Although slightly larger than the R35, the H35 had the same combat abilities and performance. The H35 and R35 were very similar in appearance; indeed, they used the same turret. 400 were built. They were employed mainly in cavalry and light mechanized divisions.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
45mm
WEIGHT
12 tonnes

P08006
The FCM 36 Light Tank was another French infantry support vehicle. It possessed some innovative features, however, setting it apart from the R35 and H35 tanks. Its hull and turret were of all-welded construction. It was the only production model French tank with a diesel engine, and its armor was well sloped, providing greater ballistic protection. Due to its high production cost, however, only 100 were built. They were issued to the 4th and 7th Independent Tank Battalions (BCC).

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
40mm
WEIGHT
12.5 tonnes

P08007
The H39 Light Tank was an improved H35. Improvements included a more powerful engine, a much improved suspension and a longer L/33 gun. Around 600 were in service in May 1940, and a further 100 were built before the armistice. The H39 saw action with the 1st, 2nd and 3rd Armored Divisions (DCR) in France; it also saw action in Norway and with the Free French in Syria.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
45mm
WEIGHT
12 tonnes

P08008
The R40 Light Tank was an improved R35, featuring a new track and suspension. Interestingly, these improvements were developed partly from the Char B medium tank. The R40 was also fitted with the more powerful L/33 gun. No exact numbers are available for how many of these tanks were produced. French Army sources indicate that some 80+ were issued to the 40th and 48th Independent Tank Battalions (BCC) and 1st Polish Tank Regiment.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
45mm
WEIGHT
12 tonnes

P08009
The Char Moyen D1 Medium Tank was originally classified as a light tank and was intended as a replacement for the FT-17. After its production run ended it was redesignated as a medium tank. The D1 saw action in France with the 67th Independent Tank Battalion (BCC), but most were sent to Tunisia. Some 160 were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 47mm gun
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
40mm
WEIGHT
14 tonnes

P08010
The Char Moyen D2 Medium Tank was basically an upgraded D1. Originally intended to succeed the D1 for infantry support, the D2 was larger, faster and better armored. The D2 served with de Gaulle's 4th Armored Division (DCR). 100 were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 47mm gun
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
40mm
WEIGHT
19.5 tonnes

P08011
The Somua S35 Medium Tank was based somewhat on the Char D2 and was adopted as the main medium tank of the DLM (Light Mechanized Divisions). It was considered the best tank to oppose the Germans in 1940, totally outclassing the Pz IIIE and F. Made entirely of cast construction, the S35 was rugged, fast, and well armed and armored. Some 430 were available to the French Army in 1940.

ARMAMENT
1 x 47mm gun
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
56mm
WEIGHT
20 tonnes

P08012
The Char B1-bis Medium Tank was the principal medium tank in service with the French Army in 1940. Although heavily armed and armored, it suffered from numerous impediments. Firstly, it was a very complex machine, so much so as to create problems in mass production. In the field, its drawbacks were the one-man turret, short range of operation, relatively slow speed and poor communications equipment. The bow-mounted 75mm gun had no lateral traverse capabilities. Yet, in spite of these problems, the Char B1-bis was a powerful weapon, easily a match for any panzer of the time. 368 were built. They were employed as the main battle tank of the Armored Divisions (DCR), and some were issued to independent tank companies (CACC).

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm gun
1 x 47mm gun
2 x 7.5mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
60mm
WEIGHT
32 tonnes

P08013
The AMD 50 Armored Car was a modernized version of the White Armored Car used in WWI. Also known as the White-Laffly or Laffly 50 AM, it completed its production run in 1934. Intended for long-range reconnaissance, most were used in French North Africa. The AMD 50 featured an additional rear facing driver's position. 98 were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
MAX ARMOR
7mm
WEIGHT
6.5 tonnes

P08014
The AMD 80 Armored Car was a modernized version of the White Armored Car used in WWI. Also known as the Laffly-Vincennes or Laffly 80 AM. This armored car completed its production run in 1935. Intended for long-range reconnaissance, it was sent to Tunisia. The AMD 80 featured an additional, rear facing driver's position. Twenty-eight were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 13.2mm machinegun
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
20mm
WEIGHT
7.5 tonnes

P08015
The AMD 35 Armored Car, nicknamed Pan-Pan, and sometimes called the Panhard 178 or P-178, was one of the finest medium armored cars anywhere in 1940. Featuring four-wheel drive, a rear mounted engine, front and rear driving positions, a 25mm main gun, and excellent speed (72km/h) and range (300km), the AMD 35 was a potent reconnaissance vehicle. Its only drawbacks were no independent suspension and radios in command vehicles only. About 525 were built, but only about 400 were issued to units in the field.

ARMAMENT
1 x 25mm gun
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
26mm
WEIGHT
8.5 tonnes

P08016
The Laffly W15T was a truck-mounted 47mm AT Gun, used in independent anti-tank batteries. Built between 24 May and 17 June 1940, some seventy were rushed into service. Although the original design called for the vehicle to be fully armored, only the gunshield was installed (and even this was often dispensed with). The W15T performed well in the field, achieving some notable successes against German armor, but suffered very heavy losses in the process.

ARMAMENT
1 x 47mm gun
MAX ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
5 tonnes

P08017
The Autocannon de 25 CA AA was the 25mm anti-aircraft gun mounted on a light truck. These vehicles were mostly field modifications rather than factory produced. Exact numbers are unknown, but it is generally accepted they were few in number. A few saw action with the 1st, 2nd and 3rd Armored Divisions, and some were deployed with W15T anti-tank batteries. An Autocannon de 25 CA AA platoon consisted of four vehicles.

ARMAMENT
1 x 25mm gun
MAX ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
7 tonnes

P08018
The Autocannon de 75 mle 13/34 was a modified version of a WWI self-propelled 75mm AA gun. Modifications incorporated in the 1930s allowed the gun to engage ground targets as well as aircraft. This vehicle carried no ammunition; it was accompanied by a second vehicle carrying ammunition instead of a gun. A battery consisted of four vehicles. 236 were available to the French Army on 10 May 1940.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm gun
MAX ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
6 tonnes

P08019
The AMC 29 Halftrack Armored Car was an armored, closed-top halftrack with turreted armament. Designed in 1923, it underwent a series of improvements until it reached its final form in 1932. 100 were built for the cavalry. Other names for this vehicle were the M29 or P16.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
11mm
WEIGHT
7 tonnes

P08020
The SOMUA MCG Halftrack Prime Mover was used for towing 105mm and 155mm artillery pieces. It was developed from the 1920s-vintage SOMUA-Kgresse repair and recovery halftrack. This vehicle had several drawbacks: slow speed, noisy engine and tracks, and most notably, the fact that it required two such vehicles to move a gun along with its crew and ammunition. This unit also represents the Citron-Kgresse P17 halftrack. Some 3000 of both types were available in May 1940.

ARMAMENT
none
MAX ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
2.5 tonnes (P17)
6.5 tonnes (MCG)

P08021
The Unic P107 Halftrack first appeared in 1935. It was used to tow 75mm field guns and 105mm howitzers. With 3276 built it was the most numerous French halftrack. This unit also represents the Citron-Kgresse P19 halftrack, of which 600 were built.

ARMAMENT
none
MAX ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
5 tonnes (P107)
3 tonnes (P19)

P08023
The Lorraine 38L Armored Personnel Carrier was an unusual infantry transport vehicle. It carried four passengers, and towed an armored, fully tracked trailer that carried the rest of the infantry squad. A stopgap design, only 150 had been delivered by May 1940. They were issued to infantry formations of the 1st, 2nd and 3rd DCR.

ARMAMENT
none
MAX ARMOR
10mm
WEIGHT
9 tonnes

P08024
The Latil TAR H2 Gun Tractor was adopted in 1934 for towing heavy artillery and guns. It had 4x4 drive and four wheel steering. 600 were built.

ARMAMENT
none
MAX ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
9.5 tonnes

P08025
The French used a variety of trucks from the Citron 1.5-ton Type 23 to the Studebaker K30 5-ton 4x4. Trucks were used for a variety of purposes, such as towing guns, carrying guns en portee, transporting troops, etc. This unit is a generic representation of these trucks and includes all special types (Laffly, etc.)


P08026
This unit represents a variable number of wagons sufficient to move a battery of guns or a platoon of infantry.


P08027
This unit represents a number of horses sufficient to carry a platoon of cavalry.


P08028
This unit represents a variable number of motorcycles used to transport infantry. Most often they were affiliated with some type of recon unit.


P08029
This unit represents a variable number of unarmed and unarmored boats used to transport infantry and equipment across water.


P08030
This unit represents a variable number of rafts used to transport troops and equipment across water.


P08101
The mle 35 60mm Mortar was designed by the Edgar Brandt company. Motorized infantry companies were issued one each, as were cavalry and reconnaissance squadrons. Some 4900 were in service in May 1940. The 60mm mortar could fire both light and heavy bombs.

MAX RANGE
1700m
SHELL WEIGHT
1.3kg & 2.2kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
17.8kg

P08102
The mle 35 60mm Mortar was designed by the Edgar Brandt company. The 5th (heavy weapons) squadron of each cavalry regiment in the French Army included a platoon of four 60mm mortars. Some 4900 were in service in May 1940. The 60mm mortar could fire both light and heavy bombs.

MAX RANGE
1700m
SHELL WEIGHT
1.3kg & 2.2kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
17.8kg

P08103
The mle 27/31 81mm Mortar Group used a mortar designed by the Edgar Brandt company. A mortar "groupe" (two mortars) was authorized for the heavy weapons platoon of each motorized infantry battalion. Around 5000 were in service in 1940. The 81mm mortar could fire light and heavy bombs, and smoke.

MAX RANGE
2850m
SHELL WEIGHT
3.25kg & 6.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
59.7kg

P08104
The mle 27/31 81mm Mortar was designed by the Edgar Brandt company. In French cavalry formations, the heavy weapons company of each battalion was assigned a platoon of four 81mm mortars. Around 5000 were in service in 1940. The 81mm mortar could fire light and heavy bombs, and smoke.

MAX RANGE
2850m
SHELL WEIGHT
3.25kg & 6.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
59.7kg

P08105
The SA-L mle 34 25mm Anti-Tank Gun was built by Hotchkiss, and served as the standard battalion and regimental anti-tank gun of the French Army. The light weight of this weapon made it unsuitable for high-speed towing, so it was usually either horse-drawn or carried en portee. In the game this unit also represents the lighter mle 37 version. Some 6100 of both types were built, but this amount did not meet the demands of the army. The support company of each motorized infantry battalion was authorized two 25mm AT guns.

ARMOR PENETRATION
50mm at 600m
SHELL WEIGHT
.32kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
310-496kg

P08106
The SA-L mle 34 25mm Anti-Tank Gun was built by the Hotchkiss company and served as the standard battalion and regimental anti-tank gun of the French Army. This unit also represents the lighter mle 37 version. Some 6100 of both types were built. The heavy weapons company of each motorized infantry regiment was authorized six 25mm AT guns in two three-gun platoons.

ARMOR PENETRATION
50mm at 600m
SHELL WEIGHT
.32kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
310-496kg

P08107
The SA-L mle 34 25mm Anti-Tank Gun was built by the Hotchkiss company and served as the standard battalion and regimental anti-tank gun of the French Army. Each DLM (light mechanized division) and DLC (light cavalry division) was authorized a divisional 25mm anti-tank squadron of twelve guns. This unit also represents lighter mle 37 version. Some 6100 of both types were built.

ARMOR PENETRATION
50mm at 600m
SHELL WEIGHT
.32kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
310-496kg

P08108
The SA mle 37 APX 47mm Anti-Tank Gun was a powerful weapon, firing tungsten-core AP shot. Although 841 were manufactured, many were never issued due to a shortage of ammunition. All non-alpine divisions in metropolitan France were authorized a divisional 47mm anti-tank battery of twelve guns. In practice this number was usually six, and sometimes as few as four.

ARMOR PENETRATION
89mm at 500m
SHELL WEIGHT
1.725kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1070kg

P08109
The mle 97/35 75mm Anti-Tank Gun was based on the famous Model 1897 field piece. Modified by fitting a circular platform under its wheels (similar to the British 25pdr), this weapon was thus able to traverse more rapidly than in its original form. No numbers are available as to how many of these guns were so modified. It was issued to the divisional anti-tank batteries of several French divisions. The guns were not popular with their crews due their extra weight and the longer time needed to get the gun in or out of action. This was in spite of its very potent tank killing abilities.

ARMOR PENETRATION
75mm at 500m
SHELL WEIGHT
5.98kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1190kg

P08110
The mle 16 TR 37mm Infantry Gun was designed in 1916 as an infantry support weapon. Still in service in 1940, it was sometimes pressed into the anti-tank role due to shortages of the 25mm anti-tank gun. Issued mainly to second-line and reserve divisions, it was also issued to the weapons company of reconnaissance groups in the motorized infantry divisions, each company being authorized one gun. 1036 were available at the time of the German invasion.

MAX RANGE
2400m
SHELL WEIGHT
.55kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
108kg

P08111
The mle 1897 75mm Field Gun was the famous Model 1897 field piece, the first gun with a modern recoil system and fast-acting breech block. It revolutionized field artillery, and became the most widely used field gun ever produced. At the start of WWII the French had some 4500 of these guns in their inventory. It was the standard light artillery piece in most French divisions, and was also used in the Maginot Line fortresses.

MAX RANGE
11,100m
SHELL WEIGHT
6.2kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1140kg

P08112
The mle 35 B 105mm Howitzer was the design chosen to replace France's WWI-vintage 155mm howitzers. Two groupes (battalions) of four three-gun batteries were issued to the armored and mechanized divisions. Some cavalry divisions and motorized infantry divisions were authorized one groupe each. This unit also represents the similar 105 C mle 34 S. 376 were available in May 1940.

MAX RANGE
10,700m
SHELL WEIGHT
15.6kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1627-1722kg

P08113
The mle 13 S 105mm Field Gun was based on a Russian 107mm design. First produced in 1914, some 897 of these pieces were available in May 1940, used mainly as corps artillery.

MAX RANGE
12,000m
SHELL WEIGHT
15.7kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2300kg

P08114
The mle 36 S 105mm Field Gun was the intended replacement for the L 13 S and was the most modern artillery piece in the French inventory. It was used primarily as corps artillery. 145 were in service in May 1940.

MAX RANGE
16,000m
SHELL WEIGHT
15.7kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
3540-3920kg

P08115
The mle 17 S 155mm Howitzer C 17 S was originally designed as a 152mm howitzer for Czarist Russia. Adopted for use by France during WWI, over 1800 pieces were still in service in May 1940. French infantry divisions were authorized a regiment consisting of two twelve-gun groupes. Most C 17 S were horse-drawn.

MAX RANGE
11,300m
SHELL WEIGHT
43.6kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
3300kg

P08116
The 155mm GPF Gun first saw action in 1917. With some modernization, it was still in service with the French Army in May 1940. The GPF was one of best pieces in the French inventory. It was employed at the corps level in twelve-gun groupes. 402 were available at the time of the German invasion.

MAX RANGE
18,600m
SHELL WEIGHT
43kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
10,750kg

P08117
The mle 06 65mm Mountain Gun was used to equip several mountain artillery and fortress units. This weapon had an unusual recoil mechanism. Called the counter- or soft-recoil system, the barrel travels forward when the lanyard is pulled, and the gun fires when the barrel's forward travel limit is reached. This allows the barrel's momentum to offset the recoil. About seventy of these guns were in service in France in May 1940.

MAX RANGE
6500m
SHELL WEIGHT
4.4kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
400kg

P08118
The mle 28 75mm Mountain Gun was designed as a replacement for the mle 06 65mm mountain gun. It was used to equip mountain and colonial artillery "groupes" (battalions). 156 were available in May 1940. In the game this unit also represents the earlier 75mm mle 19 M.

MAX RANGE
9000m
SHELL WEIGHT
7.25kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
660kg

P08119
The mle 28 105mm Mountain Gun was designed to complement the mle 28 75mm. Only 24 of these guns were in France in May 1940 (in the Alps defense positions). In the game this unit also represents the earlier 105mm mle 19 M.

MAX RANGE
7850m
SHELL WEIGHT
12kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
750kg

P08120
The mle 39 O 20mm Anti-Aircraft Gun was ordered from the Swiss Oerlikon company in late 1939. By May 10, 1940 357 had been delivered. Organized into four-gun platoons, they were issued to infantry-type divisions. The support company of the infantry battalions operated these guns.

MAX EFFECTIVE CEILING
1100m
SHELL WEIGHT
0.3kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
400kg

P08121
The mle 38 25mm Anti-Aircraft Gun was developed to provide the French Army with a light anti-aircraft gun larger than a machinegun and capable of engaging aircraft at higher altitudes. Organized in two-gun platoons, they were issued to several French divisions. This unit also represents the heavier CA mle 39 which had a stronger gun platform and carriage. 829 guns of both types were produced.

MAX CEILING
5000m
SHELL WEIGHT
.29kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
850kg

P08122
The mle 38 25mm Anti-Aircraft Gun was developed to provide the French Army with a light AA gun larger than a machinegun and capable of engaging aircraft at higher altitudes. Organized into three-gun platoons, they were issued to all manner of French divisions. This unit also represents the heavier CA mle 39, which had a stronger gun platform and carriage. 829 guns of both types were produced.

MAX CEILING
5000m
SHELL WEIGHT
.29kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
850kg

P08123
The mle 32 75mm Anti-Aircraft Gun was the most numerous mobile anti-aircraft gun in the French Army in May 1940. Organized into four-gun batteries, it was deployed as follows: 356 mobile units and some 600 static mounts.

MAX CEILING
8200m
SHELL WEIGHT
6.44kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
4100kg

P08201
This unit represents a standard French rifle platoon. It generally consisted of about forty men armed with rifles, pistols, grenades and three Chatellerault 7.5mm light machineguns. The platoon was divided into three squads, and each squad was additionally equipped with a rifle grenade launcher.


P08202
This unit represents the infantry machinegun "groupe". It usually consisted of about twelve men with rifles and two Hotchkiss mle 14 8mm air-cooled machineguns. Two machinegun groupes made a machinegun platoon.


P08203
This unit represents the infantry machinegun platoon. Made up of two machinegun "groupes", it consisted of about thirty men with rifles and four Hotchkiss mle 14 8mm air-cooled machineguns.


P08204
This unit represents a French cavalry platoon. Usually made up of three squads, it had about 37 men, rifles, pistols, grenades and two light machineguns.


P08205
This unit represents motorcycle platoon. Usually employed in the reconnaissance role, it had 32 men, rifles, pistols and three light machineguns.


P08206
This unit represents a French engineer platoon. French combat engineers have a long and distinguished history, and are the oldest organized professional engineering corps in the world. During the reign of Louis XIV(1643-1715), the Marquis de Vauban organized and systematized the tasks of engineers, creating the world's first professional engineering corps. The combat engineers represented here are a direct result of this. The combat engineer platoon had 45 men, small arms, and an array of combat engineering equipment.


P08207
The Anti-Aircraft Machinegun Section had 15-20 men with two AA machineguns. The weapon primarily used was the 13.2mm Mitrailleuse Hotchkiss de mle 1930. It was roughly equivalent to the US .50-cal machinegun, with a somewhat lower rate of fire and muzzle velocity. Sometimes a dual mount was used, with two machineguns mounted side by side on a heavy (300kg) tripod. The 13.2mm machinegun could also be used in a ground support role.


P08307
This unit represents an army HQ. Pre-war French doctrine was geared toward the defensive. The war envisaged by the French was one similar to WWI. This situation was compounded by a very poor communications system. The result was that French field headquarters were largely unprepared to cope with the mobile type of warfare waged by the Germans in 1940.


P08306
This unit represents a corps HQ. Pre-war French doctrine was geared toward the defensive. The war envisaged by the French was one similar to WWI. This situation was compounded by a very poor communications system. The result was that French field headquarters were largely unprepared to cope with the mobile type of warfare waged by the Germans.


P08301
This unit represents a divisional HQ. Pre-war French doctrine was geared toward the defensive. The war envisaged by the French was one similar to WWI. This situation was compounded by a very poor communications system. The result was that French field headquarters were largely unprepared to cope with the mobile type of warfare waged by the Germans.


P08302
This unit represents a brigade HQ. Pre-war French doctrine was geared toward the defensive. The war envisaged by the French was one similar to WWI. This situation was compounded by a very poor communications system. The result was that French field headquarters were largely unprepared to cope with the mobile type of warfare waged by the Germans.


P08303
This unit represents a regimental HQ. Pre-war French doctrine was geared toward the defensive. The war envisaged by the French was one similar to WWI. This situation was compounded by a very poor communications system. The result was that French field headquarters were largely unprepared to cope with the mobile type of warfare waged by the Germans.


P08304
This unit represents a non-motorized (usually infantry) battalion HQ. Pre-war French doctrine was geared toward the defensive. The war envisaged by the French was one similar to WWI. This situation was compounded by a very poor communications system. The result was that French field headquarters were largely unprepared to cope with the mobile type of warfare waged by the Germans.


P08305
This unit represents a motorized battalion HQ. Pre-war French doctrine was geared toward the defensive. The war envisaged by the French was one similar to WWI. This situation was compounded by a very poor communications system. The result was that French field headquarters were largely unprepared to cope with the mobile type of warfare waged by the Germans.


P08401
To generalize, French Army officers were well trained, brave, and capable of leading France's armed forces in the roles for which it was intended. This role was defined in 1925 by War Minister Paul Painlev as able "to achieve a rational system of national defense, adequate in times of danger but unsuited to adventures and conquests". With some notable exceptions, French officers found it difficult to deal with fluid situations brought about by German mobile warfare.


P08402
To generalize, French Army officers were well trained, brave, and capable of leading France's armed forces in the roles for which it was intended. This role was defined in 1925 by War Minister Paul Painlev as able "to achieve a rational system of national defense, adequate in times of danger but unsuited to adventures and conquests". With some notable exceptions, French officers found it difficult to deal with fluid situations brought about by German mobile warfare.


P08403
To generalize, French Army officers were well trained, brave, and capable of leading France's armed forces in the roles for which it was intended. This role was defined in 1925 by War Minister Paul Painlev as able "to achieve a rational system of national defense, adequate in times of danger but unsuited to adventures and conquests". With some notable exceptions, French officers found it difficult to deal with fluid situations brought about by German mobile warfare.


P08404
To generalize, French Army officers were well trained, brave, and capable of leading France's armed forces in the roles for which it was intended. This role was defined in 1925 by War Minister Paul Painlev as able "to achieve a rational system of national defense, adequate in times of danger but unsuited to adventures and conquests". With some notable exceptions, French officers found it difficult to deal with fluid situations brought about by German mobile warfare.


P08405
To generalize, French Army officers were well trained, brave, and capable of leading France's armed forces in the roles for which it was intended. This role was defined in 1925 by War Minister Paul Painlev as able "to achieve a rational system of national defense, adequate in times of danger but unsuited to adventures and conquests". With some notable exceptions, French officers found it difficult to deal with fluid situations brought about by German mobile warfare.


P08406
To generalize, French Army officers were well trained, brave, and capable of leading France's armed forces in the roles for which it was intended. This role was defined in 1925 by War Minister Paul Painlev as able "to achieve a rational system of national defense, adequate in times of danger but unsuited to adventures and conquests". With some notable exceptions, French officers found it difficult to deal with fluid situations brought about by German mobile warfare.


P08407
To generalize, French Army officers were well trained, brave, and capable of leading France's armed forces in the roles for which it was intended. This role was defined in 1925 by War Minister Paul Painlev as able "to achieve a rational system of national defense, adequate in times of danger but unsuited to adventures and conquests". With some notable exceptions, French officers found it difficult to deal with fluid situations brought about by German mobile warfare.


P08408
To generalize, French Army officers were well trained, brave, and capable of leading France's armed forces in the roles for which it was intended. This role was defined in 1925 by War Minister Paul Painlev as able "to achieve a rational system of national defense, adequate in times of danger but unsuited to adventures and conquests". With some notable exceptions, French officers found it difficult to deal with fluid situations brought about by German mobile warfare.


P08409
To generalize, French Army officers were well trained, brave, and capable of leading France's armed forces in the roles for which it was intended. This role was defined in 1925 by War Minister Paul Painlev as able "to achieve a rational system of national defense, adequate in times of danger but unsuited to adventures and conquests". With some notable exceptions, French officers found it difficult to deal with fluid situations brought about by German mobile warfare.


P08410
To generalize, French Army officers were well trained, brave, and capable of leading France's armed forces in the roles for which it was intended. This role was defined in 1925 by War Minister Paul Painlev as able "to achieve a rational system of national defense, adequate in times of danger but unsuited to adventures and conquests". With some notable exceptions, French officers found it difficult to deal with fluid situations brought about by German mobile warfare.


P09001
Mark VIB & VIC Light Tank: Designed for reconnaissance , these vehicles, which were the mainstay of British armored strength in 1939-40, were often used as main battle tanks by necessity - with often disastrous results. Both models carried a water-cooled .303-caliber machinegun, but the B model also featured a water-cooled .50-caliber machinegun, whereas the C model used an air-cooled 15mm Besa machinegun. Armored and light tank squadrons used these tanks in troops of three. Mk VI models were used in Belgium, France, North Africa, Greece and Crete. Approximately 1180 were built. This unit also represents the earlier light tanks taken from training units and used in Egypt and the UK for home defense following the fall of Dunkirk.

ARMAMENT
1 x .12.7mm machinegun
1 x 7.65mm machinegun
or
1 x 15mm machinegun
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
14mm
WEIGHT
5.5 tonnes

P09002
The Light Tank Mk VII was designed with the intention of its replacing the Light Tank Mk VI. However, during its development period the decision was taken to move from light tanks to armored cars for use in the traditional light tank role. Additionally the factory building them was bombed in 1940 resulting in there being only 177 of this type being built. Unsuitable for use in the desert due to inadequate cooling arrangements, it was first used operationally during the invasion of Madagascar. The tank's main claim to fame, though, was its part in the invasion of Europe where a squadron of Tetrarchs, as they had now been named, were landed by the giant British Hamilcar gliders. Their overall effect was low due to the small numbers involved.

ARMAMENT
1 x 2pdr (40mm) gun
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
14mm
WEIGHT
7.5 tonnes

P09003
This was the Close Support version of the Tetrarch. Like most British tanks with a 2pdr main armament, the Light Tank Mk VII was produced in two basic versions: the gun tank and the close support tank. The difference was only in the main armament, the CS version having a 3-inch howitzer capable of firing both smoke and high explosive.

ARMAMENT
1 x 76mm howitzer
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
14mm
WEIGHT
12.5 tonnes

P09004
The U.S. M3 Stuart I Light Tank was lend-leased to the British beginning in early 1941. Better known to the British as the "Honey" because of its reliability and handling, the Stuart was the first U.S.-built tank to see action in WWII. During Operation Crusader, Stuarts fully equipped the 4th Armoured Brigade of the 7th Armoured Division and were used in the cruiser tank role. By early 1942, U.S.-made medium tanks had arrived in sufficient numbers to relegate the Stuarts to recon and screening role. Regardless of its role, the Stuart gave excellent service and saw action on all fronts.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
2-3 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
38mm
WEIGHT
12.25 tonnes

P09027
The Stuart III was the U.S. M3A1 Light Tank as lend-leased to the British. Better known to the British as the "Honey" because of its reliability and handling, the Stuart served in a variety of roles. It was used as a cruiser tank, recon and screening vehicle and as an armored escort. Regardless of its role, the Stuart gave excellent service and saw action on all fronts. The M3A1 incorporated detail improvements over the M3. This unit represents a two-tank section.
.
ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
2-3 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
38mm
WEIGHT
12.25 tonnes

P09005
The Stuart III was the U.S. M3A1 Light Tank as lend-leased to the British. Better known to the British as the "Honey" because of its reliability and handling, the Stuart served in a variety of roles. It was used as a cruiser tank, recon and screening vehicle and as an armored escort. Regardless of its role, the Stuart gave excellent service and saw action on all fronts. The M3A1 incorporated detail improvements over the M3. This unit represents a three-tank troop.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
2-3 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
38mm
WEIGHT
13 tonnes

P09076
The Stuart V was the U.S. M3A3 Light Tank as lend-leased to the British. The M3A3 was an improved version of the M3A1, featuring a redesigned hull with sloped armor. The Stuart gave excellent service and saw action on all fronts, though it was hopelessly outdated by 1943. This unit represents a two-tank section.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
2-3 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
38mm
WEIGHT
13 tonnes

P09006
The Stuart V was the U.S. M3A3 Light Tank as lend-leased to the British. The M3A3 was an improved version of the M3A1, featuring a redesigned hull with sloped armor. The Stuart gave excellent service and saw action on all fronts, though it was hopelessly outdated by 1943. This unit represents a four-tank troop.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
2-3 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
38mm
WEIGHT
13 tonnes

P09913
The Stuart VI was the U.S. M5A1 light tank as lend-leased to the British. The M5A1 was a complete redesign of the M3A1, featuring thicker armor, sloping front hull plates, and twin Cadillac engines with an automatic transmission. Regardless of the role in which it was used, the Stuart gave excellent service and saw action on all fronts. This unit represents a four-tank troop.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
3 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
38mm
WEIGHT
13 tonnes

P09007
This was the U.S. M22 "Locust" Light Tank, designed from the outset as an air-transportable tank following a design competition between J Walter Christie, GMC and Marmon-Herrington. The Marmon-Herrington version was chosen and, after evaluation as the Light Tank T9, was put into production. Between March 1943 and February 1944, 830 tanks of this type were built. Seriously handicapped in U.S. service by the lack of a suitable American carrier aircraft (it could be carried by the C-54, but only if its turret was removed), a number were supplied to the British who could carry the tank in their Hamilcar glider.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
1 x 7.62mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
25mm
WEIGHT
7.4 tonnes

P09008
Properly known as the Cruiser Tank Mk I (A9), this was a light-weight development of the discontinued Medium Tank Mk III. Powered by a commercial engine, the A9 was developed to meet a 1934 proposal to produce a fast Cruiser (Medium) tank for use within the tank regiments of the Royal Armoured Corps. Powerfully armed for its day with three machineguns (two in independent turrets on the hull front) and a 2pdr main gun, effective both in an anti-armor and anti-infantry role, this tank was disadvantaged only by its slow speed and thin armor. The A9 was used extensively in France 1940 and in the Western Desert until 1941.

ARMAMENT
1 x 2pdr (40mm) gun
3 x 7.65mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
14mm
WEIGHT
13 tonnes

P09009
The main drawback of British tanks of the early war period was that the 2pdr main gun they were usually armed with had no high explosive or smoke capability. While it was considered that tank-mounted machineguns could deal with enemy infantry and the main gun could easily deal with any contemporary enemy armored vehicle, the lack of smoke was considered a serious problem. Whilst all British tanks of the period were issued with smoke candles for self concealment, they had no means of projecting smoke cover. The CS (or Close Support) tank addressed this problem with a 3.7-inch howitzer that fired a 4.77kg smoke shell replacing the 2pdr gun of the "Gun Tanks".

ARMAMENT
1 x 94mm howitzer
3 x 7.65mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
14mm
WEIGHT
13 tonnes

P09010
The Cruiser Tank Mk II (A10) was a progressive development of the A9 with the same boat-shaped hull and "slow motion" suspension. As a development of the A9 it was intended that the A10 would rectify some of the shortcomings of the earlier design, particularly in the area of protection with 30mm of frontal armor as opposed to the 14mm of the A9. The increase in armor was gained by bolting on new face plates to the basic A9 structure around the hull front and turret, this being the first time this technique was used on a British tank. This increase in protection was not gained without cost. Speed dropped to about half that of the A9, too slow to be considered a true cruiser tank. But since it was still too lightly armored to be considered an infantry tank, the A10 was given the new designation of "Heavy Cruiser". The multi-turreted approach of the A9 was dropped with this model. This was done as a weight saving measure, not as an indication of a change of tactical doctrine. Both the A9 and A10 were considered "stop-gap" vehicles because in 1937, prior to A10 production, the decision had already been made to develop new cruiser types based upon the designs of Walter Christie.

ARMAMENT
1 x 2pdr (40mm) gun
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
30mm
WEIGHT
14 tonnes

P09011
Hand in hand with the production of the A10 gun tank was the A10 CS. Only 30 of this variant were built, and like the A9 CS, they were armed with the 3.7-inch Mortar (howitzer) OQF Mk I, a single-use weapon in that it could only fire smoke. In battle, CS (Close Support) tanks would accompany the squadron headquarters of the tank regiments, protecting the gun tanks by laying smoke screens for the gun tanks to maneuver behind. As a general point regarding the armor of the A9/A10 series tanks it is true to say that although the armor was comparatively thin it was well laid out and generally well sloped, especially around the turret - a design feature well in advance of many competing designs.

ARMAMENT
1 x 94mm howitzer
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
30mm
WEIGHT
14.4 tonnes

P09012
The Cruiser Tanks Mk III and IV (A13) were inspired by the Russian BT tank, which was in turn inspired by the designs of Walter Christie. The A13 was built at the insistence of Lt. Colonel G. Le Q. Martel to be faster than the previous Cruiser tanks. At almost twice the speed of the A9 this was the first tank to be fitted with an engine governor to keep the speed down and thus avoid mechanical complications. In the field the governors were on occasion disabled by the crews to allow better running speed. It was produced in three main versions: the Mk I, Mk II, and a CS (Close Support) version. The main difference between the Mk I (65 built) and Mk II (655 built) was that the Mk IIs were built to the new cruiser standard of having 30mm of armor protection in vulnerable areas. It was a measure of the basic quality of this design that although the Mk II was over 1000kg heavier it suffered no noticeable drop in achievable speed. Armament of both types was identical but turrets differed. The A13 Mk I (Cruiser Mk III) was issued with a standard A10 type turret but the A13 Mk II (Cruiser Mk IV) had a redesigned turret fitted with a distinctive hexagonal appearance, spaced armor facing, another first for the tank. Both the Mk I and Mk II are represented in the game. Figures below are for the more numerous Cruiser Mk IV (A13 Mk II).

ARMAMENT
1 x 2pdr (40mm) gun
1x 7.65mm or 7.92mm MG
MAX ARMOR
30mm
WEIGHT
15 tonnes

P09013
Approximately one in ten of all British tanks of the period were CS (Close Support) tanks, a figure born of necessity as the British 2pdr gun with which Cruiser and Infantry Gun Tanks were fitted were incapable of firing smoke or high explosive. The 3.7-inch smoke mortar fitted in this tank could fire smoke but not high explosive, a disadvantage that rapidly became apparent during early engagements with the Germans and consequentially this was the last tank to be issued with this gun.

ARMAMENT
1 x 94mm howitzer
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
30mm
WEIGHT
15 tonnes

P09099
The Cruiser tank Mk VI (A15) was a progressive development of the unsuccessful Cruiser tank Mk V (A13 Mk III, Covenanter). Popularly known as the Crusader, this tank featured a longer hull with a modified Christie suspension. Built too late to incorporate the lessons learnt in France in 1940, the early Crusader Mk Is had their bow machinegun fitted in an independent turret but this was quickly deleted from later types. Well respected by the Germans for its speed, it was nevertheless no match for the German Mk IIIs and IVs in either hitting power or armor. With a five-man crew and roomy turret it could sustain a high rate of fire from its 2-pounder main armament, but mechanically it was unreliable. Differences between the Crusader Mk I and Mk II (both represented by this unit) included a slightly thicker frontal armor in the Mk II and the elimination of the frontal independent MG turret at the production stage. Total production for Mk Is and Mk IIs was over 5,300 vehicles. This unit represents the more early tank regiment organization in which three tanks were issued per troop (platoon). Figures below are for the Mk II.

ARMAMENT
1 x 2pdr (40mm) gun
1-2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
49mm
WEIGHT
19.3 tonnes

P09014
The Cruiser tank Mk VI (A15) was a progressive development of the unsuccessful Cruiser tank Mk V (A13 Mk III, Covenanter). Popularly known as the Crusader, this tank featured a longer hull with a modified Christie suspension. Built too late to incorporate the lessons learnt in France in 1940, the early Crusader Mk Is had their bow machinegun fitted in an independent turret but this was quickly deleted from later types. Well respected by the Germans for its speed, it was nevertheless no match for the German Mk IIIs and IVs in either hitting power or armor. With a five-man crew and roomy turret it could sustain a high rate of fire from its 2-pounder main armament, but mechanically it was unreliable. Differences between the Crusader Mk I and Mk II (both represented by this unit) included a slightly thicker frontal armor in the Mk II and the elimination of the frontal independent MG turret at the production stage. Total production for Mk Is and Mk IIs was over 5,300 vehicles. This unit represents the later tank regiment organization in which four tanks were issued per troop (platoon) This four-tank per troop organization was also used from the outset by Canadian armoured regiments. Figures below are for the Mk II.

ARMAMENT
1 x 2pdr (40mm) gun
1-2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
49mm
WEIGHT
19.3 tonnes

P09015
Like the earlier Cruisers equipped with the 2pdr gun as main armament, the Crusader was incapable of firing HE. To rectify this situation a close support version of the Crusader was placed in production, this time armed with a 3-inch howitzer. Approximately one in ten of all Crusader tanks were CS (Close Support) versions, and were issued to HQ elements to provide fire support to gun tanks. The Crusader CS was produced in both Mk I and Mk II versions alongside the corresponding Crusader 2pdr gun tanks. Figures below are for the Mk II version.

ARMAMENT
1 x 76mm howitzer
1-2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
49mm
WEIGHT
19.3 tonnes

P09016
The Crusader Mk III was a development of the earlier Mks I and II wherein the 2pdr main gun was replaced with the much more powerful 6pdr (57mm) gun. This change was not made without cost. The larger gun required much more turret room and ammunition stowage space, and crew numbers dropped by two, weight also rose and speed dropped as the armor was increased. In production from May 1942, 144 being completed by July of the same year. There was no CS (Close Support) version of this model but the chassis was used for a family of vehicles including gun-towers, anti-aircraft tanks and other non-combat versions. Issued at a rate of four tanks per troop.

ARMAMENT
1x 6pdr (57mm) gun
MAX ARMOR
51mm
WEIGHT
20 tonnes

P09017
This tank could be described as a life saver for the British. Supplied directly to the 8th Army struggling in the desert in their darkest hour, the Grant helped stem the tide of Rommel's advance. With its turret-mounted 37mm anti-tank gun, it was capable of engaging the early German panzers with a reasonable degree of success, and with its 75mm main gun mounted in the front superstructure it was capable of engaging both German anti-tank guns with HE and German armor with armor-piercing rounds. This unit represents both the Anglicized M3 Grant and standard production American M3 Lee.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm gun
1 x 37mm gun
3-4 x 7.62mm MGs
MAX ARMOR
76mm
WEIGHT
28.2 tonnes

P09018
Built on the chassis of the M3 Lee, the M4 Sherman was quite possibly the most famous tank of the war. Built in massive numbers and supplied to all of the Allies, this tank fought in every theater of the war. In West Front, this unit represents all of the generic Sherman Is, IIs, IIIs and Vs, all armed with the 75mm dual-purpose anti-tank/high-explosive gun. Differences in model numbers really relate (in this instance) to variations in powerplant and internal arrangements. At Alamein the M4 Sherman made up half of the total tank strength committed to the battle by the British. The great advantage of this tank was its main gun. While it is true to say that it could not penetrate armor the way the 6pdr could, it could fire HE - something most British tanks of the period could not do. In effect it could take on both infantry and armor with equal ease. Not without cost though, it was known to the Germans as "The Tommy Cooker" because of its tendency to explode when hit. Its relatively thin armor and lack of hitting power became apparent as the Germans developed new tanks and weapons from 1943 onwards. The deficiencies of the Sherman became quickly apparent when matched against Tigers or Panthers. This unit represents an early to mid period British tank troop equipped with three tanks.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm gun
2 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
76mm
WEIGHT
30.2-32.3 tonnes

P09905
Built on the chassis of the M3 Lee, the M4 Sherman was quite possibly the most famous tank of the war. Built in massive numbers and supplied to all of the Allies, this tank fought in every theater of the war. In West Front, this unit represents all of the generic Sherman Is, IIs, IIIs and Vs, all armed with the 75mm dual-purpose anti-tank/high-explosive gun. Differences in model numbers really relate (in this instance) to variations in powerplant and internal arrangements. At Alamein the M4 Sherman made up half of the total tank strength committed to the battle by the British. The great advantage of this tank was its main gun. While it is true to say that it could not penetrate armor the way the 6pdr could, it could fire HE - something most British tanks of the period could not do. In effect it could take on both infantry and armor with equal ease. Not without cost though, it was known to the Germans as "The Tommy Cooker" because of its tendency to explode when hit. Its relatively thin armor and lack of hitting power became apparent as the Germans developed new tanks and weapons from 1943 onwards. The deficiencies of the Sherman became quickly apparent when matched against Tigers or Panthers. This unit represents a later period British tank troop equipped with 4 tanks.

ARMAMENT
1x 75mm M3 gun
2 x 7.62mm MGs
MAX ARMOR
76mm
WEIGHT
30.2-32.3 tonnes

P09098
Built on the chassis of the M3 Lee, the M4 Sherman was quite possibly the most famous tank of the war. Built in massive numbers and supplied to all of the Allies, this tank fought in every theater of the war. In West Front, this unit represents all of the generic Sherman Is, IIs, IIIs and Vs, all armed with the 75mm dual-purpose anti-tank/high-explosive gun. Differences in model numbers really relate (in this instance) to variations in powerplant and internal arrangements. At Alamein the M4 Sherman made up half of the total tank strength committed to the battle by the British. The great advantage of this tank was its main gun. While it is true to say that it could not penetrate armor the way the 6pdr could, it could fire HE- something most British tanks of the period could not do. In effect it could take on both infantry and armor with equal ease. Not without cost though, it was known to the Germans as "The Tommy Cooker" because of its tendency to explode when hit. Its relatively thin armor and lack of hitting power became apparent as the Germans developed new tanks and weapons from 1943 onwards. The deficiencies of the Sherman became quickly apparent when matched against Tigers or Panthers. This unit represents a tank troop equipped with two tanks as used by some formations in the Italian campaign.

ARMAMENT
1x 75mm M3 gun
2 x 7.62mm MGs
MAX ARMOR
76mm
WEIGHT
30.2-32.3 tonnes

P09019
By mid 1943 the Sherman with its 75mm gun was almost entirely incapable of penetrating the frontal armor of contemporary German armor. To counter this the British using typical ingenuity mounted the superb 17pdr gun in a modified Sherman turret and called it the Firefly. The modification was a success and a massive conversion program was undertaken. Modifications to the basic Sherman included the removal of the bow machinegun to provide room for ammunition storage and an extension to the rear of the turret to make room for the massive breech of the 17pdr. At the same time crew numbers were dropped to three. It was an emergency solution but it did work. At last British troops had a tank that could engage a late model panzer with a reasonable prospect of success. The only drawbacks were that the Firefly tended to burn just as easily as any other Sherman and, with reduced crew numbers dealing with heavier shells, fatigue became an issue. This unit represents a British tank troop (platoon) organized along early lines with a three tank troop, two of the tanks being 75mm gunned Shermans and the third having the longer ranged more powerful 17pdr. Figures below are for the Firefly.

ARMAMENT
1 x 17pdr (76mm) gun
1 x 7.62mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
76mm
WEIGHT
32 tonnes

P09906
By mid 1943 the Sherman with its 75mm gun was almost entirely incapable of penetrating the frontal armor of contemporary German armor. To counter this the British using typical ingenuity mounted the superb 17pdr gun in a modified Sherman turret and called it the Firefly. The modification was a success and a massive conversion program was undertaken. Modifications to the basic Sherman included the removal of the bow machinegun to provide room for ammunition storage and an extension to the rear of the turret to make room for the massive breech of the 17pdr. At the same time crew numbers were dropped to three. It was an emergency solution but it did work. At last British troops had a tank that could engage a late model panzer with a reasonable prospect of success. The only drawbacks were that the Firefly tended to burn just as easily as any other Sherman and, with reduced crew numbers dealing with heavier shells, fatigue became an issue. This unit represents a mid period tank troop when the Firefly was still new and was only available in small numbers and was issued on a scale of one Firefly per troop of three tanks, the other two being standard Shermans with the 75mm dual-purpose gun. Figures below are for a Firefly.

ARMAMENT
1 x 17pdr (76mm) gun
1 x 7.62mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
76mm
WEIGHT
32 tonnes

P09907
By mid 1943 the Sherman with its 75mm gun was almost entirely incapable of penetrating the frontal armor of contemporary German armor. To counter this the British using typical ingenuity mounted the superb 17pdr gun in a modified Sherman turret and called it the Firefly. The modification was a success and a massive conversion program was undertaken. Modifications to the basic Sherman included the removal of the bow machinegun to provide room for ammunition storage and an extension to the rear of the turret to make room for the massive breech of the 17pdr. At the same time crew numbers were dropped to three. It was an emergency solution but it did work. At last British troops had a tank that could engage a late model panzer with a reasonable prospect of success. The only drawbacks were that the Firefly tended to burn just as easily as any other Sherman and, with reduced crew numbers dealing with heavier shells, fatigue became an issue. This unit represents a mid period tank troop when the Firefly was available in greater numbers and issued on a scale of two per four tank troop. Figures below are for a Firefly.

ARMAMENT
1 x 17pdr (76mm) gun
1 x 7.62mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
76mm
WEIGHT
32 tonnes

P09020
The British/Commonwealth forces were also issued with a quantity of 76mm gunned Shermans. Known in British service as the Sherman IIA, these 76mm gunned Shermans whilst still not having the firepower of a 17pdr were considerably more powerful than the 75mm gunned Shermans. Unlike the Firefly this increase in power was not gained at the expense of some of the more useful aspects of the 75mm gunned Sherman; for instance, it continued to have a five man crew, the bow machinegun was retained and weight (when compared to the 75mm gunned version) did not rise significantly. Available to the British only in small numbers, this unit represents a standard three tank troop of Shermans stiffened somewhat by the substitution of a 75mm gunned Sherman with a 76mm gunned Sherman. This type of troop was used primarily in Italy.

ARMAMENT
1 x 76mm
2 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
89mm
WEIGHT
31.8 tonnes

P09021
The British/Commonwealth forces were also issued with a quantity of 76mm gunned Shermans. Known in British service as the Sherman IIA, these 76mm gunned Shermans whilst still not having the firepower of a 17pdr were considerably more powerful than the 75mm gunned Shermans. Unlike the Firefly this increase in power was not gained at the expense of some of the more useful aspects of the 75mm gunned Sherman; for instance, it continued to have a five man crew, the bow machinegun was retained and weight (when compared to the 75mm gunned version) did not rise significantly. As production of this new 76mm gunned model rose it became available in greater and greater numbers. This unit represents a tank troop with its full establishment of three tanks wholly made up of 76mm gunned Shermans. This type of troop was used primarily in Italy.

ARMAMENT
1 x 76mm
2 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
89mm
WEIGHT
31.8 tonnes

P09022
This unit represents the CS (close support) troop attached to all British HQ tank formations. Designated Sherman 1B, this model of Sherman was equipped with a 105mm howitzer. Acting in concert with the gun tanks, CS tanks provided close support by disrupting enemy anti-tank positions and infantry in improved positions.

ARMAMENT
1 x 105mm howitzer
2 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
76mm
WEIGHT
30.2-31 tonnes

P09023
This was the "Liberty"-engined model of the A27 design and was known as the Cruiser tank Mk VIII or A27L. Given the popular name Centaur it was regarded as an interim type until the A27M, the Meteor-engined version could be got into production. Early production Centaur Mk Is were armed with the 6pdr gun, but later Mk IIIs had a new 75mm. By 1943 existing Centaur gun tanks were either converted into A27Ms (Cromwells) or special purpose variants such as AA tanks, Kangaroos and OP tanks. The Centaurs represented in the game are the close support Mk IV version armed with the new 95mm gun. These vehicles were extensively used on D-Day by the Royal Marine Armoured Support Group, being landed over the beaches to provide close support to the landing. This was the only Centaur type to be used in action other than the special purpose variants.

ARMAMENT
1 x 95mm howitzer
1-2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
76mm
WEIGHT
28.8 tonnes

P09908
The "Meteor"-engined version of the A27 design retained the same designation as the slightly earlier Centaur, being known in official circles as the Cruiser Tank Mk VIII. Known as the Cromwell, this tank can be regarded as the British Sherman. Initially issued with the 6pdr, production swiftly switched to a version with a British 75mm dual-purpose gun. Additionally many of the earlier A27Ls were converted to A27M standard by installing the new powerplant. Later versions lost their bow machinegun to make space for additional ammunition storage. Armor protection also increased during its life from a maximum of 76mm to 101mm with the addition of appliqu armor. This armor was first applied by the simple expedient of bolting on additional plates but later models had welded armor. Within the game this unit represents a troop of Cromwells forming part of an armoured reconnaissance regiment.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm gun
1-2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
76-101mm
WEIGHT
28-28.5 tonnes

P09909
This unit represents the tank troops of the 7th Armoured Division. Following D-Day it became rapidly apparent that the Cromwell-equipped troops of the armoured regiments were no match for late-model German tanks. To stiffen the firepower of the Cromwell troops, a Sherman Firefly was added on a scale of one per troop. With its 17pdr gun it was able to give a measure of long range anti-tank capability.

ARMAMENT
(Cromwell)
1 x 75mm gun
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
and
(Firefly)
1 x 17pdr (76mm) gun
1 x 7.62mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
76-101mm (Cromwell)
76mm (Firefly)
WEIGHT
28-28.5 tonnes (Cromwell)
33 tonnes (Firefly)

P09024
Just as in the armoured regiments it was found that the Cromwell was no match for late model German tanks, the same was also true of the armoured reconnaissance regiments. To alleviate the plight of the recce. Regiments, the Cruiser tank A30 Challenger was issued on a scale of one per troop. The A30 was an expedient design mounting the 17pdr gun. Compared to the A27 Cromwell/Centaur design, the A30 had a stretched and widened hull with an extra road wheel. On top of this new hull was placed the 17pdr turret, first developed for the experimental tank the TOG2. The Challenger had a high silhouette and because of its larger size (compared to the A27 design), whilst still retaining the same powerplant, the vehicle was slow and unwieldy. It also required a six-man crew. The only saving grace of the Challenger was its 17pdr gun.

ARMAMENT
(Cromwell)
1 x 75mm gun
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
and
(Challenger)
1 x 17pdr (76mm) gun
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
76-101mm (Cromwell)
101mm (Challenger)
WEIGHT
28-28.5 tonnes (Cromwell)
33 tonnes (Challenger)

P09025
This was the close support version of the Cromwell tank, armed with a 95mm howitzer. All British armoured regiments had CS (close support) tanks attached to HQ formations throughout the war. The 95mm howitzer fitted in this model was capable of firing HE and HEAT, and was the Cromwell equivalent of the Centaur IV. Depending upon availability, two or three CS tanks were attached to each squadron (U.S. company) and regimental (U.S. battalion) HQ.

ARMAMENT
1 x 95mm howitzer
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
76-101mm
WEIGHT
28-28.5 tonnes

P09026
The Comet was the best British tank of World War II (with the exception of the six prototype Centurions dispatched to Germany just before the end of hostilities). Developed from the A27 series, it featured a widened hull (without any significant increase in length) coupled with a new suspension based on the Christie type, but with return rollers added. Its most significant feature though (fitted in a low silhouette turret) was the brand new 77mm high velocity gun. Developed from the superb 17pdr, the 77mm OQF had both a shorter chamber and barrel enabling the weapon to be fitted in what was a comparatively small turret. The 77mm, despite its apparent disadvantages when compared to its illustrious parent, had to all intents and purposes more or less the same hitting power. This tank can be seen from the British viewpoint as being the final nail in the coffin of the panzer. Of all-welded construction, mechanically reliable, hard hitting, the Comet can be viewed as a contender for the title "Best tank of The War". More reliable than the Panther, fully crewed and equipped when compared to the T-34, it was a war winner. First issued to fighting units in December 1944, it did not appear in any real quantities until March 1945.

ARMAMENT
1 x 77mm gun
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
101mm
WEIGHT
33.7 tonnes

P09028
The Crab is the third of the "Funnies" to be represented within the game. It was a British-designed device used to clear mines. An M4 Sherman was fitted with a rotating drum to which were attached 43 flailing chains which beat the ground in front of the vehicle to explode the mines. In addition, wire cutters were located at the sides of the drum to cut barbed wire. The highly specialized 79th Armoured Division that was the home of all the "Funnies" used "Crabs" throughout the 1944-45 European campaign. Employed in troops of five, these vehicles were dispatched from the 79th to assist other units on an as-needed basis. Flailing speed was between 2 and 4 mph.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm gun
2 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
76mm
WEIGHT
33 tonnes

P09029
The Infantry Tank Mk I, Matilda I (A11) to give it its full title, was a small but very heavily armored two-man tankette. Designed by Sir John Carden as an infantry support tank, it was armed only with a single machinegun and crept along at a measly 5 mph top speed. Prior to 1940, however, it was invulnerable to all known tank and anti-tank weapons likely to be deployed by a prospective enemy. Regarded as an interim type only, it was nevertheless built in what was for the period large numbers (140 excluding prototypes) and was deployed in France 1940. Following the withdrawal from Dunkirk the Matilda I was used only for training purposes; however, some were again deployed as a result of the invasion scare of September 1940.

ARMAMENT
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
or
1 x 7.65mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
60mm
WEIGHT
11.1 tonnes

P09030
The Infantry Tank Mk II, Matilda II, (A12) was a much larger tank than the Matilda I. With its four-man crew serving its 2pdr gun, protected by the heaviest armor, it was more than a match for any tank in existence. Produced in large numbers (2,987 until 1943) and used in all theaters of the war and even used post-war by Australian reserve forces, it roundly deserved its epitaph of being "Queen of The Battlefield". Sometimes known as the Matilda Senior, it was first used in any quantity against the Germans at the battle of Arras in France. Wherein, a small number of Matildas advancing in the dawn's cold light blunted the tip of Hitler's armored spearhead. Scattering German soldiers to the four winds in rout, the attack stalled only as the Matildas, advancing now without support, bore down on Rommel's own divisional headquarters where they were stopped by the might of 88mm AA guns nearby. What had been only the day before a race to the Channel became a cautious advance, and the BEF was saved. Using the time gained, the majority of the BEF was able to withdraw to Dunkirk. Employed in nearly all the important desert battles, this tank was often called upon to act in the cruiser role where despite its slow speed it distinguished itself.

ARMAMENT
1 x 2pdr (40mm) gun
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
78mm
WEIGHT
26.9 tonnes

P09032
Strangely for an infantry support tank, the Matilda II's main gun the 2pdr had no HE capability. To rectify this the Matilda III was introduced, carrying a 3-inch howitzer. Acting in direct support of the gun tanks, the CS (close support) tanks were issued on a scale of two per HQ troop (platoon).

ARMAMENT
1 x 3-inch (76mm) howitzer
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
78mm
WEIGHT
26.9 tonnes

P09031
The Matilda Scorpion I was a Matilda II adapted to mine clearing, based on the ideas of Major Du Toit, an engineer serving with the South African forces. He suggested that a weighted chain spun against the ground ahead of a slowly advancing tank would detonate land mines. He was sent to England where he set to work developing the Baron, a turretless Matilda derivative. Meanwhile forces in the desert could not afford to wait for this new weapon. Acting on their own initiative they developed the Matilda Scorpion. A 30 hp Bedford engine and operator's position was attached to the forward right hull front of a standard Matilda gun tank, the additional engine drove a flail device ahead of the tank to detonate mines. The same system was later adapted for use on both Grant and Valentine tanks. Scorpions were first used at the 2nd Battle of Alamein where 32 of them drove across minefields opening wide gaps in what were believed by the Germans to be secure flanks, thus forcing a leak that was soon to be a deluge as British forces drove the Germans back--in what was to be their last retreat in Africa--all the way to Tunisia. Of Alamein, Churchill wrote in his memoirs that prior to Alamein Britain never achieved victory and after Britain never suffered defeat.

ARMAMENT
1 x 2pdr (40mm) gun
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
78 mm
WEIGHT
29 tonnes

P09033
Based on the chassis and suspension of the A9/A10 series of cruiser tanks, the Infantry Tank Mk III Valentine was developed as a private venture by Vickers and as such never received an ordnance designation ("A" number). Often mistaken as being a light tank because of its diminutive size, the Valentine was in fact a slow moving heavily armored infantry tank. Built in very large numbers, by 1943 the Valentine made up a quarter of British tank strength. Built both in Britain and Canada, this type was also an important Lend-Lease type with all of the Canadian production bar 30 retained for training being sent to Russia. First deployed to the Western Desert, the Valentine was initially used in the Cruiser role due to lack of other types. Initially produced with a 2pdr gun in a two-man turret, production swiftly changed to one with an improved three-man turret. This unit represents all these early production 2pdr gun tanks issued to armoured regiments in troops of three.

ARMAMENT
1 x 2pdr (40mm) gun
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
65mm
WEIGHT
17.7 tonnes

P09034
By 1942 it was apparent that the Valentine with its low speed and lack of hitting power was reaching the end of its useful life. In order to extend the usefulness of the tank the turret was again redesigned and fitted with a 6pdr gun. Whilst the 6pdr was a considerable improvement on the 2pdr, its larger size necessitated a reduction of the turret crew to two men and the loss of the vehicle's coaxial machinegun. This unit represents a troop of these newer 6pdr Valentines.

ARMAMENT
1 x 6pdr (57mm) gun
MAX ARMOR
65mm
WEIGHT
18.6 tonnes

P09035
The Infantry Tank Mk IV Churchill was developed to meet a War Office specification set in 1939 and given the ordnance number A22. Initially envisaged as a throwback to the "Shelled Area" tanks of The Great War, the A22 design was developed into one of the most important British tanks of the war. Rushed into service before development was fully completed the Churchill quickly gained a reputation for poor reliability. Churchill himself was incensed that a vehicle bearing his name should perform so badly and consideration was given to discontinuing production. Engineers from the factories were sent to front line units and a redesign program was instated, these measures together with an extensive re-work program brought the tank up to standard. The most heavily armored of any Allied standard production tank the Churchill was for many years nearly invulnerable to German AT weapons, but again in common with most early British tanks, it didn't have the power to effectively fight back. This unit represents very early production Churchill Mk 1s with a 3-inch howitzer mounted in the bow and a 2pdr in the turret. Used operationally only during the Dieppe Raid, the Mk I was quickly superseded in production by separate Gun/CS types.

ARMAMENT
1 x 2pdr (40mm) gun
1 x 3-inch (76mm) howitzer
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
102mm
WEIGHT
39.6 tonnes

P09036
A development of the Churchill II, the Churchill III featured a 6pdr gun fitted in a new turret. This together with a host of detailed improvements was the turning point for the Churchill series of tanks. Proving themselves in the hills of Tunisia they were the only Allied tank which showed any degree of survivability when engaged in combat with the German Panzertruppen. Plans to discontinue Churchill production were shelved and development of the basic design was reinstituted.

ARMAMENT
1 x 6pdr (57mm) gun
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
102mm
WEIGHT
39.8 tonnes

P09901
Progressive development of the basic Churchill III lead to this, the Churchill IV. The main feature of this design was the introduction of a new "cast" as opposed to the welded turret previously seen on the Mk III. Other than this new turret, this tank was otherwise identical to the earlier 6pdr model. First produced in mid 1942 early production models had the Mk5 6pdr with its lighter, longer barrel than the Mk 3 6pdr the majority were fitted with. This model is notable for two other reasons. Firstly, it was chosen as the model from which Churchill Crocodiles (q.v.) would be based on; and secondly, of more pressing importance to troops in the field, 120 of this model were modified by the Brigade workshops of the 8th Army to mount the American 75mm dual purpose gun. Starting in January 1943 both the gun and mounting of redundant and war weary M4s were removed and fitted to the turrets of Churchill IVs. Thus making the Churchill the first British tank to mount this or any other dual purpose main gun. The modified Churchill's were known as Churchill Mk IV (NA75) and proved to be a great success.

ARMAMENT
1 x 6pdr (57mm) gun
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
102mm
WEIGHT
39.9 tonnes

P09037
Complying with standard British procedures the Churchill was also produced in a CS (close support) version. The Churchill V was fitted with a 95mm howitzer capable of firing HE, Smoke and HEAT ammunition. Only 10% of Churchill production amounted to CS versions. CS tanks were attached to all tank HQ formations primarily for the purpose of laying smoke screens to protect the gun tanks. As the war progressed though, CS tanks found themselves actively attacking enemy anti-tank defenses and even using their HEAT in self defense or in defense of the HQs.

ARMAMENT
1 x 95mm howitzer
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
102mm
WEIGHT
39.6 tonnes

P09038
This was a Churchill IV with a base modification to bring the vehicle roughly up to Mk VII standard. Following the success of the Churchill NA75 with the 8th Army, Churchill IVs in Britain were modified by replacing the 6pdr with a British built 75mm gun. Other improvements included the addition of a cupola to the turret and introducing vane sights. Churchill VIs were used during the liberation of Western Europe. Within the game this unit also represents the Churchill IV (NA75) where starting in January 1943 both the gun and mounting of redundant and war weary M4s were removed and fitted to the turrets of Churchill IVs, thus making the Churchill the first British tank to mount this or any other dual purpose main gun. 

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm gun
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
102mm
WEIGHT
40 tonnes

P09039
Introduced to service in time for the Campaign in Europe the Churchill VII (A22F) was a major redesign of the basic Churchill design. Improvements were made to the gearbox, escape hatches, turret design, suspension and with the wargamer in mind it featured a 75mm British built main gun and much heavier armor. This tank later redesignated A42 was considered such a good design that many continued in service postwar with British forces both at home and abroad. With a maximum armor thickness of 152mm and nowhere less than 25mm, it was the most heavily armored standard production allied tank of World War II.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm gun
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
152mm
WEIGHT
40.6 tonnes

P09040
Built and issued alongside the Churchill Mk VII was this, the Mk VIII. Like the Churchill V this was a CS (close support) tank armed with the same 95mm Howitzer. It was however built to the same standard as the Mk VII with its thicker armor base and numerous detail improvements.

ARMAMENT
1 x 95mm howitzer
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
152mm
WEIGHT
40.6 tonnes

P09042
Second of "The Funnies", the Churchill AVRE (Armoured Vehicle, Royal Engineers) was a specially converted Churchill Mk III or IV where the 6pdr main gun was replaced by a 290mm spigot mortar. This device was especially designed for the purpose of "Bunker Busting" and their presence along with the other "Funnies" on the British and Canadian beaches on D-Day effectively prevented the disaster that afflicted the Americans on "Omaha". Chosen by the engineers for its roomy interior and side escape hatches (allowing egress under fire) the AVRE was much more than a bomb thrower. All AVREs were fitted to take anti-mine devices such as CIRD (the Canadian Indestructible Roller Device) and were put to a whole host of uses such as carrying the combat store of engineers, tow Snake and Viper (anti-mine explosives), carry fascines, lay carpets over soft sand or even lay explosives such as the "carrot" device intended to blow holes through sea walls. It will, though, be best remembered as acting in close companionship with its sister vehicle the Crocodile for its role in demolishing the armored ratholes of the Nazis both on the Atlantic and West Walls. Hitler's "Fortress Europe" dissolved in ash and smoke in the face of vehicles such as these.

ARMAMENT
1 x 290mm projector
1 x 7.92mm Besa MG
MAX ARMOR
102mm
WEIGHT
39.6 tonnes

P09043
First of the "Funnies" the Churchill Crocodile was an adaptation of a standard Churchill IV for the flamethrowing role. The Crocodile equipment comprised a flame projector fitted in place of the bow machinegun connected by an under-chassis link to an armored fuel trailer packed with enough napalm for eighty one-second bursts. Powered by pressurized nitrogen, the Crocodile equipment had the impressive (for a flamethrower) range of 120 yards. Like the AVRE this weapon was especially developed for the purpose of clearing bunkers and heavily entrenched infantry. The flame weapon killed by means of depriving the nearby air of oxygen and thus asphyxiating its unfortunate victims.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm gun
1 x flamethrower
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
102mm
WEIGHT
45 tonnes

P09044
An armored version of the AEC Matador MAT (Medium Artillery Tractor), the Deacon was designed to be a faster, better protected self-propelled anti-tank gun than the 2pdr Portees first used in the early desert battles. It mounted a 6pdr gun in a partially open turret. Although it was successful on many occasions, it was slow and had an overloaded chassis. 176 were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 6pdr (57mm) gun
MAX ARMOR
14mm
WEIGHT
8 tonnes

P09045
This was an unmodified American M10 tank destroyer supplied by Lend-Lease to British forces. Issued in troops of four to the anti-tank battalions of armoured divisions and equipped with the 3-inch gun it was a useful device by which the heavier German tanks could be engaged. Based on the chassis of the M4 but built to a thinner armor base, the M10 suffered no real loss of protection due to its well designed and sloped hull. It was however (like many vehicles of its type) open topped, which did make the crew highly vulnerable to air-burst artillery and fire from above.

ARMAMENT
1 x 3-inch (76mm) gun
1 x 7.65mm Bren MG
MAX ARMOR
57mm
WEIGHT
29.6 tonnes

P09046
A British adaptation of the American M10, the 3-inch gun of the American vehicle was replaced by a 17pdr anti-tank gun in a slightly modified turret. Known as the Achilles, this was a highly successful adaptation with the hitting power of the 17pdr being obtained without significant increase in weight or loss of maneuverability. Like the M10 it was issued to the anti-tank battalions of armoured divisions.

ARMAMENT
1 x 17pdr (76mm) gun
1 x 7.65mm Bren MG
MAX ARMOR
57mm
WEIGHT
29.6 tonnes

P09047
Originally conceived as a means to get the 17pdr into service as quickly as possible, the Self-Propelled Gun "Archer" was a converted late model Valentine Infantry Tank. The turret was removed and an open topped fighting compartment was built up around the front of the vehicle, the 17pdr main gun was fitted so that its barrel pointed backwards, obliging the crew to "advance backwards" into battle. This though was not a great problem because, like all tank destroyer designs, this vehicle worked best from an ambush position and was never intended for offensive operations. First used in action in October 1944 this vehicle proved so useful and capable in its role it remained in service with the British (and many other) Armies for many years.

ARMAMENT
1 x 17pdr (76mm) gun
1 x 7.65mm Bren MG
MAX ARMOR
60mm
WEIGHT
16.75 tonnes

P09048
The Daimler Scout Car was a result of a War Office request for a small, partially armored vehicle, for use in scouting and liaison roles. More commonly known as the Dingo, this vehicle incorporated some very advanced design concepts for its time. The design was so successful 6,626 vehicles of five different Marks were built. This unit represents one scout car for use with airlanding units

ARMAMENT
1 x machinegun
MAX ARMOR
14mm
WEIGHT
3 tonnes

P09049
The Daimler Scout Car was a result of a War Office request for a small, partially armored vehicle, for use in scouting and liaison roles. More commonly known as the Dingo, this vehicle incorporated some very advanced design concepts for its time. The design was so successful 6,626 vehicles of five different Marks were built. Additionally, Ford of Canada produced a copy of the Daimler called the Lynx, 3225 were built. Humber also answered the called for scout cars, building 4300 units. This unit represents a two-car section.

ARMAMENT
1 x machinegun
MAX ARMOR
14-20mm
WEIGHT
3-4.5 tonnes

P09050
The Stuart Recce was a Stuart light tank with its turret removed for use in the reconnaissance role. It was also fitted with a pintle-mounted machinegun. The resulting vehicle was lighter, faster and much less conspicuous.

ARMAMENT
2 x machineguns
MAX ARMOR
38mm
WEIGHT
12 tonnes

P09051
The Humber III and Otter Light Reconnaissance Cars evolved from the many wheeled AFV (armored fighting vehicle) designs rushed into production in the summer of 1940. Based on the Humber 4x4 8-cwt truck, the Humber was lightly armored and carried a turreted machinegun. The Otter was the General Motors of Canada equivalent of the Humber. These vehicles were used for reconnaissance by infantry units and for reconnaissance and scouting with engineers. 5361 of both types were built. This unit represents a two-car section.

ARMAMENT
1 x machinegun
MAX ARMOR
20mm
WEIGHT
3.5-4.5 tonnes

P09052
The Morris CS9 Armoured Car was a converted Morris 4x2 15-cwt truck. This was a stopgap measure until more advanced designs could be developed. 99 were constructed in 1938. The CS9 saw action with the 12th Lancers in France and the 11th Hussars in North Africa. This unit represents a three-car troop.

ARMAMENT
1 x anti-tank rifle
1 x machinegun
MAX ARMOR
14mm
WEIGHT
4.5 tonnes

P09053
The Roll Royce Armoured Car was based on the Rolls Royce 1914-Pattern of WWI. These vehicles were modified by the 11th Hussars by replacing the machinegun turret with an open topped turret containing an anti-tank rifle, a light machinegun and smoke dischargers. They saw action in the early stages of the desert war. This unit represents a three-car troop of two Rolls Royces and one Morris AC.

ARMAMENT
1 x anti-tank rifle
1 x machinegun
MAX ARMOR
9mm
WEIGHT
4 tonnes

P09054
The Marmon-Herrington Armoured Car was truly an example of combined production effort. It was based on a Canadian Ford 4x2 chassis, used British armament, South African armor and a U.S. 4x4 conversion kit. This vehicle was simple in design, poorly armed, and lightly armored, but proved to be solidly reliable. This unit includes both the Mark II ME and the Mark III ME. It was intended for use in the Middle East, hence the "ME". It saw action in North Africa, Syria and East Africa. This unit represents a three-car troop.

ARMAMENT
1 x anti-tank rifle
2 x machineguns
MAX ARMOR
14mm
WEIGHT
5.5 tonnes

P09055
The Marmon-Herrington Armoured Car was truly an example of combined production effort. It was based on a Canadian Ford 4x2 chassis, used British armament, South African armor and a U.S. 4x4 conversion kit. This vehicle was simple in design, poorly armed, and lightly armored, but proved to be solidly reliable. Desiring to redress its weak armament, forces in the field began replacing the turret with any number of different weapons. These included captured Italian 20mm anti-air or 47mm anti-tank, German 37mm anti-tank and some even had British 2-pounders. This unit represents a two-car section.

ARMAMENT
1 x 20mm AA
or
1 x 47mm AT
or
1 x 37mm AT
or
1 x 2pdr (40mm) AT
MAX ARMOR
14mm
WEIGHT
5-6 tonnes

P09056
The Humber II Armoured Car was based on the Quad Field Artillery Tractor. A relatively unsophisticated vehicle, the Humber was still reliable and performed well in the field. This unit includes the Mark II and Mark III versions. The Mark II version had a two man-turret, the Mark III version had a larger three-man turret. Some 5300 were built. This unit represents a two-car section.

ARMAMENT
1 x 15mm machinegun
1 x light machinegun
MAX ARMOR
20mm
WEIGHT
7 tonnes

P09902
The Humber II Armoured Car was based on the Quad Field Artillery Tractor. A relatively unsophisticated vehicle, the Humber was still reliable and performed well in the field. This unit includes the Mark II and Mark III versions. The Mark II version had a two man-turret, the Mark III version had a larger three-man turret. Some 5300 were built. This unit represents a three-car troop.

ARMAMENT
1 x 15mm machinegun
1 x light machinegun
MAX ARMOR
20mm
WEIGHT
7 tonnes

P09903
The Humber II Armoured Car was based on the Quad Field Artillery Tractor. A relatively unsophisticated vehicle, the Humber was still reliable and performed well in the field. This unit includes the Mark II and Mark III versions. The Mark II version had a two man-turret, the Mark III version had a larger three-man turret. Some 5300 were built. This unit represents a troop of two Humber ACs and one Daimler AC.

ARMAMENT
1 x 15mm machinegun
1 x light machinegun
MAX ARMOR
20mm
WEIGHT
7 tonnes

P09057
The Humber IV was actually a Humber III fitted with a U.S. 37mm gun. The size of the gun's breech assembly forced a reduction in the turret crew from three to two. These vehicles were usually deployed in the squadron and regimental HQs of armored car regiments. This unit represents a two-car patrol.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
1 x machinegun
MAX ARMOR
20mm
WEIGHT
7 tonnes

P09058
The Daimler Armoured Car is basically a larger version of the Daimler Scout Car. This vehicle used the turret and main gun from the Tetrarch light tank. This was a huge improvement in firepower over earlier British armored cars. The Daimler proved itself to rugged and reliable and was used mainly in the reconnaissance and escort roles. The Daimler saw action in North Africa and ETO. 2,694 were built. This unit represents a two-car section.

ARMAMENT
1 x 2-pdr gun
1 x machinegun
MAX ARMOR
25mm
WEIGHT
7.5 tonnes

P09059
The AEC I Armoured Car was little more than a tank on wheels, and was known as "The Mobile Pillbox". Based on the AEC Matador medium artillery tractor, the AEC I was large, slow, and heavily armed. It carried the turret and main armament of the Valentine II tanks. The AEC I was used in North Africa as a heavy support vehicle. This unit represents a two-car section.

ARMAMENT
1 x 2-pdr gun
1 x machinegun
MAX ARMOR
30mm
WEIGHT
11 tonnes

P09060
The AEC III Armoured Car was little more than a tank on wheels. Based on the AEC Matador medium artillery tractor, the AEC III was large, slow, and heavily armed. It incorporated some improvements over the AEC I, most notably a more powerful engine and three-man turret with a 75mm main gun. The AEC III was the most heavily armed and armored car of the war. This unit represents a two-car section.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm gun
1 x machinegun
MAX ARMOR
30mm
WEIGHT
13 tonnes

P09061
The Staghound Armored Car was a U.S.-built vehicle lend-leased to the British. Intended for desert use, the Staghound was large and rather heavy. While these characteristics were not a problem in the desert, in the narrow lanes and streets of continental Europe they were a liability. 2,844 were built, all of which were used by the British and the Commonwealth. This unit represents a two-car section.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
3 x machineguns
MAX ARMOR
32mm
WEIGHT
14 tonnes

P09062
The Staghound Armored Car was a U.S.-built vehicle lend-leased to the British. Intended for desert use, the Staghound was large and rather heavy. While these characteristics were not a problem in the desert, in the narrow lanes and streets of continental Europe they were a liability. The British modified some of the Staghounds by installing a 76mm close-support howitzer. This vehicle was renamed the Staghound II armored car. This unit represents a three-car troop.

ARMAMENT
1 x 76mm howitzer
2 x machineguns
MAX ARMOR
32mm
WEIGHT
14 tonnes

P09904
The Greyhound Armored Car was actually the U.S. M8 Armored Car. Lend-leased to the British via in-theatre transfer, the Greyhound was only used in Italy. The Greyhound was reasonable well armed and armored and was mechanically reliable. It also featured 6x6 drive and had excellent cross-country capabilities. This unit represents a two-car section.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
2 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
19mm
WEIGHT
7.9 tonnes

P09063
The Bishop was an expedient design built around the chassis of a Valentine Infantry Tank. With a certain visual similarity to the Russian KV2, it had a high slab-sided turret fitted with a 25pdr Field Gun. This was Britain's first attempt to produce a self propelled gun in WW II. And was an unsuccessful design. Coming into service at about the same time as Lend-Lease M7 the Bishop was quickly relegated to second line duties.

ARMAMENT
1 x 25pdr Mk II gun
1 x 7.65mm Bren MG
MAX ARMOR
60mm
WEIGHT
17.7 tonnes

P09064
The M7 Howitzer Motor Carriage was a modified M3 Medium Tank with a 105mm howitzer carried in an open-top compartment. It first saw action in Tunisia; where it began to replace the T19 HMC Halftrack in the armored field artillery battalions of the 1st Armoured Division. Serving in batteries of six, it soon equipped all armored field artillery battalions. This unit represents a battery of four Priests.

ARMAMENT
1 x 105mm howitzer
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
51mm
WEIGHT
23 tonnes

P09065
Visually similar to the American M7 the Sexton was built in vast numbers in Canada. Based on the chassis of the Ram tank (as was the M7) visually it could be distinguished from the M7 by the stepped appearance of its upperworks, the large muzzle brake on the 25pdr and of course the driver sat on the right. Sexton's entirely replaced M7s in 21 Army Group (NW Europe) shortly after D-Day in order to free up 105mm ammunition for American forces.

ARMAMENT
1 x 25pdr Mk II gun
1 x 7.65mm Bren MG
MAX ARMOR
25mm
WEIGHT
25.9 tonnes

P09066
The White 75mm Gun Halftrack was actually the U.S. M3 GMC halftrack. Once the M10 GMC tank destroyers become available in sufficient number to American forces, they began turning over the M3 GMC to the British via in-theater transfer. Designated the 75mm SP, Autocar by the British, they were used to equip the heavy troops in British armored car squadrons. This unit represents a two-vehicle section.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm gun
MAX ARMOR
12.7mm
WEIGHT
9 tonnes

P09067
Officially known as "Tank, Light AA Mk II" it was a converted Mark VIB Light Tank with its main gun replaced with four machineguns. Although it was capable of pouring out massive firepower, it was not as effective as it could have been, due to the one-man turret that placed too many responsibilities on the commander. British tank units had a four tank anti-aircraft troop attached throughout the war until about August/September 1944 when air superiority had been permanently achieved.

ARMAMENT
4 x 7.92mm Besa MGs
MAX ARMOR
14mm
WEIGHT
5.3 tonnes

P09068
The Crusader anti-aircraft tank was issued to tank Regiments. In two main versions, the Mk I was equipped with a single 40mm Bofors gun in an open backed but shielded mount. The second type being the Mks II and III (the difference being the location of the radio) where two 20mm Oerlikon cannon were mounted in an armored high elevation turret; the latter are the type represented in the game. British tank units had a four tank anti-aircraft troop attached throughout the war until about August/September 1944 when air superiority had been permanently achieved.

ARMAMENT
2 x 20mm AA guns
MAX ARMOR
49mm
WEIGHT
19.3 tonnes

P09069
The White Quad .50-cal Anti-Aircraft Halftrack was actually the U.S. M17 MGMC. Not available to the British until the closing months of the war, they were used primarily as infantry support as the Luftwaffe was practically non-existent. It was in the infantry support that this vehicle gained its nickname of "The Chopper". This was because its four 12.7mm machineguns could literally chop up unarmored or soft targets. This unit represents a two-vehicle section.

ARMAMENT
4 x 12.7mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
16mm
WEIGHT
9.5 tonnes

P09070
The Humber Quad-MG Anti-Aircraft Armored Car was a Humber Mark I or II armored car fitted with the turret from a MK VI anti-aircraft light tank. These vehicles were attached to the regimental HQs of armored car and tank regiments. By late 1944 most anti-aircraft armored cars had been phased out. This unit represents a two-car section.

ARMAMENT
4 x machineguns
MAX ARMOR
20mm
WEIGHT
7 tonnes

P09071
The Staghound anti-aircraft armored car was a Staghound I with its normal turret removed and replaced with one mounting two 12.7mm machineguns. Some 1000 were built. These vehicles were attached to the regimental HQs of armored car and tank regiments. By late 1944 most anti-aircraft armored cars had been phased out. This unit represents a two-car section.

ARMAMENT
2 x 12.7mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
32mm
WEIGHT
12 tonnes

P09072
The British were lend-leased large numbers of U.S.-built halftracks. They were used as command vehicles, prime movers, engineer vehicles and armored personnel carriers. Most of these halftracks were built by the International Harvester Co. This unit includes the M5, M5A1, M9 and M9A1. Over 10,000 were lend-leased. This unit represents a platoon of six vehicles.

ARMAMENT
1 x machinegun
MAX ARMOR
12.7mm
WEIGHT
8.5 tonnes

P09073
The Universal Carrier can trace its origins to the pre-war Carden Loyd Tankettes and Bren Carriers. This unit, being the ultimate wartime development, represents two air-landed Carriers intended to be used as towing vehicles for air-landed anti-tank guns.

ARMAMENT
1 x Bren light MG
MAX ARMOR
14mm
WEIGHT
4.1 tonnes

P09074
This unit represents a section of three Carriers used in infantry battalions. One carried a Bren light machinegun, another an anti-tank rifle, and the third a 2-inch mortar.

ARMAMENT
1 x Bren light MG
or
1 x anti-tank rifle
or
1 x 2-inch mortar
MAX ARMOR
14mm
WEIGHT
4 tonnes

P09914
The Windsor was a Canadian-built version of the standard British Universal Carrier. It was a bit larger than the latter, and was used primarily as a towing vehicle for the 6pdr anti-tank gun.

ARMAMENT
1 x Bren light MG
MAX ARMOR
14mm
WEIGHT
4 tonnes

P09075
This unit represents a specialized version of the Universal Carrier issued to machinegun battalions. It was specially adapted to carry the Vickers medium machinegun on top of the engine compartment, a gun which although heavy was incredibly reliable and accurate. The Australians fielded a different version, with a Vickers gun in the front superstructure.

ARMAMENT
2 x 7.65mm MMG
MAX ARMOR
14mm
WEIGHT
4.5 tonnes

P09077
Priest Kangaroo: As Priests (the U.S. M7 HMC) self-propelled 105mm howitzers were withdrawn from front-line British service they were stripped of their gun, fitted with bench seats and returned to the front line to serve as armored personnel carriers. This was a very common occurrence and by war's end many British infantry battalions were carried into battle both in NW Europe and Italy in "Kangaroos" of one type or another.

ARMAMENT
1 x 7.65mm Bren LMG
MAX ARMOR
62mm
WEIGHT
18.5 tonnes

P09078
The Canadian Ram tank was based on the old American M3 chassis just like the early M4 Shermans, also like the M4 it mounted a dual purpose 75mm Gun. Despite being built in quite large numbers it was not accepted for service as a gun tank. Consequently many Rams had their turrets stripped from them and after minor internal conversion work were put to use as Kangaroos thus becoming the worlds first fully tracked armored personnel carriers.

ARMAMENT
1 x 7.62mm MG
MAX ARMOR
62mm to 87mm
WEIGHT
22 tonnes

P09079
The White Scout Car was actually the U.S. M3A1 Scout Car lend-leased to the British. Not considered a true scout car by the British, it was used to fill a variety of roles it had never been intended to fill. The White SC was used as a command/liaison vehicle. In infantry divisions it was used a forward artillery observer. In some motor battalions it was used as an armored personnel carrier. The latter is its role in the game.

ARMAMENT
1 x machinegun
MAX ARMOR
12.7mm
WEIGHT
5.5 tonnes

P09080
The official designation of this vehicle was "Armoured Carrier, Wheeled, Indian Pattern". Indian Pattern vehicles were so known as they were built on simpler lines than the corresponding parent design. The were also "Tropicalized" by improved engine cooling measures and the fitting of better air filters. Vehicles so built were sold specifically to the Indian Army which had a more restricted budget than other Commonwealth forces. It was used by Indian units in Africa and Italy, and performed the same roles as the basic Universal Carrier.

ARMAMENT
1 x anti-tank rifle
or
1 x machinegun
MAX ARMOR
10mm
WEIGHT
5.5 tonnes

P09910
The 15-cwt Armoured Truck was used by the Canadians as an armored personnel carrier in some motor battalions. In this role it replaced the White Scout Car. This vehicle was a 15-cwt, 4x2 truck fitted with armor plate.

ARMAMENT
none
MAX ARMOR
14mm
WEIGHT
4.5 tonnes

P09082
The Wasp is another example of the adaptability of the ubiquitous Universal Carrier. In this version the bow machinegun was replaced with a flamethrower. The fuel and propellant tank were stowed within the vehicle. A Wasp platoon was included as part of the support company for most British infantry battalions by 1945. This unit represents a platoon of six Wasps.

ARMAMENT
1 x flamethrower
MAX ARMOR
14mm
WEIGHT
4.5 tonnes

P09083
The Badger was a turretless Ram Kangaroo modified to carry a flamethrower. The flame projector replaced the bow machinegun and all the associated equipment was stowed internally. The Badger served with 4th Canadian Armored Brigade. This unit represents a platoon of six Badgers.

ARMAMENT
1 x flamethrower
1 x 7.65mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
62mm
WEIGHT
24.5 tonnes

P09084
The Buffalo MK II LVT2 (Landing Vehicle, Tracked) was a partially armored amphibious armored personnel carrier. These vehicles were used for river crossings and for the assault elements of the Royal Engineers. They saw action along the Rhine and in Italy. In Italy they were referred to as Fantails. This unit represents a troop of six Buffaloes.

ARMAMENT
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
1 x 7.62mm machinegun
or
1 x 20mm cannon
MAX ARMOR
12.7mm
WEIGHT
14 tonnes

P09085
The Buffalo MK IV LVT4 (Landing Vehicle, Tracked) was an armored amphibious armored personnel carrier. The LVT4 was a logical evolution of the LVT2. In addition to the features of the LVT2, the LVT4 had a rear-opening ramp. These vehicles were used for river crossings and for the assault elements of the Royal Engineers. They saw action along the Rhine and in Italy. In Italy they were referred to as Fantails. This unit represents a troop of six Buffaloes.

ARMAMENT
1 x 20mm cannon
or
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
1 x 7.62mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
12.7mm
WEIGHT
14.5 tonnes

P09086
Duplex Drive Sherman tanks: First tested on Tetrarch Light Tanks and Valentine Infantry Tanks, the Duplex Drive system was the brainchild of Hungarian born military engineer Nicholas Straussler. By encasing the tank within a floatation screen the tank could be made to float and by fitting a propeller to a power-take-off from the main engine the tank could be made to swim. DD Sherman tanks were the only type to be used operationally, first used on D-Day by both American and British units. DD Shermans remained in use throughout the campaign in NW Europe with the 79th Armoured Division.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm gun
2 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
62mm
WEIGHT
31.3 tonnes

P09087
The DUKW was a U.S.-built amphibious truck. First used by the British in Sicily, it was used through-out the war. It was used to shuttle troops and stores from ship to shore and in river crossings. The DUKW had fairly good land mobility and carried a payload of up to 2275kg. This unit represents a platoon of six DUKWs.


P09088
The Terrapin MK I amphibious truck was produced by the British to supplement the DUKW. The Terrapin was an eight-wheeled vehicle, had two engines and carried a payload of 4100kg. In the water each of its engines drove a separate propeller. On land, only the four center wheels touched the ground and its lack of a suspension system made for a rough, slow ride. It was used to ferry men and stores in support of amphibious assaults. This unit represents a platoon of six Terrapins.


P09081
In the desert, light anti-tank guns were often damaged while being towed. To solve this problem, the unlimbered gun was mounted on the bed of a specially modified truck. The Bofors 37mm Portee is an example of this. An additional benefit of this system was the mobility it gave the gun. More often than not the gunners fought directly from the portee. This unit represents a platoon of six vehicles.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm Bofor
MAX ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
5 tonnes

P09089
In the desert, light anti-tank guns were often damaged while being towed. To solve this problem, the unlimbered gun was mounted on the bed of a specially modified truck. The 2-pounder Portee is an example of this. An additional benefit of this system was the mobility it gave the gun. More often than not the gunners fought directly from the portee. This unit represents a platoon of six vehicles.

ARMAMENT
1 x 2-pounder gun
MAX ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
5 tonnes

P09090
Officially termed the "Carrier, SP, 4x4, 40mmAA", the Morris C9/B was a 40mm Bofors AA gun mounted on a Morris quad field artillery tractor. This vehicle was the most numerous of the British SPAA. This unit represents a six-vehicle troop, one of three such troops which made up a battery.

ARMAMENT
1 x 40mm Bofors
MAX ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
9 tonnes

P09091
Built to transport infantry and tow light guns, the Loyd Carrier saw only limited service prior to 1943. As the portee system was in use for anti-tank guns, the Loyd was only used as an infantry transport during these years. After 1943 it was adopted as the standard towing vehicle for the 6-pounder gun and the 4.2-inch mortar. The Loyd was designed to have armor plates attached, but they were rarely fitted. This unit represents a platoon of six vehicles.


P09092
The Quad Field Artillery Tractor was a purpose-built towing vehicle for the 18-pounder and 25-pounder guns. After the introduction of the 17-pounder, the Quad was used to tow this gun as well. Some 28,000 Quads were built. This unit represents a platoon of six vehicles.


P09912
The Long Range Desert Group's trucks were usually Chevrolet 30-cwt trucks armed with various combinations of Vickers, Lewis and Browning machineguns, plus the occasional anti-tank rifle. The armament of these vehicles was not standardized; they were generally armed according to preference of the crew. As these vehicles were often used for patrols and raids deep behind enemy lines, they had a range of operation of up to 1100 miles (1775km) and carried about three weeks supply of food and water.

ARMAMENT
3 to 5 machineguns
MAX ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
4.5 tonnes

P09093
A Jeep scout section included six jeeps. Three had a mounted machinegun, and three carried 60mm mortars and their crews. They served as standard equipment in mechanized cavalry recon platoons from 1943 onward.

ARMAMENT
1 x 7.62mm machinegun
or
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
1.5 tonnes

P09911
This unit represents a section of two Jeeps used by the British SAS. More heavily armed than the conventional Jeep, these vehicles typically carried a Browning machinegun and two Vickers K model twin-barreled machineguns.

ARMAMENT
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
2 x 7.65mm Vickers K MGs
MAX ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
2 tonnes

P09094
Derived from the "GP" (General Purpose) designation by Ford, the Jeep was a 1/4-ton 4x4 utility vehicle that served many roles: command, liaison, and recon. By the end of World War II, a total of 639,245 Jeeps had been built. In the game this unit represents a number of Jeeps used for towing light guns or carrying light mortars.


P09095
The British used a variety of British and American made trucks and lorries. During the war, some 900,000 trucks were used for all manner of purposes. This unit represents a variable number of trucks sufficient to transport a platoon of infantry.


P09096
This unit represents a variable number of unarmed and unarmored powered boats used to transport infantry and equipment across water.


P09097
This unit represents a variable number of unarmed and unarmored rafts used to transport infantry and equipment across water.


P09601
The Landing Craft, Personnel, was a military adaptation of a commercial motor boat built by the Higgins Company of New Orleans. It had a wooden hull, and troops had to climb over its sides to (dis)embark. The unit in the game represents the LCP(L), which was a large version of the boat. 2193 of these were built, followed by 2631 LCP(R) which had a narrow bow ramp to facilitate loading and unloading.


P09602
The Landing Craft, Vehicle, was an unarmored (and unarmed) craft with a bow ramp which allowed it to carry a light vehicle or gun. 2366 were built in 1942. Due to their vulnerability to enemy fire, they were quickly superseded by the armored LCVP.


P09603
The Landing Craft, Vehicle Personnel, was an improved version of the LCV, featuring armor plating and twin .30-cal machinegun armament. As with its predecessor, a bow ramp allowed the LCVP to carry a light vehicle or gun. 23,358 LCVPs were built, beginning in 1943.


P09604
The Landing Craft, Assault, was a 1939 British design. It was slower than the LCVP and less well armed, but offered its passengers superior protection against light weapons and shell splinters. 2030 LCA were built, and it was the standard infantry landing craft of British forces. Small numbers were used by U.S. forces as well.


P09605
The Landing Craft, Mechanized, was a British design originally intended for the transport of a light tank. The most common model was the LCM(3), built mainly by the Higgins Company of New Orleans. This version could carry a medium tank. All LCMs were armored.


P09606
The Landing Craft, Tank, was a British design intended for the transport of several light or medium tanks. The original model was the LCT(1), and by the end of the war the British were using the much larger LCT(4). In the meantime the U.S. produced the LCT(5) and LCT(6).


P09101
The OML 3-inch mortar was descended from the famous Stokes 3-inch trench mortar of WWI. A serviceable weapon, the OML 3-inch was in widespread service by 1939. However, it lacked the range of its Axis counterparts. British infantry battalions in 1940 were issued two of these mortars.

MAX RANGE
1500m
SHELL WEIGHT
4.54kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
57.2kg

P09102
The OML 3-inch mortar was descended from the famous Stokes 3-inch trench mortar of WWI. A serviceable weapon, the OML 3-inch was in widespread service by 1939. However, it lacked the range of its Axis counterparts. By 1942 improvements in the ammunition and to the mortar itself had, to a degree, redressed this problem. This unit represents a two-mortar section.

MAX RANGE
2550m
SHELL WEIGHT
4.54kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
57.2kg

P09103
In 1941 the OSB 4.2-inch mortar was developed to fire chemical rounds. The fighting in North Africa made it clear that a mortar with greater range than the 3-inch was sorely needed. Consequently HE rounds were quickly developed for the 4.2-inch. Initially the range of an HE shell was unsatisfactory (about 3100m) but new ammo soon corrected this problem. In North Africa the 4.2-inch was used by Royal Engineer mortar companies and in the ETO was issued directly to the infantry units. This unit represents a two-mortar section.

MAX RANGE
3900m
SHELL WEIGHT
10.9kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
286kg

P09104
In 1941 the OSB 4.2-inch mortar was developed to fire chemical rounds. The fighting in North Africa made it clear that a mortar with greater range than the 3-inch was sorely needed. Consequently HE rounds were quickly developed for the 4.2-inch. Initially the range of an HE shell was unsatisfactory (about 3100m) but new ammo soon corrected this problem. In North Africa the 4.2-inch was used by Royal Engineer mortar companies and in the ETO was issued directly to the infantry units. This unit represents a four-mortar platoon.

MAX RANGE
3900m
SHELL WEIGHT
10.9kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
286kg

P09105
This was the French "Canon lger de 25 antichar SA-L mle 1934" issued in 1940 to British infantry brigade anti-tank companies in France. It was inferior in performance to most contemporary anti-tank guns both in ranges and penetrative performance. It was however small, easy to conceal and light to maneuver. All British guns were left behind in France following the British withdrawal at Dunkirk and were later taken over by the Germans for use by coastal defense purposes. This unit represents a section of two guns.

ARMOR PENETRATION
50mm@600m
SHELL WEIGHT
.32kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
496kg

P09106
This was the French "Canon lger de 25 antichar SA-L mle 1934" issued in 1940 to British infantry brigade anti-tank companies in France. It was inferior in performance to most contemporary anti-tank guns both in ranges and penetrative performance. It was however small, easy to conceal and light to maneuver. All British guns were left behind in France following the British withdrawal at Dunkirk and were later taken over by the Germans for use by coastal defense purposes. This unit represents a platoon of three guns.

ARMOR PENETRATION
50mm@600m
SHELL WEIGHT
.32kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
496kg

P09107
This was the French "Canon lger de 25 antichar SA-L mle 1934" issued in 1940 to British infantry brigade anti-tank companies in France. It was inferior in performance to most contemporary anti-tank guns both in ranges and penetrative performance. It was however small, easy to conceal and light to maneuver. All British guns were left behind in France following the British withdrawal at Dunkirk and were later taken over by the Germans for use by coastal defense purposes. This unit represents a platoon of four guns.

ARMOR PENETRATION
50mm@600m
SHELL WEIGHT
.32kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
496kg

P09108
This was the standard British anti-tank gun of the early war years. Heavy for its caliber, it featured a mount capable of all-round traverse permitting an all-round defense against armor. It was issued to the anti-tank battalions forming part of either an infantry or armoured division on a scale of 36 guns per battalion. Except for anti-tank rifles infantry battalions did not have their own organic anti-tank capability until 1942 when they were issued with a platoon of the much more powerful 6pdr. Seriously handicapped by its lack of HE shell and hitting power, it nevertheless continued to soldier on until quite a late period of the war. This unit also represents the Bofors 37mm anti-tank gun issued to British troops forming part of the Western Desert Force during the early war period.

ARMOR PENETRATION
52mm@500m
SHELL WEIGHT
1kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
757kg

P09128
This gun was introduced as the replacement for the earlier 2pdr guns. Of nominal 57mm caliber this weapon was an effective tank during the mid-war period. Introduced in mid 1942 as an answer to the German Pz IIIs and IVs that were impervious to the earlier British anti-tank weapons. From mid 1942 6pdrs were also issued to anti-tank platoons within infantry battalions on a scale of four per platoon. Anti-tank battalions within divisional organizations were also re-equipped within this weapon from mid 1942 on the same scale as the 2pdr of 36 guns per battalion. The most serious drawback of this weapon was that when initially issued, no HE shell was available for it. This unit represents a section (half a platoon) of two guns.

ARMOR PENETRATION
83mm@500m
SHELL WEIGHT
2.72-3.18kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
500kg

P09129
OQF 6pdr. Of nominal 57mm caliber this weapon was an effective tank during the mid-war period. Introduced in mid 1942 as an answer to the German Pz IIIs and IVs that were impervious to the earlier British anti-tank weapons. From mid 1942 these anti-tank guns were also issued to anti-tank platoons within infantry battalions on a scale of four per platoon. Anti-tank battalions within divisional organizations were also re-equipped within this weapon from mid 1942 on the same scale as the 2pdr of 36 guns per battalion. The most serious drawback of this weapon was that when initially issued, no HE shell was available for it. This unit represents a platoon of four guns.

ARMOR PENETRATION
83mm@500m
SHELL WEIGHT
2.84kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
500kg

P09130
By 1944 the 6pdr gun was hopelessly outclassed as an anti-tank weapon. To rectify the situation an APDS (Armor Piercing Discarding Sabot) shot was developed for it. With this new shell the weapon was given a new lease on life. The super high velocity APDS shell was capable of penetrating most enemy armored vehicles although the newer vehicles still had to be attacked from the flank or rear. An increase in the production of HE shells also allowed limited infantry support to be given. This unit represents a section of two guns.

ARMOR PENETRATION
136mm@1000m (APDS)
SHELL WEIGHT
1.47kg (APDS)
WEIGHT IN ACTION
500kg

P09109
By 1944 the 6pdr gun was hopelessly outclassed as an anti-tank weapon. To rectify the situation an APDS (Armor Piercing Discarding Sabot) shot was developed for it at the same time an HE shell was introduced. With this new shell the weapon was given a new lease of life. The super high velocity APDS shell was capable of penetrating most enemy armored vehicles although the newer vehicles still had to be attacked from the flank or rear. An increase in the production of HE shells also allowed limited infantry support to be given. This unit represents a platoon of four guns.

ARMOR PENETRATION
136mm@1000m (APDS)
SHELL WEIGHT
1.47kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
500kg

P09110
By autumn of 1942 the 17-pounder was in production, but delays in carriage production were keeping it from being issued to units in the field. British Army Intelligence suspected that the Tiger was about to make its appearance and determined that the 17pdr had to be rushed into service. As a result, its barrel and breech assembly were fitted to the 25pdr carriage. Test-firing showed the carriage just able to withstand the recoil of the gun, and the combination was accepted for service. It was designated the 17/25-pounder and was nicknamed the "Pheasant" after its code name. About 100 were built. This unit represents a four-gun battery.

ARMOR PENETRATION
120mm@500m
SHELL WEIGHT
7.73kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2200kg

P09111
In 1943 the British introduced a new weapon, the 17pdr anti-tank gun. Considered by many to be the ultimate World War II anti-tank gun, it had a higher penetrative ability then either the American 90mm or the fabled German 88. This weapon could penetrate the frontal armor of a Tiger I at over 1000m. This weapon was initially issued only to anti-tank battalions; infantry anti-tank platoons having to soldier on with the 6pdr. At the same time as the 17pdr was introduced the size of anti-tank battalions was increased to a nominal 48 guns organized in four companies each of 12 guns.

ARMOR PENETRATION
120mm@500m
SHELL WEIGHT
7.73kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2920kg

P09131
In mid 1944 the already superb 17pdr gun was given an APDS (Armor Piercing Discarding Sabot) shell. From this point on no German tank was safe. Capable of penetrating the frontal armor of Panthers and Tiger IIs at significant ranges, the British army had at long last a weapon capable of exorcising the specter of the panzer. By the time the APDS round was coming into service the infantry battalion anti-tank platoons were being re-equipped with this weapon. Also issued at this time was an HE shell, doubling the usefulness of this already superb gun. This unit represents a platoon of four guns issued with the APDS and HE shells.

ARMOR PENETRATION
186mm@500m (APDS)
SHELL WEIGHT
3.70kg (APDS)
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2920kg

P09132
Forming the backbone of British artillery in WWI, the OQF 18-pounder was still in service in 1939. Modified for vehicle towing, they were pressed into service in the anti-tank role by Commonwealth units when the availability of 25pdrs made them redundant in the field artillery role. This unit represents a four-gun battery.

ARMOR PENETRATION
40mm @500m
SHELL WEIGHT
8.18kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1595kg

P09112
The OQF M1A1 75mm pack howitzer was a U.S.-made light artillery piece lend-leased to the British. In the ETO, it was used by the British 1st and 6th Airborne Divisions. Each regiment of these divisions was authorized 27 pack howitzers. This unit represents a three-gun troop.

MAX RANGE
8700m
SHELL WEIGHT
6.6kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
585-609kg

P09113
The mle 1897 75mm Field Gun was the famous Model 1897 field piece of WWI. British use of these weapon appears to be limited to action on Crete. This unit represents a four-gun battery.

MAX RANGE
11100m
SHELL WEIGHT
6.2kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1140kg

P09114
The OQF 18-pounder field gun formed the backbone of British artillery during WWI. Modified for vehicle towing, the 18-pdr served with British forces in France (BEF) and North Africa as divisional artillery. It served in this role until replaced by the 25-pounder. This unit represents a four-gun battery.

MAX RANGE
8520m
SHELL WEIGHT
8.18kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1595kg

P09115
The OQF 25-pounder Field Gun was by all accounts one of the finest light artillery pieces of the war. It became the standard artillery piece in all ETO British infantry divisions. The 25-pounder represented in the game is the Mk II model mounted on a turntable platform giving it 360 degrees of traverse. This was a very versatile weapon, firing high explosive, armor piercing and smoke ammunition. This unit represents a four-gun troop.

MAX RANGE
12500m
SHELL WEIGHT
11.34kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1840kg

P09116
The OQF 3.7-inch mountain howitzer was a pack designed for use with the Indian Army. This gun had an unusual feature in that the barrel and breech screwed into the opposite ends of a special junction. This feature gave the gun its nickname, "The Screwgun". It saw action in Norway, Crete, North Africa, Sicily and Italy. This gun was in the Mountain and Light Mountain artillery regiments. This unit represents a four-gun battery.

MAX RANGE
5480m
SHELL WEIGHT
4.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
844kg

P09117
The OQF 4.5-inch howitzer was a WWI piece modified for vehicular towing. It was used by some BEF divisions as part of their artillery compliment. It also saw action in several early North African campaigns. It was eventually replaced by the 25-pounder. This unit represents a four-gun battery.

MAX. RANGE
6040m
SHELL WEIGHT
15.66kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1494kg

P09141
The M1918 155mm Howitzer was a U.S.-made heavy artillery piece lend-leased to the British. It was a WWI vintage weapon still in service at the start of WWII. It fired its heavy shell extremely accurately, even at long range.

MAX RANGE
19500m
SHELL WEIGHT
43kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
10750kg

P09142
The OBL 60-pounder was built prior to 1914. It was a 127mm-caliber weapon, a few of which were in service at the start of the war. In the inter-war years the carriages were revamped to allow for higher towing speeds and when war broke out in 1939 the 60-pounder was ready for action. Some 16 of these gun saw action in France in 1940. A few others were used in North Africa, and all were removed from service by the end of 1941. This unit represents a four-gun battery.

MAX RANGE
13,816m
SHELL WEIGHT
27.24kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
5470kg

P09118
The OBL 4.5-inch gun was a medium artillery piece assigned to artillery regiments of British corps. Extremely accurate at very long ranges, its shell size and low HE content of the shell were generally considered liabilities. Consequently, it began to be phased out of service during 1944. This unit represents a four-gun troop of either the Mk I or Mk II version.

MAX RANGE
19200m
SHELL WEIGHT
25kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
5850kg

P09119
The OBL 5.5-inch gun-howitzer was a medium artillery piece assigned to artillery regiments of British corps. The 5.5-inch used the same carriage as the 4.5-inch gun and in appearance, the two weapons were nearly identical. This unit represents a four-gun troop.

MAX RANGE
16560m
SHELL WEIGHT
45.4kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
6200kg

P09120
The OBL 6-inch howitzer was another WWI piece still in service in 1940. It served with the BEF in France and also saw action in North Africa. It was eventually replaced by the 4.5-inch gun and the 5.5-inch gun/howitzer. This unit represents a four-gun battery.

MAX RANGE
10400m
SHELL WEIGHT
39kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
4210kg

P09121
In the summer of 1940 it was decided to replace the barrel liners of the existing WWI 8-inch howitzers with ones in the 7.2-inch caliber, designating it the OBL 7.2-inch Howitzer MK I. This resulted in an increased range, but at the expense of an increased recoil. As a result, ramps had to be placed behind the wheels when firing. This was not a good system as the gun had to be re-aimed after every shot. Sometimes the gun rolled over the ramps and considerable time was lost man-handling it back into position. This unit represents a battery of four guns

MAX RANGE
15440m
SHELL WEIGHT
91.7kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
10345kg

P09122
The OBL 7.2-inch Howitzer MK VI is a marriage of a long barreled 7.2-inch howitzer to the carriage of the U.S. 155mm M2 "Long Tom." This was an excellent heavy artillery piece. It possessed none of the drawbacks of the earlier Marks and had even greater range. This unit represents a four gun battery.

MAX RANGE
18000m
SHELL WEIGHT
91.7kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
14,794kg

P09143
The OBL 8-inch howitzer was a leftover from WWI. This weapon was probably developed from the naval weapon of the same bore size. Its use was usually confined to major campaigns. It was used during the breakout from Normandy and was also used against the last organized defense west of the Rhine.

MAX RANGE
9500m
SHELL WEIGHT
90kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
9112kg

P09123
The OQF 20mm anti-aircraft gun was actually any one of three different guns. The British used the Oerlikon, the Hispano-Suiza and the Polsten designs. Although authorized for almost every branch of the British Army, few actually saw action until late in the war due to production delays and ammunition problems. The HE ammo did not self-destruct after a pre-determined flight time and commanders were concerned that 20mm shells falling back to earth may cause casualties among friendly forces. This unit represents a four-gun section.

MAX EFFECTIVE CEILING
4560m
SHELL WEIGHT
0.3kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
400kg

P09124
The OQF 40mm Anti-Aircraft Gun was actually the Swedish 40mm Bofors AA gun. The British purchased several of these superb weapons from Sweden, Poland, Belgium and Hungary. In 1941 this gun went into production in British factories, as well as factories in Canada and Australia. Fully automatic, the Bofors provided fast, accurate, saturating fire against low-flying aircraft. It had a full 360 degree traverse and maximum 90 degree elevation. The Bofors was used to equip light anti-aircraft regiments through-out the ETO. This unit represents a pre-1943 four-gun troop.

MAX EFFECTIVE CEILING
5600m
SHELL WEIGHT
0.9kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2654kg

P09125
The OQF 40mm Anti-Aircraft Gun was actually the Swedish 40mm Bofors anti-aircraft gun. The British purchased several of these superb weapons from Sweden, Poland, Belgium and Hungary. In 1941 this gun went into production in British factories, as well as factories in Canada and Australia. Fully automatic, the Bofors provided fast, accurate, saturating fire against low-flying aircraft. It had a full 360 degree traverse and maximum 90 degree elevation. The Bofors was used to equip light anti-aircraft regiments through-out the ETO. This unit represents a six-gun troop.

MAX EFFECTIVE CEILING
5600m
SHELL WEIGHT
0.9kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2654kg

P09126
The standard British AA gun of WWI, the 3-inch was still in service in 1939. Although considered obsolescent by 1940 standards, this gun gave good service in the British heavy anti-aircraft regiments. This was not designed for firing at ground targets and gradually replaced by the 3.7-inch anti-aircraft gun through-out the war. This unit represents a four-gun battery.

MAX EFFECTIVE CEILING
4800m
SHELL WEIGHT
7.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2727kg

P09127
The OQF 3.7-inch anti-aircraft gun was a superb weapon. As an anti-aircraft weapon, this gun was lethal; however, its design characteristics were such that direct firing on ground targets was extremely difficult. It could and did fire on ground targets in the indirect artillery role. This unit represents a four-gun battery.

MAX EFFECTIVE CEILING
9760m
SHELL WEIGHT
12.7kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
9337kg

P09201
This unit represents a section of Glider-borne infantry equipped with airlanded Universal Carriers. This represents a most powerful section, armed with two Bren light machineguns and well equipped with submachineguns, giving the section useful attack qualities at any usual infantry engagement range.


P09202
This is a section of armored infantry, usually carried into battle by means of Universal Carriers or a derivative thereof. The section comprised of nine men generously equipped with three Bren light machineguns was a powerful unit in its own right. Equipped with an anti-tank weapon and 2-in. mortar in addition to the soldiers' personal weapons, this infantry section possessed a level of firepower quite disproportionate to its size. In later years this section could be seen transported into battle by one of the new generation of armored personnel carriers, the Kangaroo. Prior to 1943 the anti-tank weapon would be a Boys anti-tank rifle. After this date the weapon would be a PIAT HEAT projector.


P09203
Like in all other armies the British Infantry was the backbone of the army. By 1939 the British army had been continuously involved in colonial and continental warfare for a period of nearly 300 years. As a consequence the infantry arm of the British army could be regarded as probably the best trained and most experienced service in the world. This added to the strong Regimental system that helped maintain morale through difficulties great and small made the British infantry a force to be reckoned with. Armed with the superlative Lee-Enfield bolt action rifle which in trained hands could be fired as quickly (and more accurately) than most semi-automatic weapons and stiffened with the equally superb Bren light machinegun the firepower available to a standard infantry platoon was truly awesome. This unit represents a standard infantry platoon of the period comprising of three rifle sections and a HQ section. Each rifle section comprised 10 men, 8 or 9 of which would be armed with the Lee-Enfield rifle, one with a Bren light machinegun and one who may, depending upon supply arrangements would have a Sten submachinegun. As the war progressed the issue of submachineguns became standardized and it became usual practice for two to be issued per section, one for the section commander and one other. The HQ section comprised the platoon commander, his sergeant, a runner/radioman, a two man 2-in. mortar team, two men with an anti-tank weapon and one other. In the period prior to 1943 the anti-tank weapon would be the Boys anti-tank rifle.


P09204
Like in all other armies the British Infantry was the backbone of the army. By 1939 the British army had been continuously involved in colonial and continental warfare for a period of nearly 300 years. As a consequence the infantry arm of the British army could be regarded as probably the best trained and most experienced service in the world. This added to the strong Regimental system that helped maintain morale through difficulties great and small made the British infantry a force to be reckoned with. Armed with the superlative Lee-Enfield bolt action rifle which in trained hands could be fired as quickly (and more accurately) than most semi-automatic weapons and stiffened with the equally superb Bren light machinegun the firepower available to a standard infantry platoon was truly awesome. This unit represents a standard infantry platoon of the period comprising of 3 rifle sections and a HQ section. Each rifle section was comprised of 10 men, 8 or 9 of which would be armed with the Lee-Enfield rifle, 1 with a Bren light machinegun and 1 who may, depending upon supply arrangements would have a Sten submachinegun. As the war progressed the issue of submachineguns became standardized and it became usual practice for 2 to be issued per section, 1 for the section commander and 1 other. The HQ section comprised of the Platoon Commander, his Sgt., a runner/radioman, a two man 2-inch mortar team, two men with an anti-tank weapon and one other. The anti-tank weapon would be in this later period the PIAT anti-tank hollow charge projector.


P09205
Like in all other armies the British Infantry was the backbone of the army. By 1939 the British army had been continuously involved in colonial and continental warfare for a period of nearly 300 years. As a consequence the infantry arm of the British army could be regarded as probably the best trained and most experienced service in the world. This added to the strong Regimental system that helped maintain morale through difficulties great and small made the British infantry a force to be reckoned with. Armed with the superlative Lee-Enfield bolt action rifle which in trained hands could be fired as quickly (and more accurately) than most semi-automatic weapons and stiffened with the equally superb Bren light machinegun the firepower available to a standard infantry platoon was truly awesome. This unit represents a standard airborne infantry platoon drawn from one of the newly formed parachute regiments. Comprising of 3 rifle sections and a HQ section. Each rifle section was comprised of 8 men, 6 of which would be armed with the Lee-Enfield rifle, 1 with a Bren light machinegun and 2 with Sten submachineguns. The HQ section comprised of the Platoon Commander, his Sgt., a runner/radioman, a two man 2-inch mortar team and a an anti-tank gunner. Despite the smaller numbers employed within a para-platoon when compared to a standard infantry platoon it suffered no loss of effective firepower.


P09206
This unit represents a standard airborne infantry platoon drawn from one of the parachute regiments or newly converted late war glider regiments. Like in all other armies the British Infantry was the backbone of the army. By 1939 the British army had been continuously involved in colonial and continental warfare for a period of nearly 300 years. As a consequence the infantry arm of the British army could be regarded as probably the best trained and most experienced service in the world. This added to the strong Regimental system that helped maintain morale through difficulties great and small made the British infantry a force to be reckoned with. Armed with the superlative Lee-Enfield bolt action rifle which in trained hands could be fired as quickly (and more accurately) than most semi-automatic weapons and stiffened with the equally superb Bren light machinegun the firepower available to a standard infantry platoon was truly awesome. Comprising of 3 rifle sections and a HQ section. Each rifle section was comprised of 8 men, 6 of which would be armed with the Lee-Enfield rifle, 1 with a Bren light machinegun and 2 with Sten submachineguns. The HQ section comprised of the Platoon Commander, his Sgt., a runner/radioman, a two man 2-inch mortar team. The mortar team would also be responsible for the anti-tank weapon, which would be in this later period the PIAT anti-tank hollow charge projector.


P09207
This unit represents a section drawn from a machinegun platoon attached to either an independent machinegun battalion or battalion HQ of a standard infantry battalion. This unit was equipped with two of the old but reliable and accurate water-cooled Vickers machineguns.


P09208
This unit represents a Medium Machinegun Platoon found in the machinegun battalions of the British Army. This unit is equipped with four of the old but reliable and accurate water-cooled Vickers machineguns. This platoon was additionally equipped with an anti-tank weapon which depending upon the period would be either a Boys anti-tank rifle or a PIAT hollow Charge projector. Alternatively, platoons of this organization could be found attached to many infantry Battalion HQs.


P09209
This unit represents a company drawn from the divisional combat engineer battalions attached to all British divisions. Like the combat engineers to be found in many armies, combat engineers or "Sappers" were provided with a wide variety of specialist equipment. Deployed in the field to deal with those obstacles considered to awkward or dangerous for regular troops, Sappers would clear and lay minefields, destroy bridges and attack fortifications. Equipment included not only standard infantry equipment but also flamethrowers, demolition charges and specialist clearing equipment like Bangalore torpedoes. Like all British infantry units the Sappers could be relied upon to show great measures of skill, determination and reserves of morale. One important factor to bear in mind was that front line engineering tasks were often performed by the pioneer platoons attached to infantry battalions and it would only be after these smaller less well equipped units had tried and failed that these heavyweight units would be brought in.


P09210
Representing an airlanded combat engineer company these companies were quite small in terms of manpower being only about the size of two infantry platoons. Like the combat engineers to be found in many armies, these combat engineers or "Sappers" were provided with a wide variety of specialist equipment. Deployed in the field to deal with those obstacles considered to awkward or dangerous for regular troops Sappers would clear and lay minefields, destroy bridges and attack fortifications. Equipment included not only standard infantry equipment but also flamethrowers, demolition charges and specialist clearing equipment like Bangalore torpedoes. Like all British infantry units the Sappers could be relied upon to show great measures of skill determination and reserves of morale. Just as skilled and determined as their more conventionally deployed comrades they were unable to carry as much in the way of combat stores due to their method of deployment.


P09211
This unit represents a light machinegun section of eight men armed with two Bren guns. The prime purpose of this unit is to represent the light anti-aircraft section attached to many HQ formations throughout the army. They can also be used to represent "carrier" crews who have disembarked in order to provide close fire support to the troops they carry and finally they represent the guard units deployed in local defense of HQs, artillery parks and the like.


P09212
Initially named Local Defence Volunteers, the British Home Guard was in many respects a throwback to the county militias of the 17th, 18th and 19th centuries in that they were employed only within their county, were only "part-time" soldiers, and could not be posted abroad. There the similarity ended, for although the county militias had often taken the best men the county had to offer, the Home Guard took the elderly veterans of yesterday's wars, the infirm, and men serving in reserved occupations. Organized as additional battalions to county regiments commanded by retired officers, when first raised the volunteers had little more in the way of equipment than an armband proclaiming them as soldiers. Equipment comprised farmers' shotguns, 18th century pikes and even pitchforks. Never the less as time went by these local volunteers got better and better equipment. Starting firstly with imported surplus US rifles, the volunteers later got Lewis machine guns, improvised hand grenades and various types of anti-tank guns and projectors. In some areas the volunteers became so well equipped they were able to organize "flying columns" of motorized troops in requisitioned civil transport and even armored cars. This unit represents a typical Home Guard platoon of 20-40 men during the period following initial organization when they are in the process or being supplied with adequate equipment.


P09213
Whoever said that Britons were endowed with a sense of fair play and honest decency has never heard of these fellows. Many British "special" units were created during the war amongst the most well known being the Commando Battalions of the Special Service Brigade. Known for their love of the dark and willingness to use the stiletto dagger with which they were issued, Commando units were sent in ever increasing numbers to wreak havoc on the shores of occupied Europe from 1941 onwards. Heavily armed and liberally equipped with explosives, the men of this organization, amongst their other exploits, stole parts of secret German radar installations, destroyed a heavy water plant and ruined the greatest harbor in France. For game purposes this unit also represents the hardly less infamous Royal Marine Commandos, SAS and other specialist units from Britain's secret armies. Typical equipment for a commando unit of around 30 men would be around fifteen submachineguns, four Bren light machineguns, ten rifles and a Boys anti-tank rifle, not for tank stopping though, but fired from a standing position and used as a sniping rifle, something that was supposedly guaranteed to break the firer's shoulder. All "special" units had a high quantity of automatic weapons, explosives and determination and should be considered formidable assault units.


P09307
British HQs at every level tended to be highly adaptable to suit ever changing circumstances. One feature of the British army of this period that is often forgotten is that it was the first (and for many years the only) army in the world to be entirely motorized. This in turn allowed local commanders to show great flexibility in deploying local resources. There were drawbacks, though, to the British regimental system. All arms coordination in the early years tended to be poor with armor and infantry tending to act independently to no overall plan although this was not particularly evident when the armored forces were drawn from the Royal Tank Regiments first formed in the First World War. Coordination tended to be better at the small unit level where years of experience fighting "low intensity" colonial wars could be best brought to bear. However the lack of coordination at higher levels for many years allowed enemy forces to often defeat in detail what would otherwise be an overwhelming force. However as a final summary the British HQ units, coordinated by radio, liberally supplied with recce assets and a supply train only marginally less than late war American forces, performed well in their appointed role.


P09306
British HQs at every level tended to be highly adaptable to suit ever changing circumstances. One feature of the British army of this period that is often forgotten is that it was the first (and for many years the only) army in the world to be entirely motorized. This in turn allowed local commanders to show great flexibility in deploying local resources. There were drawbacks, though, to the British regimental system. All arms coordination in the early years tended to be poor with armor and infantry tending to act independently to no overall plan, although this was not particularly evident when the armored forces were drawn from the Royal Tank Regiments first formed in the First World War. Coordination tended to be better at the small unit level where years of experience fighting "low intensity" colonial wars could be best brought to bear. However the lack of coordination at higher levels for many years allowed enemy forces to often defeat in detail what would otherwise be an overwhelming force. However as a final summary the British HQ units, coordinated by radio, liberally supplied with recce assets and a supply train only marginally less than late war American forces, performed well in their appointed role.


P09301
British HQs at every level tended to be highly adaptable to suit ever changing circumstances. One feature of the British army of this period that is often forgotten is that it was the first (and for many years the only) army in the world to be entirely motorized. This in turn allowed local commanders to show great flexibility in deploying local resources. There were drawbacks, though, to the British regimental system. All arms coordination in the early years tended to be poor with armor and infantry tending to act independently to no overall plan although this was not particularly evident when the armored forces were drawn from the Royal Tank Regiments first formed in the First World War. Coordination tended to be better at the small unit level where years of experience fighting "low intensity" colonial wars could be best brought to bear. However the lack of coordination at higher levels for many years allowed enemy forces to often defeat in detail what would otherwise be an overwhelming force. However as a final summary the British HQ units, coordinated by radio, liberally supplied with recce assets and a supply train only marginally less than late war American forces, performed well in their appointed role.


P09302
British HQs at every level tended to be highly adaptable to suit ever changing circumstances. One feature of the British army of this period that is often forgotten is that it was the first (and for many years the only) army in the world to be entirely motorized. This in turn allowed local commanders to show great flexibility in deploying local resources. There were drawbacks, though, to the British regimental system. All arms coordination in the early years tended to be poor with armor and infantry tending to act independently to no overall plan although this was not particularly evident when the armored forces were drawn from the Royal Tank Regiments first formed in the First World War. Coordination tended to be better at the small unit level where years of experience fighting "low intensity" colonial wars could be best brought to bare. However the lack of coordination at higher levels for many years allowed enemy forces to often defeat in detail what would otherwise be an overwhelming force. However as a final summary the British HQ units, coordinated by radio, liberally supplied with recce assets and a supply train only marginally less than late war American forces, performed well in their appointed role.


P09303
British HQs at every level tended to be highly adaptable to suit ever changing circumstances. One feature of the British army of this period that is often forgotten is that it was the first (and for many years the only) army in the world to be entirely motorized. This in turn allowed local commanders to show great flexibility in deploying local resources. There were drawbacks, though, to the British regimental system. All arms coordination in the early years tended to be poor with armor and infantry tending to act independently to no overall plan although this was not particularly evident when the armored forces were drawn from the Royal Tank Regiments first formed in the First World War. Coordination tended to be better at the small unit level where years of experience fighting "low intensity" colonial wars could be best brought to bear. However the lack of coordination at higher levels for many years allowed enemy forces to often defeat in detail what would otherwise be an overwhelming force. However as a final summary the British HQ units, coordinated by radio, liberally supplied with recce assets and a supply train only marginally less than late war American forces, performed well in their appointed role.


P09304
British HQs at every level tended to be highly adaptable to suit ever changing circumstances. One feature of the British army of this period that is often forgotten is that it was the first (and for many years the only) army in the world to be entirely motorized. This in turn allowed local commanders to show great flexibility in deploying local resources. There were drawbacks, though, to the British regimental system. All arms coordination in the early years tended to be poor with armor and infantry tending to act independently to no overall plan although this was not particularly evident when the armored forces were drawn from the Royal Tank Regiments first formed in the First World War. Coordination tended to be better at the small unit level where years of experience fighting "low intensity" colonial wars could be best brought to bear. However the lack of coordination at higher levels for many years allowed enemy forces to often defeat in detail what would otherwise be an overwhelming force. However as a final summary the British HQ units, coordinated by radio, liberally supplied with recce assets and a supply train only marginally less than late war American forces, performed well in their appointed role.


P09305
British HQs at every level tended to be highly adaptable to suit ever changing circumstances. One feature of the British army of this period that is often forgotten is that it was the first (and for many years the only) army in the world to be entirely motorized. This in turn allowed local commanders to show great flexibility in deploying local resources. There were drawbacks, though, to the British regimental system. All arms coordination in the early years tended to be poor with armor and infantry tending to act independently to no overall plan although this was not particularly evident when the armored forces were drawn from the Royal Tank Regiments first formed in the First World War. Coordination tended to be better at the small unit level where years of experience fighting "low intensity" colonial wars could be best brought to bear. However the lack of coordination at higher levels for many years allowed enemy forces to often defeat in detail what would otherwise be an overwhelming force. However as a final summary the British HQ units, coordinated by radio, liberally supplied with recce assets and a supply train only marginally less than late war American forces, performed well in their appointed role.


P09401
British HQs at every level tended to be highly adaptable to suit ever changing circumstances. One feature of the British army of this period that is often forgotten is that it was the first (and for many years the only) army in the world to be entirely motorized. This in turn allowed local commanders to show great flexibility in deploying local resources. There were drawbacks, though, to the British regimental system. All arms coordination in the early years tended to be poor with armor and infantry tending to act independently to no overall plan although this was not particularly evident when the armored forces were drawn from the Royal Tank Regiments first formed in the First World War. Coordination tended to be better at the small unit level where years of experience fighting "low intensity" colonial wars could be best brought to bear. However the lack of coordination at higher levels for many years allowed enemy forces to often defeat in detail what would otherwise be an overwhelming force. However as a final summary the British HQ units, coordinated by radio, liberally supplied with recce assets and a supply train only marginally less than late war American forces, performed well in their appointed role.


P09402
British HQs at every level tended to be highly adaptable to suit ever changing circumstances. One feature of the British army of this period that is often forgotten is that it was the first (and for many years the only) army in the world to be entirely motorized. This in turn allowed local commanders to show great flexibility in deploying local resources. There were drawbacks, though, to the British regimental system. All arms coordination in the early years tended to be poor with armor and infantry tending to act independently to no overall plan although this was not particularly evident when the armored forces were drawn from the Royal Tank Regiments first formed in the First World War. Coordination tended to be better at the small unit level where years of experience fighting "low intensity" colonial wars could be best brought to bear. However the lack of coordination at higher levels for many years allowed enemy forces to often defeat in detail what would otherwise be an overwhelming force. However as a final summary the British HQ units, coordinated by radio, liberally supplied with recce assets and a supply train only marginally less than late war American forces, performed well in their appointed role.


P09403
British HQs at every level tended to be highly adaptable to suit ever changing circumstances. One feature of the British army of this period that is often forgotten is that it was the first (and for many years the only) army in the world to be entirely motorized. This in turn allowed local commanders to show great flexibility in deploying local resources. There were drawbacks, though, to the British regimental system. All arms coordination in the early years tended to be poor with armor and infantry tending to act independently to no overall plan although this was not particularly evident when the armored forces were drawn from the Royal Tank Regiments first formed in the First World War. Coordination tended to be better at the small unit level where years of experience fighting "low intensity" colonial wars could be best brought to bear. However the lack of coordination at higher levels for many years allowed enemy forces to often defeat in detail what would otherwise be an overwhelming force. However as a final summary the British HQ units, coordinated by radio, liberally supplied with recce assets and a supply train only marginally less than late war American forces, performed well in their appointed role.


P09404
British HQs at every level tended to be highly adaptable to suit ever changing circumstances. One feature of the British army of this period that is often forgotten is that it was the first (and for many years the only) army in the world to be entirely motorized. This in turn allowed local commanders to show great flexibility in deploying local resources. There were drawbacks, though, to the British regimental system. All arms coordination in the early years tended to be poor with armor and infantry tending to act independently to no overall plan although this was not particularly evident when the armored forces were drawn from the Royal Tank Regiments first formed in the First World War. Coordination tended to be better at the small unit level where years of experience fighting "low intensity" colonial wars could be best brought to bear. However the lack of coordination at higher levels for many years allowed enemy forces to often defeat in detail what would otherwise be an overwhelming force. However as a final summary the British HQ units, coordinated by radio, liberally supplied with recce assets and a supply train only marginally less than late war American forces, performed well in their appointed role.


P09405
British HQs at every level tended to be highly adaptable to suit ever changing circumstances. One feature of the British army of this period that is often forgotten is that it was the first (and for many years the only) army in the world to be entirely motorized. This in turn allowed local commanders to show great flexibility in deploying local resources. There were drawbacks, though, to the British regimental system. All arms coordination in the early years tended to be poor with armor and infantry tending to act independently to no overall plan although this was not particularly evident when the armored forces were drawn from the Royal Tank Regiments first formed in the First World War. Coordination tended to be better at the small unit level where years of experience fighting "low intensity" colonial wars could be best brought to bear. However the lack of coordination at higher levels for many years allowed enemy forces to often defeat in detail what would otherwise be an overwhelming force. However as a final summary the British HQ units, coordinated by radio, liberally supplied with recce assets and a supply train only marginally less than late war American forces, performed well in their appointed role.


P09406
British officers, often drawn from the upper classes of society, were trained from birth to assume positions of leadership. Highly self-reliant and showing great personal initiative, the officer class of the British army coped well with the demands of war. A notable feature of British officers is the amount of trust that was placed in their judgment and in no army other than perhaps the German army were junior officers given such high positions of responsibility. An example being that the artillery units of an entire Army Corps was often placed under the direction of a junior FOO. Officers within the British armed services were also often required to train with their men, this being especially true in elite units such as the Commandos, Marines, the SAS and the like. In so doing a bond of trust was forged between the officer and the men under his command. Also prevalent during the wartime period was the promotion of senior NCOs to commissioned ranks. These men, often drawn from the regular peacetime army, had already proved themselves in battle both in terms of leadership and organizational ability. They had the additional experience that could only be gained through service in the ranks.


P09407
British officers, often drawn from the upper classes of society, were trained from birth to assume positions of leadership. Highly self-reliant and showing great personal initiative, the officer class of the British army coped well with the demands of war. A notable feature of British officers is the amount of trust that was placed in their judgment and in no army other than perhaps the German army were junior officers given such high positions of responsibility. An example being that the artillery units of an entire Army Corps was often placed under the direction of a junior FOO. Officers within the British armed services were also often required to train with their men, this being especially true in elite units such as the Commandos, Marines, the SAS and the like. In so doing a bond of trust was forged between the officer and the men under his command. Also prevalent during the wartime period was the promotion of senior NCOs to commissioned ranks. These men, often drawn from the regular peacetime army, had already proved themselves in battle both in terms of leadership and organizational ability. They had the additional experience that could only be gained through service in the ranks.


P09408
British officers, often drawn from the upper classes of society, were trained from birth to assume positions of leadership. Highly self-reliant and showing great personal initiative, the officer class of the British army coped well with the demands of war. A notable feature of British officers is the amount of trust that was placed in their judgment and in no army other than perhaps the German army were junior officers given such high positions of responsibility. An example being that the artillery units of an entire Army Corps was often placed under the direction of a junior FOO. Officers within the British armed services were also often required to train with their men, this being especially true in elite units such as the Commandos, Marines, the SAS and the like. In so doing a bond of trust was forged between the officer and the men under his command. Also prevalent during the wartime period was the promotion of senior NCOs to commissioned ranks. These men, often drawn from the regular peacetime army, had already proved themselves in battle both in terms of leadership and organizational ability. They had the additional experience that could only be gained through service in the ranks.


P09409
British officers, often drawn from the upper classes of society, were trained from birth to assume positions of leadership. Highly self-reliant and showing great personal initiative, the officer class of the British army coped well with the demands of war. A notable feature of British officers is the amount of trust that was placed in their judgment and in no army other than perhaps the German army were junior officers given such high positions of responsibility. An example being that the artillery units of an entire Army Corps was often placed under the direction of a junior FOO. Officers within the British armed services were also often required to train with their men, this being especially true in elite units such as the Commandos, Marines, the SAS and the like. In so doing a bond of trust was forged between the officer and the men under his command. Also prevalent during the wartime period was the promotion of senior NCOs to commissioned ranks. These men, often drawn from the regular peacetime army, had already proved themselves in battle both in terms of leadership and organizational ability. They had the additional experience that could only be gained through service in the ranks.


P09410
British officers, often drawn from the upper classes of society, were trained from birth to assume positions of leadership. Highly self-reliant and showing great personal initiative, the officer class of the British army coped well with the demands of war. A notable feature of British officers is the amount of trust that was placed in their judgment and in no army other than perhaps the German army were junior officers given such high positions of responsibility. An example being that the artillery units of an entire Army Corps was often placed under the direction of a junior FOO. Officers within the British armed services were also often required to train with their men, this being especially true in elite units such as the Commandos, Marines, the SAS and the like. In so doing a bond of trust was forged between the officer and the men under his command. Also prevalent during the wartime period was the promotion of senior NCOs to commissioned ranks. These men, often drawn from the regular peacetime army, had already proved themselves in battle both in terms of leadership and organizational ability. They had the additional experience that could only be gained through service in the ranks.


P10001
The M3 light tank was based on the pre-war M2A4. In June 1942 an improved version, the M3A1, went into production. This model had a more efficient turret and fighting compartment among other changes. The M3A1 was used by the 1st Armored Division in North Africa. Known as "Stuarts" to the British, the M3 series was renowned for its reliability, though after 1941 it became increasingly obsolete. A total of 4,621 were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
5 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
51mm
WEIGHT
13 tonnes

P10002
The M5 was an interim design with many improvements over the M3A1, among these being thicker armor, sloping front hull plates, and twin Cadillac engines with an automatic transmission. In early 1943 it was supplanted on the production lines by the further improved M5A1. The latter was used to replace M3A1 losses in the 1st Armored Division in North Africa, and by the time of Operation Husky in July 1943 the M5A1 had become the standard U.S. light tank. A total of 6,810 M5A1s were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
3 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
67mm
WEIGHT
15.4 tonnes

P10003
Commonly referred to as the "Chaffee" in honor of Gen. Adna Chaffee, the "father of the U.S. Armored Force", this tank was designed to replace the M5A1. It was based on the M18 tank destroyer but had a new turret with a light-weight 75mm gun from the B-25H Mitchell Bomber. A few saw action in the Ardennes, and by VE Day all light tank companies of the 7th Armored Division and the mechanized cavalry squadrons had been totally re-equipped with the M24. In 1944 and 1945, a total of 4,195 were built. The M24 also saw action in the Korean conflict.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm gun
2 x 7.62mm machineguns
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
25mm
WEIGHT
18.4 tonnes

P10004
The M3 Medium Tank was rushed into production to provide U.S. and Allied forces with a mobile gun that could deal the current series of Pz IIIs and IVs fielded by the Germans. No turret in or close to production at the time could handle its 75mm gun, however, so its main armament was placed in a limited-traverse mount in the right front of the hull. In addition, a high-velocity 37mm gun was mounted in a turret atop the superstructure. The M3 saw action in North Africa, after which time it was replaced by M4 Shermans. A total of 5,811 of the M3 series was built, most of which were Lend-Leased to other countries.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm gun
1 x 37mm gun
3-4 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
57mm
WEIGHT
28 tonnes

P10005
The M4 "General Sherman" medium tank was based on the earlier M3. It was designed to work with infantry in smashing enemy defense lines, and breaking through to disrupt the enemy's supply and communications network. U.S. doctrine at the time called for tank destroyers to take on enemy tanks, so the Sherman was not given any special anti-tank capability. Its 75mm gun was deemed 'good enough' for exploitation operations, but was not intended to destroy Panzers. Due to its tendency to catch fire and explode when penetrated by an armor-piercing shell, the Sherman was called the "Ronson" by contemptuous German tankers, in reference to a name-brand cigarette lighter. 30,600 Shermans with the 75mm gun were built, using several different types of engines. 

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm gun
2 x 7.62mm machineguns
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
76mm
WEIGHT
30.2-32.3 tonnes

P10006
Known unofficially as the "Jumbo", the M4A3E2 was much more heavily armored than the M4. An extra 38mm of armor were added to its front and upper sides, and its lower front hull armor was 140mm thick. A new turret with 152mm-thick cast armor and a 178mm-thick gunshield replaced the standard turret. 254 Jumbos were built, all with the 75mm gun (though some were later field-modified by substituting the more powerful 76mm gun).

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm gun
2 x 7.62mm machineguns
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
178mm
WEIGHT
38.2 tonnes

P10007
Because U.S. Army doctrine called for tanks to be used as infantry support, Shermans were initially given 75mm guns. After clashes with Tigers and Panthers, it quickly became clear that a higher-velocity gun was needed. Originally, it was intended that one third of each Sherman unit be equipped with these improved models, but by VE Day, over half of all Shermans in the U.S. Army in Europe carried 76mm guns. However, the larger gun was only marginally more effective against a Panther's frontal armor. 7,968 Shermans with the 76mm gun were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 76mm gun
2 x 7.62mm machineguns
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
89mm
WEIGHT
31.8 tonnes

P10008
4680 Shermans were produced with a 105mm howitzer as main armament. These were used to provide heavy support in medium tank battalions, the HQ company of which was authorized an "assault gun" platoon of three Sherman 105s.

ARMAMENT
1 x 105mm howitzer
2 x 7.62mm machineguns
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
76mm
WEIGHT
30.2-31 tonnes

P10009
Originally conceived as a replacement for the Sherman, with armor and firepower to match the Tiger I, the earliest form of what would become the M26 Pershing made its first appearance in the spring of 1944 as a medium tank. Apparently in an attempt to boost the confidence of American tankers, it was redesignated a heavy tank. This was not without rationale, however, as it boasted a 90mm gun and armor that was 100mm thick in places. The Pershing's most famous battle was at Remagen bridge. Four Pershings of Company A, 14th Tank Battalion, 9th Armored Division, were in the center of the action. Ironically, these tanks did not cross the heavily damaged bridge because they were deemed too heavy. By VE Day, over 700 M26s had been built. The M26 was also used in the Korean war, reverting back to its original designation as a medium tank.

ARMAMENT
1 x 90mm gun
2 x 7.62mm machineguns
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
102mm
WEIGHT
41.8 tonnes

P10010
The M10 Gun Motor Carriage was based on the M4A2 Medium Tank, but to give the tank destroyer greater mobility its armor was thinner. It also had a new turret, which was open-topped to increase visibility. Because the 3-inch AA gun was so large and heavy, two 1800-lb. counterweights were attached to the rear of the turret to keep it balanced. Moreover, the heavy turret lacked power traverse. After the M10 GMC's successful debut in Tunisia, where it equipped the 899th and 776th Tank Destroyer Battalions, it replaced the M3 GMC halftrack and became the standard U.S. tank destroyer until late 1944 when the M18 and M36 began to replace it. A total of 4,993 M10s were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 3-inch (76mm) gun
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
64mm
WEIGHT
30 tonnes

P10011
Nicknamed The Hellcat, the M18 Gun Motor Carriage was designed to be very light and fast, and proved to be the fastest tracked vehicle of the war. It was popular with its crews, because its speed allowed it to quickly change positions during a battle. This tank destroyer could have been deployed in 1943, but commanders in Europe wanted to wait for the more heavily armed M36 which was in the final stages of production. 2,507 M18s were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x76mm gun
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
25mm
WEIGHT
18 tonnes

P10012
Referred to as the Jackson or Slugger, the M36 Gun Motor Carriage was essentially an M10A1 GMC with a new (but still open-topped) turret and a powerful 90mm gun. Because of this firepower, it was the most successful of all the U.S. tank destroyers. Unfortunately, many commanders expected to use this vehicle in the battlefield as a tank - a task for which it was not well suited, with its open top and thinner armor. The realization that real tanks were more adaptable in a fast-changing battle ultimately led to the end of the Tank Destroyer Command in 1946. 1,413 M36 GMCs were produced.

ARMAMENT
1 x90mm gun
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
76mm
WEIGHT
28.2 tonnes

P10014
Designed primarily as an infantry carrier for armored divisions, the M3 Halftrack could carry 13 men, including the driver. It also carried a .30-cal air-cooled machinegun that was pedestal-mounted in the center-forward section of the passenger compartment. (Later a special .50-cal mount was produced; these vehicles were designated M3A1.) U.S. halftracks were faster than similar German vehicles, but had no floor armor, making the troops highly exposed to mines. Also, their tracks tended to wear out quickly. A total of 12,499 were built. A slightly smaller version - the M2 - was also built, but is represented by the M3 in the game.

ARMAMENT
1 x 7.62mm machinegun
or
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
12.7mm
WEIGHT
8 tonnes

P10015
Based on the M2 Halftrack, the M4 Mortar Carrier provided a mobile mount for the 81mm mortar in mechanized units. Three of these vehicles made up a platoon, which served in the HQ company of tank battalions and armored infantry battalions. About 1200 of the M4 and similar M4A1 Mortar Carriers were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 81mm mortar
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
12.7mm
WEIGHT
8.4 tonnes

P10016
This M3 halftrack mounting an M1897A4 field gun was designed as an interim tank destroyer pending the arrival of the M10 GMC. As such, the M3 provided mixed results in Tunisia. Its thin armor allowed it to be easily destroyed, but it was effective against German armor when used properly from ambush positions. A total of 2,202 were built, but 1,360 later had their big gun removed and served as M3A1 halftracks.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm gun
MAX. ARMOR
16mm
WEIGHT
9 tonnes

P10017
The T30 Howitzer Motor Carriage was an M3 halftrack equipped with a 75mm pack howitzer. Three of these vehicles made up a platoon which served in the HQ company of each tank battalion. The armored regiment's recon company also included a platoon of T30s. Initially, infantry regiments also included two of these platoons in their cannon company. The T30 HMC fought exclusively in Africa and the Mediterranean theaters. A total of 500 was built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm howitzer
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
12.7mm
WEIGHT
8.9 tonnes

P10018
The T19 Howitzer Motor Carriage was an M3 halftrack equipped with a 105mm howitzer. Six comprised a battery in the armored field artillery battalions of the 1st and 2nd Armored Divisions in Tunisia. Initially, cannon companies of infantry regiments in the Mediterranean Theater had two T19 HMC halftracks. The T19 was eventually replaced by the M7 HMC and M3 105mm howitzer. Only 324 were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 105mm howitzer
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
12.7mm
WEIGHT
9.1 tonnes

P10019
The M15A1 Multiple Gun Motor Carriage was an M3 halftrack mounting a 37mm AA gun and two coaxial .50 caliber machineguns. The gun compartment was protected by armored plates. This vehicle was very successful in its AA role in Tunisia. Crews found that they could deceive Axis aircraft into thinking the vehicles were armed only with the machineguns; as overconfident enemy pilots closed to strafe them, the crews would open up with the 37mm gun. Originally assigned to tank destroyer battalions, they were later placed in self-propelled AAA Automatic Weapons battalions. A total of 2,332 were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm AA gun
2 x 12.7mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
12.7mm
WEIGHT
9.5 tonnes

P10020
The M15A1 Multiple Gun Motor Carriage was an M3 halftrack mounting a 37mm AA gun and two coaxial .50 caliber machineguns. The gun compartment was protected by armored plates. This vehicle was very successful in its AA role in Tunisia. Crews found that they could deceive Axis aircraft into thinking the vehicles were armed only with the machineguns; as overconfident enemy pilots closed to strafe them, the crews would open up with the 37mm gun. Originally assigned to tank destroyer battalions, they were later placed in self-propelled AAA Automatic Weapons battalions. A total of 2,332 were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm AA gun
2 x 12.7mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
12.7mm
WEIGHT
9.5 tonnes

P10021
The M16 Multiple Gun Motor Carriage was an M3 halftrack with four.50-caliber machineguns on an electrically powered Maxson turret that could traverse 360 degrees in six seconds. Used in self-propelled AAA Automatic Weapons battalions, it proved very effective against both low-flying aircraft and 'soft' ground targets. Its rate of fire of 2200 rounds per minute led to its being nicknamed the 'meat chopper'.

ARMAMENT
4 x 12.7mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
12.7mm
WEIGHT
9 tonnes

P10023
The M3A1 Scout Car was found mainly in mechanized cavalry troops of infantry and armored divisions, where its functions were to scout enemy positions, screen flanks and provide security. Some were used in tank destroyer battalions as well. Close to 21,000 were built, many of which were given to Allied nations through the Lend-Lease program.

ARMAMENT
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
1 x 7.62mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
12.7mm
WEIGHT
5.6 tonnes

P10026
The M8 Light Armored Car served as the primary AFV in mechanized cavalry units, replacing the M3A1 Scout Car and the M2 Halftrack. Although it was lightly armored and undergunned, its crews liked its speed and the cross-country mobility provided by its light weight and 6x6 drive.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
1 x 7.62mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
19mm
WEIGHT
7.9 tonnes

P10027
Sometimes referred to as the Scott, the M8 Howitzer Motor Carriage was an M5 light tank modified to carry a new turret that mounted a pack howitzer. It was used for both direct and indirect fire support. In the game this unit represents a two-vehicle platoon in the assault-gun troop of the mechanized cavalry squadron. A total of 1,778 were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm howitzer
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
44.5mm
WEIGHT
15.7 tonnes

P10028
Sometimes referred to as the Scott, the M8 Howitzer Motor Carriage was an M5 light tank modified to carry a new turret that mounted a pack howitzer. It was used for both direct and indirect fire support. In the game this unit represents the three-vehicle assault-gun platoon in the HQ company of armored infantry battalions, and of light and medium tank battalions (until replaced by Sherman 105s). A total of 1,778 were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm howitzer
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
44.5mm
WEIGHT
15.7 tonnes

P10029
The M7 Howitzer Motor Carriage was a modified M3 Medium Tank with a 105mm howitzer carried in an open-top compartment. It first saw action in Tunisia; where it began to replace the T19 HMC Halftrack in the armored field artillery battalions of the 1st Armored Division. Serving in batteries of six, it soon equipped all armored field artillery battalions. A total of 3,490 M7 HMCs were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 105mm howitzer
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
51mm
WEIGHT
23 tonnes

P10030
Sometimes called "King Kong", the M12 Gun Motor Carriage was an M1917 or M1918 155mm gun mounted on a heavily modified M3 Medium Tank chassis. Seventy-four of the one hundred built were sent to Normandy between June and August of 1944. As the only heavy artillery that could keep pace with the rapid advance across France after American forces broke out of the hedgerows, this vehicle proved especially valuable. This gun was used in batteries of four.

ARMAMENT
1 x 155mm gun
MAX. ARMOR
51mm
WEIGHT
26.4 tonnes

P10031
The DD (Duplex Drive) design allowed the M4 Sherman to serve as an amphibious tank. After being waterproofed, the vehicle was fitted with a collapsible canvas screen around the hull top, which was erected by rubber tubing filled with compressed air. Two small propellers provided the propulsion in the water at 4 knots. Steering was handled by the tank commander, who stood on a platform attached to the rear of the turret and controlled a tiller that angled the propellers. Although the screen blocked the line of fire from the bow machinegun, it also concealed the tank itself from the enemy; from the ground, it looked somewhat like a small boat, and hence not a worthwhile target. Once ashore, the screen could be dropped and the propellers folded away. It was intended that the tanks arrive before the infantry to provide cover fire, but this was not the case on D-Day due to rough seas and general confusion. Of 59 amphibious tanks actually launched, 28 sank, while 32 others were ship-landed at Normandy's shores. DD Shermans were also used in Operation Anvil/Dragoon, the invasion of Southern France, and in many river-crossing operations, including the breaching of the Rhine. 

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm gun
2 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
76mm
WEIGHT
30.2-32.3 tonnes

P10033
A Jeep scout section included six jeeps. Three had a mounted machinegun, and three carried 60mm mortars and their crews. They served as standard equipment in mechanized cavalry recon platoons from 1943 onward.

ARMAMENT
1 x 7.62mm machinegun
or
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
1.5 tonnes

P10034
Derived from the "GP" (General Purpose) designation by Ford, the Jeep was a 1/4-ton 4x4 utility vehicle that served many roles: command, liaison, and recon. By the end of World War II, a total of 639,245 Jeeps had been built. In the game this unit represents a number of Jeeps used for towing light guns or carrying light mortars.


P10035
Five classes of trucks were standardized by the U.S. Army in 1939: the 1/2-ton, 1.5-ton, 2.5-ton, 4-ton, and 7.5-ton trucks. The 1/2-ton truck was later superseded by the larger 3/4-ton weapons carrier. These vehicles - many of which had 6x6 drive - were used to transport troops, weapons, equipment and supplies. The united States produced some 3.2 million soft-skin vehicles during the war.


P10036
These were fully tracked soft-skin vehicles designed for towing artillery. The two most common models were the M4 and M5 High Speed Tractors. The M4 was used for towing 3-inch and 90mm AA guns, 155mm guns and the 8-inch howitzer. The M5 pulled the 105mm howitzer, the 4.5-inch gun and the 155mm howitzer. It was intended that all such guns would be tractor-towed, but demand always outstripped supply, leaving many gun battalions with 6x6 truck prime movers for the duration of the war.


P10037
This unit represents a variable number of unarmed and unarmored powered boats used to transport infantry and equipment across water.


P10038
This unit represents a variable number of unarmed and unarmored powered boats used to transport infantry and equipment across water.


P10044
Called the "Aunt Jemima", this M4 Sherman variant was outfitted with two huge roller units, each of five 10-ft. diameter steel discs that served to explode mines with their massive weight. The discs were turned by a chain driven from auxiliary sprockets mounted on the tank's drive sprockets. This was the most widely used of American mine exploders.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm gun
2 x 7.62mm machineguns
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
76mm
WEIGHT
57 tonnes

P10045
The Crab was a British-designed device used to clear mines. An M4 Sherman was fitted with a rotating drum to which were attached 43 flailing chains which beat the ground in front of the vehicle to explode the mines. In addition, wire cutters were located at the sides of the drum to cut barbed wire. The Americans used only a small number of these vehicles.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm gun
2 x 7.62mm machineguns
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
76mm
WEIGHT
33 tonnes

P10046
A wheeled amphibious cargo carrier, the DUKW was a 2.5-ton 6x6 truck transformed into a boat which could land supplies directly onto a beach and then use its wheeled drive to proceed inland. Commonly referred to as the "Duck", the DUKW acronym is not a true acronym at all; rather, it is a set of code designations: D=1942, U=Utility, K=all-wheel drive, and W=twin rear axles. Over 21,000 were built.


P10101
This unit represents a section of two 60mm mortars as used in ranger infantry companies. The mortars were not very powerful, but gave the company commander his own private 'artillery' that could bring immediate fire on the enemy from a mile away. Adopted in 1940, the weapon itself was a copy of a French design. About 75,000 were built.

MAX. RANGE
1800m
SHELL WEIGHT
1.36kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
19kg

P10102
This unit represents a section of three 60mm mortars, which were used in rifle, armored infantry, glider and parachute infantry companies. The mortars were not very powerful, but gave the company commander his own private 'artillery' that could bring immediate fire on the enemy from a mile away. Adopted in 1940, the weapon itself was a copy of a French design. About 75,000 were built.

MAX. RANGE
1800m
SHELL WEIGHT
1.36kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
19kg

P10103
This was a copy of the French Brandt 81mm mortar. It could fire both light (7-lb.) and heavy (10.75-lb.) HE bombs and white phosphorus smoke shells. In the game this unit represents a platoon of four mortars found in certain types of HQ company. About 30,000 M1 81mm mortars were built during WWII.

MAX. RANGE
3000m
SHELL WEIGHT
3.12 & 4.82kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
61.7kg

P10104
This was a copy of the French Brandt 81mm mortar. It could fire both light (7-lb.) and heavy (10.75-lb.) HE bombs and white phosphorus smoke shells. In the game this unit represents the platoon of six mortars found in the heavy weapons company of the infantry battalion. About 30,000 M1 81mm mortars were built during WWII.

MAX. RANGE
3000m
SHELL WEIGHT
3.12 & 4.82kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
61.7kg

P10105
Sometimes called "the Goon Gun", the 4.2-inch mortar was originally intended to fire only gas and smoke rounds, but by the time it was first used in combat in Sicily, an HE round had also been developed for it. Unlike most mortars, the 4.2-inch had a rifled barrel instead of a smooth bore; this increased its accuracy, but also made it more expensive. The 4.2-inch was used only in chemical mortar battalions, which were attached to divisions from the corps/army level. A total of 8,500 were made.

MAX. RANGE
4000m
SHELL WEIGHT
12-15kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
149.8kg

P10106
Based on the German PaK 35/36, this gun had a manual breech block which lowered its rate of fire. It was first used in North Africa, but eventually was replaced in the European Theater by the 57mm gun. It was usually towed by a Jeep or 3/4-ton truck. For short-range anti-personnel use it was provided with a potent canister round. 18,702 M3A1 anti-tank guns were built. In the game this unit represents a platoon in the anti-tank company of an infantry regiment.

ARMOR PENETRATION
53mm at 500m
SHELL WEIGHT
.86kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
410kg

P10107
Based on the German PaK 35/36, this gun had a manual breech block which lowered its rate of fire. It was first used North Africa, but was eventually replaced in the European Theater by the 57mm gun. It was usually towed by a Jeep or 3/4-ton truck. For short-range anti-personnel use it was provided with a potent canister round. 18,702 M3A1 anti-tank guns were built. In the game this unit represents the anti-tank platoon in an armored infantry company or glider HQ company.

ARMOR PENETRATION
53mm at 500m
SHELL WEIGHT
.86kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
410kg

P10108
Based on the German PaK 35/36, this gun had a manual breech block which lowered its rate of fire. It was first used North Africa, but was eventually replaced in the European Theater by the 57mm gun. It was usually towed by a Jeep or 3/4-ton truck. For short-range anti-personnel use it was provided with a potent canister round. 18,702 M3A1 anti-tank guns were built. In the game this unit represents the anti-tank platoon in the HQ troop of a mechanized cavalry squadron.

ARMOR PENETRATION
53mm at 500m
SHELL WEIGHT
.86kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
410kg

P10109
This was a U.S.-produced copy of the British 6-pounder anti-tank gun. The U.S. Army adopted the British design in order to replace its obsolete 37mm guns as rapidly as possible. It normally fired only AP (armor-piercing) ammunition. About 16,000 were built. In the game this unit represents a platoon of two guns as found in the anti-tank company of a mountain infantry regiment.

ARMOR PENETRATION
73mm at 1000m
SHELL WEIGHT
2.83kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1215kg

P10110
This was a U.S.-produced copy of the British 6-pounder anti-tank gun. The U.S. Army adopted the British design in order to replace its obsolete 37mm guns as rapidly as possible. It normally fired only AP (armor-piercing) ammunition. About 16,000 were built. This unit represents the anti-tank platoon in an armored infantry company and in the anti-tank company of an infantry regiment.

ARMOR PENETRATION
73mm at 1000m
SHELL WEIGHT
2.83kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1215kg

P10111
This was a U.S.-produced copy of the British 6-pounder anti-tank gun. The U.S. Army adopted the British design in order to replace its obsolete 37mm guns as rapidly as possible. It normally fired only AP (armor-piercing) ammunition. About 16,000 were built. This unit represents a platoon in a glider anti-tank company or airborne AA/AT battalion.

ARMOR PENETRATION
73mm at 1000m
SHELL WEIGHT
2.83kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1215kg

P10112
Using the barrel of the 3-inch (76mm) AA gun and the carriage, breech and recoil mechanisms of the 105mm howitzer, this anti-tank gun was large and cumbersome, but it worked satisfactorily. It was officially referred to as a "tank destroyer" rather than an anti-tank gun. Approximately 2,500 towed guns were built, and a modified version was used in the M10 Gun Motor Carriage.

ARMOR PENETRATION
100mm at 1000m
SHELL WEIGHT
6.94kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2175kg

P10113
Originally designed to be disassembled and carried by pack mules, this weapon was later given a new carriage with pneumatic tires, allowing it to be towed by motorized vehicles. It could also be air dropped. It was used by airborne divisions as well as the 10th Mountain Division in Italy.

MAX. RANGE
8700m
SHELL WEIGHT
6.6kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
588kg-609kg

P10114
The M2A1 105mm Howitzer was the standard divisional light artillery piece. Towed 2.5-ton trucks or in some cases by high-speed tractors, these guns were assigned four per battery, and could use thirteen different types of ammunition. 

MAX. RANGE
11,440m
SHELL WEIGHT
15kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1934kg

P10115
The M3 105mm Howitzer was designed to be air-transportable. It used a shorter barrel than the regular M2A1 105mm howitzer and the carriage from the cavalry version of the 75mm pack howitzer, with a modified recoil mechanism. This unit represents the "cannon company" of six M3s in an infantry regiment. The gun also served in glider field artillery battalions in 1944-45, towed by Jeeps that were also carried in the gliders.

MAX. RANGE
6633m
SHELL WEIGHT
15kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1133kg

P10116
The M3 105mm Howitzer was designed to be air-transportable. It used a shorter barrel than the regular M2A1 105mm howitzer and the carriage from the cavalry version of the 75mm pack howitzer, with a modified recoil mechanism. This unit represents a 1944-45 battery of four M3s in a glider field artillery battalion.

MAX. RANGE
6633m
SHELL WEIGHT
15kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1133kg

P10117
The M1 was designed to use the same ammunition as the British 4.5-inch gun. However, this ammo had a low HE content which made the gun somewhat unpopular despite its long range. The day after VE Day it was declared obsolete. Of the 426 built, only about 200 saw combat.

MAX. RANGE
19,200m
SHELL WEIGHT
24.9kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
5654kg

P10118
In June 1940 there were 2,791 M1917 (the original French C 17 S) and M1918 (the U.S.-produced version) 155mm howitzers in service. The weapon was used in North Africa, Sicily and Italy. It was eventually supplanted, but never entirely superseded, by the more modern M1.

MAX. RANGE
11,250m
SHELL WEIGHT
42.8kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
3715kg

P10119
This gun developed a reputation for both accuracy and reliability. The 155mm howitzer was most commonly used as a companion piece to the 105mm howitzer in divisional artillery, with one 155mm medium field artillery battalion per division. A total of 4,035 was built during the war.

MAX. RANGE
14,640m
SHELL WEIGHT
43kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
5432kg

P10120
The M1918M1 was a U.S.-built version of the French "Canon de 155 GPF". These were used in Tunisia, Sicily, and Italy in non-divisional heavy field artillery battalions. 641 were built.

MAX. RANGE
18,390m
SHELL WEIGHT
43kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
11,775kg

P10121
Called the "Long Tom", this gun was used in non-divisional heavy field artillery battalions which comprised three four-gun batteries. The M1A1 became standard U.S. heavy weapons during World War II.

MAX. RANGE
23,100m
SHELL WEIGHT
43kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
13,909kg

P10122
This howitzer was first used in combat in late 1943 in Italy, and it gained the reputation of being the most accurate long-range artillery piece of the war. By 1945, 1006 of these guns had been built.

MAX. RANGE
16,937m
SHELL WEIGHT
99kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
13,471kg

P10123
This weapon consisted of four .50-caliber machineguns mounted on an electrically driven turret, all carried on a four-wheel trailer. The turret-gun combination was the same as found on the M16 AA halftrack. The combination of "quad 50s" and rapid turret traverse (the turret could turn 360 degrees in six seconds) proved a lethal combination against low-flying aircraft.

BULLET WEIGHT
.045kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1088kg

P10124
The development of this gun dated as far back as 1920 when John Browning began its design. However, the WWII version did not enter production until 1939. The same gun was used on the M15 and M15A1 AA halftracks. The Army used the M1A2 in both Mobile and Semi-Mobile AAA Automatic Weapons battalions. A total of 7278 was built.

MAX. EFFECTIVE CEILING
3200m
SHELL WEIGHT
.6kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2780kg

P10125
This weapon was an American-built version of the famous Bofors, the most widely used AA gun of World War II. A total of 34,116 was built in the USA during the war. It was a superior design to the M1A2 37mm gun, but never completely replaced the latter. The Army used the M1 in both Mobile and Semi-Mobile AAA Automatic Weapons battalions.

MAX. EFFECTIVE CEILING
5000m
SHELL WEIGHT
.96kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2522kg

P10126
This AA gun entered production in 1940. It was designed only for AA fire, and the inability to depress its gun barrel below the horizontal made it less than ideal for use against ground targets. More than 2,000 had been built by the end of 1942, and it saw action in all theaters of the war.

MAX. EFFECTIVE CEILING
10,300m
SHELL WEIGHT
10.6kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
8626kg

P10127
The M2 was designed as an improvement over the M1A1 90mm AA gun, as it was determined that AA guns should also be able to fire against ground targets. Hence the M2 came to be known as the "triple threat" gun due to its ability to fire at air, sea and ground targets. However, its weight was almost double that of its predecessor. Like the M1A1, it was used in four-gun batteries in both Mobile and Semi-Mobile AAA Gun battalions. A total of 7,831 were built by the end of the war. 

MAX. EFFECTIVE CEILING
10,300m
SHELL WEIGHT
10.6kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
14,664kg

P10201
The Rifle Platoon consisted of three squads and a small headquarters, with a total of 41 men. Each 12-man squad was authorized ten M1 rifles, a Browning Automatic Rifle (BAR) and a Model 1903 Springfield Rifle. Three platoons plus a weapons platoon made up a rifle company, and three rifle companies plus a heavy weapons company formed an infantry battalion.


P10202
The Armored Infantry Platoon contained three 12-man rifle squads, a light machinegun squad and a 60mm mortar squad. Each rifle squad had a bazooka instead of a Browning Automatic Rifle (BAR), and every squad was transported in an armored halftrack. An armored infantry company comprised three armored infantry platoons and a 57mm anti-tank gun platoon. (In the game, the company's machinegun and mortar squads have been combined into discrete platoons in order to better represent the company's firepower.) The men did not normally fight from their halftracks, which were very thinly armored. Standard practice was for the squads to carry them to a point where they could safely unload so they could attack on foot.


P10203
The Parachute Infantry Platoon consisted of three squads and a small headquarters, with a total of 43 men. Each 12-man squad was authorized ten M1 rifles, two M1 carbines, a .30-cal. light machinegun and a Browning Automatic Rifle (BAR) - though in reality many of the men actually carried submachineguns. Three platoons and three 60mm mortars made up a company.


P10204
The Ranger Infantry Platoon is assumed to contain about two dozen men armed with rifles, two BARs and a bazooka.


P10205
The Special Service Force (SSF) Rifle Platoon was found in what is commonly referred to as the Devil's Brigade, an elite, all-volunteer joint U.S.-Canadian brigade specially trained in airborne, amphibious, mountain and winter commando tactics. The SSF platoon is assumed to comprise about two dozen men armed with rifles, submachineguns and Bren light machineguns.


P10207
This unit represents the light machinegun section in the weapons platoon of a rifle company. The section contained about 13 men with two air-cooled M1919A4 Browning .30-cal machineguns.


P10208
This unit represents a machinegun platoon in the heavy weapons company of an infantry battalion. The company contained two such platoons, each with about 40 men and four water-cooled M1917A1 Browning.30-cal. machineguns.


P10209
A Combat Engineer Platoon comprised three squads with a total of some 40 men. It was armed with standard infantry equipment along with the special equipment needed to do engineering projects. The combat engineer platoon was capable of performing various duties like mine clearance, demolition and construction.


P10210
The Airborne Infantry Platoon consisted of three squads and a small headquarters, with a total of 43 men. Each 12-man squad was authorized ten M1 rifles, two M1 carbines, a .30-cal. light machinegun and a Browning Automatic Rifle (BAR) - though in reality many of the men actually carried submachineguns. Three platoons and three 60mm mortars made up a company.


P10211
This unit represents a grouping of the .50-cal machineguns found in an infantry battalion. Though issued primarily for AA defense, they were often used in support of ground operations.


P10301
This unit represents a U.S. Divisional HQ. The organization of a headquarters for combat operations is designed to facilitate the command and control process. It includes consideration of the physical means of accomplishing the mission - the communications, control centers, and the staffs, facilities, and equipment necessary to gather and analyze information, plan and supervise execution. The commander determines the location, size, composition, and organization of the headquarters. The Division is one echelon below a Corps level command and it is responsible for the Brigade and Regimental units in its command. 


P10302
This unit represents a U.S. Brigade HQ. The organization of a headquarters for combat operations is designed to facilitate the command and control process. It includes consideration of the physical means of accomplishing the mission - the communications, control centers, and the staffs, facilities, and equipment necessary to gather and analyze information, plan and supervise execution. The commander determines the location, size, composition, and organization of the headquarters. The Brigade is the building block of a Division and it commands and controls battalion sized units. 


P10303
This unit represents a U.S. Regimental HQ. The organization of a headquarters for combat operations is designed to facilitate the command and control process. It includes consideration of the physical means of accomplishing the mission - the communications, control centers, and the staffs, facilities, and equipment necessary to gather and analyze information, plan and supervise execution. The commander determines the location, size, composition, and organization of the headquarters. The Battalion is really the lowest level that you will see a true headquarters as part of its table of organization. The Battalion HQ keeps track of the Company level units in its command. 


P10304
This unit represents a U.S. Battalion (Foot) HQ. The organization of a headquarters for combat operations is designed to facilitate the command and control process. It includes consideration of the physical means of accomplishing the mission - the communications, control centers, and the staffs, facilities, and equipment necessary to gather and analyze information, plan and supervise execution. The commander determines the location, size, composition, and organization of the headquarters. The Battalion is really the lowest level that you will see a true headquarters as part of its table of organization. The Battalion HQ keeps track of the Company level units in its command. This Battalion is comprised of "foot" or light infantry soldiers and generally does not have any organic transportation assets.


P10305
This unit represents a U.S. Battalion (Motorized) HQ. The organization of a headquarters for combat operations is designed to facilitate the command and control process. It includes consideration of the physical means of accomplishing the mission - the communications, control centers, and the staffs, facilities, and equipment necessary to gather and analyze information, plan and supervise execution. The commander determines the location, size, composition, and organization of the headquarters. The Battalion is really the lowest level that you will see a true headquarters as part of its table of organization. The Battalion HQ keeps track of the Company level units in its command. This Battalion is basically the same as a light infantry Battalion but it has some organic wheeled transportation assets. 


P10306
This unit represents a U.S. Corps HQ. The organization of a headquarters for combat operations is designed to facilitate the command and control process. It includes consideration of the physical means of accomplishing the mission - the communications, control centers, and the staffs, facilities, and equipment necessary to gather and analyze information, plan and supervise execution. The commander determines the location, size, composition, and organization of the headquarters. The Corps HQ is one echelon below an Army level command and it is responsible for the Divisional units in its command.


P10307
This unit represents a U.S. Army HQ. The organization of a headquarters for combat operations is designed to facilitate the command and control process. It includes consideration of the physical means of accomplishing the mission - the communications, control centers, and the staffs, facilities, and equipment necessary to gather and analyze information, plan and supervise execution. The commander determines the location, size, composition, and organization of the headquarters. The Army HQ is the largest headquarters unit you will have on the battlefield.


P10401
A trained and ready army has, as its foundation, competent and confident commanders and leaders. Commanders must exhibit sound leadership traits in order to influence others to accomplish the mission by providing purpose, direction and motivation. The battlefield challenge for any commander, regardless of the level of command, is to inspire solders to do things against their natural will to carry out missions for the greater good of the unit, the army and the country. Commanders are a critical asset to an army's ability to fight, survive and be victorious on the battlefield - and this is also true in West Front. 


P10402
A trained and ready army has, as its foundation, competent and confident commanders and leaders. Commanders must exhibit sound leadership traits in order to influence others to accomplish the mission by providing purpose, direction and motivation. The battlefield challenge for any commander, regardless of the level of command, is to inspire solders to do things against their natural will to carry out missions for the greater good of the unit, the army and the country. Commanders are a critical asset to an army's ability to fight, survive and be victorious on the battlefield - and this is also true in West Front. 


P10403
A trained and ready army has, as its foundation, competent and confident commanders and leaders. Commanders must exhibit sound leadership traits in order to influence others to accomplish the mission by providing purpose, direction and motivation. The battlefield challenge for any commander, regardless of the level of command, is to inspire solders to do things against their natural will to carry out missions for the greater good of the unit, the army and the country. Commanders are a critical asset to an army's ability to fight, survive and be victorious on the battlefield - and this is also true in West Front. 


P10404
A trained and ready army has, as its foundation, competent and confident commanders and leaders. Commanders must exhibit sound leadership traits in order to influence others to accomplish the mission by providing purpose, direction and motivation. The battlefield challenge for any commander, regardless of the level of command, is to inspire solders to do things against their natural will to carry out missions for the greater good of the unit, the army and the country. Commanders are a critical asset to an army's ability to fight, survive and be victorious on the battlefield - and this is also true in West Front. 


P10405
A trained and ready army has, as its foundation, competent and confident commanders and leaders. Commanders must exhibit sound leadership traits in order to influence others to accomplish the mission by providing purpose, direction and motivation. The battlefield challenge for any commander, regardless of the level of command, is to inspire solders to do things against their natural will to carry out missions for the greater good of the unit, the army and the country. Commanders are a critical asset to an army's ability to fight, survive and be victorious on the battlefield - and this is also true in West Front. 


P10406
A trained and ready army has, as its foundation, competent and confident commanders and leaders. Commanders must exhibit sound leadership traits in order to influence others to accomplish the mission by providing purpose, direction and motivation. The battlefield challenge for any commander, regardless of the level of command, is to inspire solders to do things against their natural will to carry out missions for the greater good of the unit, the army and the country. Commanders are a critical asset to an army's ability to fight, survive and be victorious on the battlefield - and this is also true in West Front. 


P10407
A trained and ready army has, as its foundation, competent and confident commanders and leaders. Commanders must exhibit sound leadership traits in order to influence others to accomplish the mission by providing purpose, direction and motivation. The battlefield challenge for any commander, regardless of the level of command, is to inspire solders to do things against their natural will to carry out missions for the greater good of the unit, the army and the country. Commanders are a critical asset to an army's ability to fight, survive and be victorious on the battlefield - and this is also true in West Front. 


P10408
A trained and ready army has, as its foundation, competent and confident commanders and leaders. Commanders must exhibit sound leadership traits in order to influence others to accomplish the mission by providing purpose, direction and motivation. The battlefield challenge for any commander, regardless of the level of command, is to inspire solders to do things against their natural will to carry out missions for the greater good of the unit, the army and the country. Commanders are a critical asset to an army's ability to fight, survive and be victorious on the battlefield - and this is also true in West Front. 


P10409
A trained and ready army has, as its foundation, competent and confident commanders and leaders. Commanders must exhibit sound leadership traits in order to influence others to accomplish the mission by providing purpose, direction and motivation. The battlefield challenge for any commander, regardless of the level of command, is to inspire solders to do things against their natural will to carry out missions for the greater good of the unit, the army and the country. Commanders are a critical asset to an army's ability to fight, survive and be victorious on the battlefield - and this is also true in West Front. 


P10410
A trained and ready army has, as its foundation, competent and confident commanders and leaders. Commanders must exhibit sound leadership traits in order to influence others to accomplish the mission by providing purpose, direction and motivation. The battlefield challenge for any commander, regardless of the level of command, is to inspire solders to do things against their natural will to carry out missions for the greater good of the unit, the army and the country. Commanders are a critical asset to an army's ability to fight, survive and be victorious on the battlefield - and this is also true in West Front. 


P10601
The Landing Craft, Personnel, was a military adaptation of a commercial motor boat built by the Higgins Company of new Orleans. It had a wooden hull, and troops had to climb over its sides to (dis)embark. The unit in the game represents the LCP(L), which was a large version of the boat. 2193 of these were built, followed by 2631 LCP(R) which had a narrow bow ramp to facilitate loading and unloading.


P10602
The Landing Craft, Vehicle, was an unarmored (and unarmed) craft with a bow ramp which allowed it to carry a light vehicle or gun. 2366 were built in 1942. Due to their vulnerability to enemy fire, they were quickly superseded by the armored LCVP.


P10603
The Landing Craft, Vehicle Personnel, was an improved version of the LCV, featuring armor plating and twin .30-cal machinegun armament. As with its predecessor, a bow ramp allowed the LCVP to carry a light vehicle or gun. 23,358 LCVPs were built, beginning in 1943.


P10604
The Landing Craft, Assault, was a 1939 British design. It was slower than the LCVP and less well armed, but offered its passengers superior protection against light weapons and shell splinters. 2030 LCA were built, and it was the standard infantry landing craft of British forces. Small numbers were used by U.S. forces as well. 


P10605
The Landing Craft, Mechanized, was a British design originally intended for the transport of a light tank. The most common model was the LCM(3), built mainly by the Higgins Company of new Orleans. This version could carry a medium tank. All LCMs were armored.


P10606
The Landing Craft, Tank, was a British design intended for the transport of several light or medium tanks. The original model was the LCT(1), and by the end of the war the British were using the much larger LCT(4). In the meantime the US produced the LCT(5) and LCT(6).


P19001
The H39 Light Tank was an improved Hotchkiss H35. Improvements included a more powerful engine, a much improved suspension and a longer gun. Service with the Free French included the 1st Compagnie de Chars in Syria and the 351st CACC (Independent Tank Company). 

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
45mm
WEIGHT
12 tonnes

P19047
The R35 Light Tank was designed to replace the aging FT-17 as the main infantry support tank in the French Army. It usually served in independent tank battalions supporting infantry divisions. It appears that about 140 (some sources state 180+) served with the Free French, mainly in Morocco and Algeria.

ARMAMENT 
1 x 37mm gun
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
45mm
WEIGHT
10 tonnes

P19002
The M3A1 Light Tank, better known as the Stuart, was a U.S. light tank lend-leased to the Free French. The M3 was fast, reasonably well-armed and armored, and mechanically reliable. Its greatest drawback was a short range of operation. 148 M3A1s and another 273 of the improved version, the M3A3, were lend-leased to the Free French.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
3 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX. ARMOR
51mm
WEIGHT
13 tonnes

P19003
The M5A1 Light Tank was a U.S. light tank lend-leased to the Free French. Developed from the successful M3 design, the M5A1 was, by all accounts, an excellent light tank. Combing speed, mechanical reliability and an automatic hydraulic transmission, the M5 performed well in whatever role it was assigned. The Free French received 230 of these tanks via lend-lease.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
3 x 7.62mm machineguns
MAX ARMOR
67mm
WEIGHT
15.4 tonnes

P19004
The British-made Crusader Cruiser Tanks were used to equip some Free French armored units in the second half of 1942. This tank was stuffed with weapons and ammunition, making for rather cramped quarters for its five man crew. Interestingly, this tank sported two turrets, one for the main gun, and a second turret mounted on the nose with a Besa machinegun. The second turret was often removed by units in the field.

ARMAMENT
1 x 2pdr (40mm) gun
2 x 7.92mm machineguns
1 x 7.65mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
40mm
WEIGHT
19 tonnes

P19005
The British made Valentine III Infantry Tanks were also used by the Free French. This tank was slow, well armored, fairly well armed and had a crew of three. This tank was a capable machine when used in its intended role as infantry support. It proved somewhat less capable versus armor.

ARMAMENT
1 x 2pdr (40mm) gun
1 x 7.92mm machinegun
1 x .7.65mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
65mm
WEIGHT
16 tonnes

P19043
The Char Moyen D1 Medium Tank was originally classified as a light tank and was intended as a replacement for the FT-17. After its production run ended it was reclassified as a medium tank. It was used by Free French forces in North Africa.

ARMAMENT
1 x 47mm gun
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
40mm
WEIGHT
19.5 tonnes

P19006
The SOMUA S35 Medium Tank was based somewhat on the Char D2 and was adopted as the main medium tank of the DLM (light mechanized divisions). This tank was generally considered the best French built tank of the war. The Free French used this tank in southern France in 1945.

ARMAMENT
1 x 47mm gun
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
56mm
WEIGHT 
20 tonnes

P19007
The Char B1-bis Medium Tank was the principal medium tank in service with the French Army in 1940. Heavily armed and armored it was a formidable weapon even as late as 1945. Like most French tank designs it suffered from the liability of the one man turret. By 1945, spare parts were mostly unavailable, meaning that breakdowns could permanently disable the Char as effectively as battle damage. The Free French used 17 B1-bis recaptured from German forces to equip the 2nd Squadron of the 13th Dragoons. They saw action along the Gironde River in 1945.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm howitzer
1 x 47mm gun
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
60mm
WEIGHT
32 tonnes

P19008
The M4 Medium Tank was a U.S. medium tank lend-leased to the Free French. Known as the Sherman 75, the M4 was solidly built, reliable, and extremely versatile. Although not the best medium tank of the war, the Sherman performed well in combat and under competent leadership it could be a formidable weapon, even decisive. Some 650 of these tanks were lend-leased and equipped all three DB (Free French armored division) by June 1944.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm gun
2 x 7.62mm machineguns
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
76mm
WEIGHT
30.2-32.3 tonnes

P19009
The M4 (76)W Medium Tank was a U.S. medium tank lend-leased to the Free French. This tank was an improved Sherman 75 with a toughened, redesigned turret to fit the more powerful 76mm gun. The Free French received this tank via in-theater transfer instead of direct shipment from the U.S.

ARMAMENT
1 x 76mm gun
2 x 7.62mm machineguns
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
89mm
WEIGHT
31.8 tonnes

P19010
The M4(105) Medium Tank was a U.S. medium tank lend-leased to the Free French. The M4 had its 75mm main gun and coaxial MG replaced by a 105 mm howitzer. It was used mainly in the direct-fire support role. The Free French received this vehicle via in-theater transfer instead of direct shipment from the U.S.

ARMAMENT
1 x 105mm howitzer
2 x 7.62mm machineguns
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
76mm
WEIGHT
30.2-31 tonnes

P19011
The Carrier AC 25mm Tank Destroyers were made from captured Vichy 25mm anti-tank guns mounted on British Carriers. These vehicles were used by Free French Foreign Legion units in North Africa.

ARMAMENT
1 x 25mm gun
MAX ARMOR
10mm
WEIGHT
4.5 tonnes

P19012
The M10 GMC Tank Destroyer was a U.S. tank destroyer lend-leased to the Free French. The M10 Gun Motor Carriage was the first important American tank destroyer of the war. It was designed to fill the gap between conventional Allied armor and superior German designs. Noting the inadequacy of the 75mm and 6-lb guns against heavier German armor, the M10 was fitted with a high-velocity 3-inch gun. The gun was set in a shallow open topped turret on a Sherman chassis. The M10 was relatively fast and maneuverable, and performed well in the field. Based as it was on the Sherman chassis, it was also very reliable mechanically. Its major drawback was that the reduction in armor that gave the M10 greater speed left it particularly vulnerable to anti-tank fire. Each Free French armored division had 115 M10s.

ARMAMENT
1 x 3-inch (76mm) gun
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
57mm
WEIGHT
29.6 tonnes
 
P19013
The AM Dodge Scout Car was a Vichy design captured by Free French forces in Syria. This vehicle was a Dodge 4x2 truck fitted with 12mm armor plates and a 37mm gun, plus a coaxial machinegun. 

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
12mm
WEIGHT
6 tonnes

P19014
The M3A1 Scout Car Section consisted of three U.S. lend-leased M3A1 scout cars. These vehicles were issued to the armored reconnaissance battalion of the Free French armored divisions. An undetermined number of these vehicles were lend-leased to the Free French.

ARMAMENT
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
2 x 7.62mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
12.7mm
WEIGHT
3.9 tonnes

P19046
The AMD 20 cv TOE Armored Cars were produced by the French strictly for colonial use. 30 were built and most of these were sent to French North Africa. The Free French used ex-Vichy vehicles.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
10mm
WEIGHT
6.5 tonnes

P19015
The AMD 50 Armored Cars were modernized versions of the White Armored Car used in WWI. Also known as the White-Laffly or Laffly 50 AM, this armored car completed its production run in 1934. Intended for long-range reconnaissance, most of them were sent to French North Africa. 98 were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
MAX ARMOR
10mm
WEIGHT
6.5 tonnes

P19016
The AMD 80 Armored Cars were modernized versions of the White Armored Car used in WWI. Also known as the Laffly-Vincennes or Laffly 80 AM, this armored car completed its production run in 1935. Intended for long-range reconnaissance, it was sent to Tunisia. 28 were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
10mm
WEIGHT
7.5 tonnes

P19045
The AMC 29 Halftrack Armored Car design dated to 1923. This vehicle was a fully armored, closed-top halftrack and had a turret mounted machinegun in its original form, which was later changed to a 37mm gun. 100 were built. The AMC 29 saw action with Free French (ex-Vichy) forces in Tunisia.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
10mm
WEIGHT
7 tonnes

P19017
The Marmon-Herrington ME Armored Car was a British design used by the Free French. In the fall of 1942 the Free French 1st RMSM was re-formed as an armored car unit. Marmon-Herringtons were used to make up the bulk of this unit. Some 21 of the Marmon-Herringtons were used.

ARMAMENT
1 x anti-tank rifle
2 x machineguns
MAX ARMOR
14mm
WEIGHT
5.5 tonnes

P19018
The Marmon-Herrington Support Armored Car was a British design used by the Free French. In the fall of 1942 the Free French 1st RMSM was re-formed as an armored car unit. Marmon-Herrington armored cars were used to make up the bulk of this unit. Some 21 Marmon-Herringtons were used.

ARMAMENT
1 x 20mm AA
or
1 x 47mm AT
or
1 x 37mm AT
or
1 x 2pdr (40mm) AT
MAX ARMOR
14mm
WEIGHT
5-6 tonnes

P19019
The Humber II Armored Car was a British design used by the Free French. Records indicate the 1st and 2nd Squadrons of the 1st RMSM used a total of three of these vehicles in January of 1943.

ARMAMENT
1 x 15mm machinegun
1 x machinegun
MAX ARMOR
20mm
WEIGHT
7 tonnes

P19020
The M8 Armored Car was a U.S. armored car lend-leased to the Free French. Formed into sections of three vehicles, the M8 was used by the Free French armored reconnaissance battalions. The M8 was an excellent armored car. It was fast, had a good range of operation, and it was mechanically reliable.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
1 x 7.62mm machinegun
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
19mm
WEIGHT
7.9 tonnes

P19021
The M8 HMC Self-Propelled Howitzers was a U.S. self-propelled gun lend-leased to the Free French. The M8 featured a 75mm howitzer set in a fully revolving turret. The M8 was based the M5 light tank chassis. The M8 was faster and more maneuverable than the other U.S.-made self-propelled guns. The Free French used them in tank, armored infantry, and armored recon battalions. About 140 were lend-leased to the Free French.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm howitzer
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
38mm
WEIGHT
18 tonnes

P19022
The M7 HMC Self-Propelled Howitzer was a U.S. self-propelled gun lend-leased to the Free French. Better known as the "Priest", the M7 consisted of a 105mm howitzer mounted on a Sherman chassis. It also carried a .50-inch anti-aircraft machinegun mounted on high pulpit-like round turret ring on the right front of the hull. It was this feature that gave the M7 its nickname, the "Priest". Over 179 were lend-leased to the Free French.

ARMAMENT
1 x 105mm howitzer
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
52mm
WEIGHT
31 tonnes

P19023
The T30 HMC Self-Propelled Howitzer Halftracks was a 75mm pack howitzer mounted on an M5 halftrack. Eight of these vehicles were lend-leased to the Free French. They were used in the support role by Free French armored recon battalions.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm howitzer
1 x 7.62mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
12.7mm
WEIGHT
10 tonnes

P19024
The Autocanon de 75 Conus TD Truck was designed by a Lieutenant Conus of the Free French. Known as the "Conus Gun", this vehicle was an armored, self-propelled version of the mle 1897 75mm field gun. Conus mounted the gun on Canadian Ford F60L 3-ton trucks, and used turret-traverse parts from captured and abandoned Italian tanks to give the gun full traverse capabilities. About a dozen "Conus guns" were built and they were used by the 3rd Squadron of the 1st RMSM as part of the British 8th Army.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm gun
MAX ARMOR
12mm
WEIGHT
9 tonnes

P19044
The Autocanon de 75 Artillery Truck was a Vichy design consisting of a "French 75" artillery piece on the back of a truck, mounted so that the gun could traverse 360 degrees and be fired without having to be unloaded. Some were used in Tunisia by ex-Vichy forces fighting with the Allies.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm gun
MAX ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
6 tonnes

P19025
The Autocanon de 25 Anti-Aircraft Trucks were 25mm anti-aircraft guns mounted on light trucks. The Free French captured some 25mm AA guns in the Levant (Lebanon-Syria) and mounted about 12 of them on light trucks. The 25mm AA trucks only saw action in North Africa. They were nicknamed "Dervishes".

ARMAMENT
1 x 25mm anti-aircraft gun
MAX ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
7 tonnes

P19026
The Autocanon de 40 Anti-Aircraft Truck was a 40mm Bofors anti-aircraft gun mounted on a GMC 6x6 truck. Also known as the GMC Bofor, 32 of these vehicles were built. They were used to provide mobile anti-aircraft protection for the 2nd DB. It is possible that they have also served with the 1st and/or 5th DB as well.

ARMAMENT
1 x 40mm Bofors anti-aircraft gun
MAX ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
8 tonnes

P19027
Free French units used a variety of British Carriers, excepting the mortar types. The 1st BFL (Free French Brigade) used some 63 of these vehicles at Bir Hacheim during the fighting in May of 1942. The Carriers were armed with a 25mm anti-tank gun.

ARMAMENT
1 x 25mm gun
MAX ARMOR
10mm
WEIGHT
4.5 tonnes

P19028
The Free French used a variety of British Carriers, excepting the mortar types. The Machinegun Carrier was of the more commonly used carriers. It was armed with a 7.5mm machinegun and saw action mainly in North Africa.

ARMAMENT
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
10mm
WEIGHT
4.5 tonnes

P19029
The Free French used a variety of British carriers, among which was the British Loyd Carrier.

ARMAMENT
1 x 25mm anti-tank gun
or
1 x 7.5mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
6 tonnes

P19030
The British Quad Field Artillery Tractors were issued the Free French for towing heavier guns. Some 40 of these prime movers were used, mostly to tow the British 25pdr field gun. Some were used to tow the French 47mm anti-tank gun. 

ARMAMENT
none
MAX ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
5 tonnes

P19031
The SOMUA MCG Halftrack Prime Movers were used primarily for towing artillery larger artillery pieces(105mm+). A noisy and slow vehicle, the SOMUA MCG also could not carry the gun, crew, and ammunition in one vehicle; it required two vehicles. 

ARMAMENT
none
MAX ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
6.5 tonnes

P19032
The M5 Halftrack was a U.S. halftrack lend-leased to the Free French. The M5 was built by the International Harvester Company solely for lend-lease. It was a very rugged and reliable vehicle. The armored infantry battalions of all DB (Free French armored divisions) were fully equipped with M5s.

ARMAMENT
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
13mm
WEIGHT
11 tonnes

P19033
The M21 Mortar Halftrack was a U.S. halftrack lend-leased to the Free French. The M21 was a marriage of the M5 halftrack and an 81mm mortar. 54 of these vehicles were used by the Free French forces.

ARMAMENT
1 x 81mm mortar
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX ARMOR
13mm
WEIGHT
11 tonnes

P19034
The Jeep Scout Section was made up of three U.S.-made jeeps. The jeep was an outstanding vehicle. Fast, rugged, and reliable, it was said the jeep could do just about anything except fly. The Scout versions were armed with a machinegun and could carry up to 4 passengers, including the driver.

ARMAMENT
1 x 7.62mm machinegun
or
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
1.25 tonnes

P19035
The Jeep was a U.S. made light utility vehicle lend-leased to the Free French. The Jeep was powered by a 4-cylinder engine and was classed as a quarter-ton truck for carrying capacity. It was exceptionally sturdy, mechanically reliable, and had a high clearance and four-wheel drive for operation in rough terrain. The Jeep could also climb a 60% grade and ford shallow streams. It was used as a command car, reconnaissance car, ambulance, a light weapons, ammunition and personnel carrier, and many other purposes. Over 4000 Jeeps were lend-leased to the Free French.

ARMAMENT
none
ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
1.25 tonnes.

P19036
The Free French used a variety of French and British made trucks. Trucks had many uses including towing guns, carrying guns en portee, and transporting troops. This unit is a generic representation of these trucks and includes special types.


P19037
The U.S. lend-leased the Free French over 11,000 Trucks ranging from 1 1/2 tonners to 2 1/2+ ton trucks. In spite of this huge number, the Free French periodically complained of truck shortages. Trucks had many uses, including towing guns, carrying guns en portee, and transporting troops. This unit is a generic representation of these trucks and includes many special types.


P19038
This unit represents a variable number of wagons sufficient to move a battery of guns or a platoon of infantry.


P19039
This unit represents a variable number of horses sufficient to carry a platoon of cavalry.


P19040
This unit represents a variable number motorcycles used to transport infantry. Motorcycles are most often affiliated with some type of recon unit.


P19041
This unit represents a variable number of unarmed and unarmored boats used to transport troops and equipment across water.


P19042
This unit represents a variable number of rafts used to transport troops and equipment across water.


P19101
The French-made mortars initially available to the Free French were only those possessed by the units when they declared themselves de Gaulle supporters. After the fall of Vichy Lebanon and Syria, the Free French possessed enough French-made mortars and ammunition to fully equip its units fighting with the British 8th Army through the end of 1942. Among these mortars was the mle 35 60mm mortar. The mle 35 was the standard light mortar of the French Army in May 1940. It could fire both light and heavy bombs.

MAX RANGE
1700m
SHELL WEIGHT
1.3kg or 2.2kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
17.8kg

P19102
The M2 60mm Mortar was a U.S.-made mortar lend-leased to the Free French. The M2 was actually a copy of the mle 35 60mm mortar design produced in the U.S. It was issued at the rate of three per infantry company, and could fire both high explosive and smoke bombs.

MAX RANGE
2000m
SHELL WEIGHT
1.36kg.
WEIGHT IN ACTION
20.45kg.

P19103
The OML 3-inch Mortar was a British design issued to the Free French. The Free French used these mortars mostly for training except when the supply for French-made mortars was unable meet the demands of forces in the field. The OML 3-inch mortar was usually deployed in a section containing two mortars.

MAX RANGE
1500m, after mid-42 2550m
SHELL WEIGHT
4.54kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
57.2kg

P19104
The mle 27/31 81mm Mortar Group used a mortar designed by Edgar Brandt company. The mortar group consisted of two mortars. After the fall of Vichy Lebanon and Syria, Free French forces captured enough mortars (including the mle 27/31) and ammunition to fully equip its forces fighting in the British 8th Army. This mortar was usually deployed in a two-mortar section. It could fire both light and heavy bombs, and smoke.

MAX RANGE
2850m
SHELL WEIGHT
3.25kg or 6.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
59.7kg

P19105
The Free French received some 1500 U.S. mortars via lend-lease, among them the M1 81mm mortar. Easy to set up, the M1 consisted of a 51 inch smooth bore barrel, a bipod, and a base plate. It was operated by a crew of three. The M1 could fire both high explosive and smoke bombs. This unit represents a platoon of four mortars.

MAX RANGE
2400m
SHELL WEIGHT
3.5kg or 6.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
62kg

P19106
The Free French received some 1500 U.S. mortars via lend-lease., among them the M1 81mm mortar. Easy to set up, the M1 consisted of a 51 inch smooth bore barrel, a bipod, and a base plate. It was operated by a crew of three. The M1 fire both high explosive and smoke bombs. This unit represents a battery of six mortars which was attached to each Free French infantry battalion.

MAX RANGE
2400m
SHELL WEIGHT
3.5kg or 6.5kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
62kg
 
P19126
The mle 16 TR 37mm Infantry Gun was designed in 1916 as an infantry support weapon. it was often pressed into service in the anti-tank role, usually due to shortages of other types of anti-tank guns. The Free French had a few of these guns available to them as part of their original equipment issue. Others were captured from Vichy forces. This unit represents a two-gun section.

MAX RANGE
2400m
SHELL WEIGHT
.55kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
108kg

P19107
The SA-L mle 34 25mm Anti-Tank Gun was built by the Hotchkiss company and served as the standard battalion and regimental anti-tank gun in the French Army. After the armistice, those units declaring for de Gaulle had some of these guns and others were captured from Vichy forces. This unit represents a three-gun platoon.

ARMOR PENETRATION
50mm@600m 
SHELL WEIGHT
.32kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
310-496kg

P19108
The SA mle 37 APX 47mm Anti-Tank Gun was a powerful weapon for its time, firing tungsten-core shot. A few of these guns were captured by Free French forces after the fall of Vichy Lebanon Syria. They were used by the 1st BFL, the 2nd Foreign Legion Battalion and the 1st Anti-Tank Company. This unit represents a four-gun platoon.

ARMOR PENETRATION
59mm @ 500m
SHELL WEIGHT
0.825kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
550kg

P19109
After the loss of their anti-tank guns in the fighting around Bir Hakeim, the Free French were re-equipped with British OQF 6pdr Anti-Tank Guns. The 6pdr had good mobility and a relatively high rate of fire, but was not really a first-class anti-tank gun. This unit represents a four-gun section.

ARMOR PENETRATION
81mm@500m
SHELL WEIGHT
2.8kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
500kg

P19110
The U.S. made M1 57mm Anti-Tank Gun was issued to Free French units as replacements starting in the summer of 1943. An adequate weapon the 57mm still lacked the punch to kill heavier German armor. An undetermined number of these guns were lend-leased to the Free French. The M1 is a close copy of the British 6pdr anti-tank gun. This unit represents a two-gun platoon.

ARMOR PENETRATION
83mm@500m
SHELL WEIGHT
2.8kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
500kg

P19111
.The U.S. made M1 57mm Anti-Tank Gun was issued to Free French units as replacements starting in the summer of 1943. An adequate weapon the 57mm still lacked the punch to kill heavier German armor. An undetermined number of these guns were lend-leased to the Free French. The M1 is a close copy of the British 6pdr anti-tank gun. This unit represents a three-gun platoon.

ARMOR PENETRATION
83mm@500m
SHELL WEIGHT
2.8kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
500kg

P19112
The U.S. made M1 57mm Anti-Tank Gun was issued to Free French units as replacements starting in the summer of 1943. An adequate weapon the 57mm still lacked the punch to kill heavier German armor. An undetermined number of these guns were lend-leased to the Free French. The M1 is a close copy of the British 6pdr anti-tank gun. This unit represents a four-gun platoon.

ARMOR PENETRATION
83mm@500m
SHELL WEIGHT
2.8kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
500kg

P19113
The mle 1897 75mm Anti-Tank Guns was based on the famous model 1897 field gun. Very few of these guns were initially available to the Free French: only those that remained with the expeditionary force that was sent to Norway in 1940. After the fall of Vichy Lebanon and Syria several more mle 1897s were available, most of them being lost in the actions in North Africa.

ARMOR PENETRATION
75mm at 500m
SHELL WEIGHT
5.98kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1190kg

P19114
The mle 1897 75mm Field Gun was the famous model 1897 field piece of WWI. Very few of these guns were initially available to the Free French: only those that remained with the expeditionary force sent to Norway in 1940. After the fall of Vichy Lebanon Syria several more mle 1897s were available, most of them being lost in the actions in North Africa. 

MAX RANGE
11100m
SHELL WEIGHT
6.2kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1140kg

P19115
The OQF 25-Pounder Field Gun was first issued to the Free French as part of the 1st Artillery Regiment which saw action at Bir Hakeim. This gun was the famous British 25-pounder gun-howitzer. The 25-pounder was usually mounted on a turntable platform giving it 360 degrees of traverse. This was a very versatile weapon, firing high explosive, armor piercing and smoke ammunition.

MAX RANGE
12500m
SHELL WEIGHT
11.34kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1840kg

P19124
The mle 13 S 105mm Field Gun was based on a Russian 107mm design and was first produced in 1914. Those used by the Free French forces were probably captured from Vichy forces in Lebanon/Syria. Although an elderly weapon it still gave good service in the Free French artillery units.

MAX RANGE
12000m
SHELL WEIGHT
15.7kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2300kg

P19116
The M3 105mm Howitzer was a U.S. design lend-leased to the Free French. They were used by the Free French in regimental cannon companies. This unit represents a six-gun cannon company.

MAX RANGE
6633m
SHELL WEIGHT
15kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1133kg

P19117
The M2A1 105mm Howitzer was a U.S. design lend-leased to the Free French. They were used by Free French infantry divisions as the divisional light artillery piece. This unit represents a four-gun battery.

MAX RANGE
11,440m
SHELL WEIGHT
15kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1934kg

P19118
The OBL 5.5-inch Gun-Howitzer was a British design used by the Free French. The Free French had at least one four-gun troop available for the Second Battle of Alamein. Some sources indicate that there may have been two troops forming an eight-gun battery. This unit represents a four-gun troop.

MAX RANGE
14800m
SHELL WEIGHT
45.4kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
6200kg

P19125
The mle 17 S 155mm Howitzer C 17 S was originally designed as a 152mm howitzer for Czarist Russia. Use by the French in WWI, over 1800 were still in service in May 1940. Those used by the Free French were probably captured from Vichy forces, although some may have been re-captured from the Germans. This unit represents a four-gun battery.

MAX RANGE
11300m
SHELL WEIGHT
43.6kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
3300kg

P19119
The M1 155mm Howitzer was a U.S. heavy artillery piece lend-leased to the Free French. The M1 was used as the divisional heavy artillery piece in the five U.S. equipped Free French infantry divisions. About 60 of these guns were lend-leased to the Free French. This unit represents a four-gun battery.

MAX RANGE
19200m
SHELL WEIGHT
24.9kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
5654kg

P19120
The M1918M1 155mm Gun was a U.S. heavy gun lend-leased to the Free French. This unit represents a four-gun battery.

ARMAMENT
19500m
SHELL WEIGHT
43kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
10750kg

P19128
The mle 06 65mm Mountain Gun was used by the Free French until the end of the war. These guns were captured from Vichy forces in Lebanon/Syria and French North Africa. This gun had an unusual recoil mechanism. Called the counter or soft-recoil system, the barrel travels forward when the lanyard is pulled and the gun fires when the barrel's forward travel limit is reached. This allowed the barrel's momentum to help offset the recoil. This unit represents a four-gun battery.

MAX RANGE
6500m
SHELL WEIGHT
4.4kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
400kg

P19121
The mle 28 75mm Mountain Gun was used by Free French forces until the end of the war. This gun was designed as a replacement for the mle 06 65mm Mountain Gun. The Free French used guns captured from Vichy forces in the Levant and French North Africa. This unit represents a four-gun Battery.

MAX RANGE
9000m
SHELL WEIGHT
7.25kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
660kg

P19127
The mle 39 O 20mm Anti-Aircraft Gun was actually the Swiss Oerlikon 20mm AA gun. Free French forces captured several of these guns from Vichy forces in the Levant and French North Africa. This unit represents a four-gun battery.

MAX EFFECTIVE CEILING
2000m
SHELL WEIGHT
0.3kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
400kg

P19122
The OQF 40mm Anti-Aircraft Gun was actually the Swedish 40mm Bofors Anti-Aircraft gun. The British provided the Free French forces with several of these superb weapons. Fully automatic, the Bofors provided fast, accurate, saturating fire against low-flying aircraft. It had a full 360 degree traverse and maximum 90 degree elevation. This unit represents a two-gun section.

MAX EFFECTIVE CEILING
5600m
SHELL WEIGHT
0.9kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2654kg

P19123
The M1 40mm Anti-Aircraft Gun was a U.S. made anti-aircraft gun based on the Swedish Bofors design. The Free French infantry divisions equipped by the U.S. were each authorized a battalion of 32 guns. This gun was fully automatic, had 360 degree traverse and 90 degrees of elevation. It could provide fast, accurate, saturating fire against low-flying aircraft. 758 of these weapons were lend-leased to the Free French. This unit represents a four-gun battery.

MAX EFFECTIVE CEILING
5600m
SHELL WEIGHT
0.9kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
2654kg

P19201
This unit represents a Free French carrier rifle section. This was a rifle squad transported in British carriers. The carrier rifle section was armed with rifles, grenades and occasionally a light machinegun. It usually served in the mobile reserve capacity.


P19202
This unit represents a standard Free French rifle platoon. Until the middle of 1943 Free French infantry formations were still mostly equipped with French made weapons. During the summer of 1943 U.S. lend-lease weapons began equipping these units. This platoon usually consisted of 41 men armed with rifles, pistols, grenades and up to 6 light machineguns. The platoon was further divided into four squads and each squad was additionally equipped with a rifle grenade launcher.


P19203
This unit represents a U.S.-equipped rifle platoon. During the summer of 1943 U.S. lend-lease infantry weapons were issued to Free French infantry formations. This unit generally consisted of 41 men armed with rifles (M1 Garand .30 cal.), BARs (Browning Automatic Rifle), pistols (Colt .45 cal), grenades and up to six light machineguns (Browning .30 cal.). The platoon was further divided into four squads and each squad was additionally equipped with a rifle grenade launcher. Another infantry weapon issued to Free French units was the M3 .45 cal. submachinegun a.k.a. The Grease Gun.


P19204
This unit represents a Free French Armored Infantry Platoon. Beginning in late 1943 the U.S. began equipping these units as the infantry contingent for the Free French armored divisions. They were equipped with rifles, BARs, light machineguns, pistols, grenades and a few submachineguns. These platoons were transported in M5 halftrack armored personnel carriers.


P19205
The Free French that were in the British SAS left to form the Free French Commandos after North Africa became Free French. Although equipped by the U.S., the Free French commandos undoubtedly patterned their unit after those of the SAS. These units were extremely versatile, trained in types of operations from amphibious to parachute. The battalion formations began being formed in June 1943 and they first saw action during the invasion of Italy. These were the Free French shock troops. This unit represents a platoon of about 35 men armed with sub-machineguns, combat knives, grenades, explosives and occasionally a small mortar.


P19206
This unit represents a Free French cavalry platoon. It had about 30-35 men and was armed with rifles, pistols and two light machineguns. The cavalry platoons were usually attached to a reconnaissance unit.


P19207
This unit represents a Free French motorcycle platoon. Usually employed in the reconnaissance role, it had about 35 men armed with rifles, pistols and up to six light machineguns.


P19208
This unit represents a Free French engineer platoon. French combat engineers have a long and distinguished history, and they are the oldest organized professional engineering corps in the world. During the reign of Louis XIV(1643-1715), the Marquis de Vauban organized and systematized the tasks of engineers, creating the world's first professional engineering corps. The combat engineers represented here are a direct result of this. The combat engineering platoon had 45 men. They carried small arms and an array of combat engineering equipment.


P19209
This unit represents a U.S. equipped Free French engineer platoon. French combat engineers have a long and distinguished history, and they are the oldest organized professional engineering corps in the world. During the reign of Louis XIV(1643-1715), the Marquis de Vauban organized and systematized the tasks of engineers, creating the world's first professional engineering corps. The combat engineers represented here are a direct result of this. The combat engineering platoon had 45 men. They were armed with U.S. made small arms and a plethora of U.S.-made engineering equipment.


P19210
This unit represents a Free French machinegun section. It usually consisted of 20 men, a few rifles, and two heavy machineguns. Two machinegun sections made up a machinegun platoon.


P19211
This unit represents a Free French machinegun platoon. The machinegun platoon was made up of two machinegun sections. It had 40 men, some rifles and four heavy machineguns.


P19212
This unit represents the U.S. -equipped Free French light machinegun section. It usually consisted of 20 men, some rifles and two .30-inch Browning light machineguns.


P19213
This unit represents the U.S.-equipped Free French heavy machinegun platoon. It had 40 men armed with rifles, three .30-inch Browning light machineguns and one M2 .50-inch Browning heavy machinegun.


P19214
This unit represents the U.S.-equipped .50-cal machinegun platoon. It had 40 men armed with rifles and four M2 .50-inch Browning heavy machineguns. The M2 was a devastating defensive weapon. It had many of the qualities of the standard smaller caliber guns, plus a maximum range of 7200m, a cyclic rate of 450 rounds per minute, high accuracy and the brutal, shattering impact of its big bullets. The M2 is an air-cooled weapon.


P19215
This unit represents the Free French anti-aircraft machinegun section. It had 15-20 men and two anti-aircraft machineguns. The weapon primarily used by this unit was the Hotchkiss de 13.2mm mle 1930 anti-aircraft machinegun. This weapon was twin-barreled and very complex. It weighed about 300kg, but was very effective against low-flying aircraft.


P19301
This unit represents a Free French Army-level HQ. Free French officers proved themselves time and again to be brave, intelligent, and very adaptable. The HQ represented here still suffered from poor communications equipment, a problem not relieved until U.S. equipment became available in mid to late 1943.


P19302
This unit represents a U.S.-equipped Free French Army-level HQ. Free French officers proved themselves time and again to be brave, intelligent and adaptable. This adaptability was a must by 1943 when Free French combat units were equipped with U.S.-made, British-made, and/or French-made equipment.


P19303
This unit represents a Free French Corps-level HQ. Free French officers proved themselves time and again to be brave, intelligent, and very adaptable. The HQ represented here still suffered from poor communications equipment, a problem not relieved until U.S. equipment became available in mid to late 1943.


P19304
This unit represents a U.S.-equipped Free French Corps-level HQ. Free French officers proved themselves time and again to be brave, intelligent and adaptable. This adaptability was a must by 1943 when Free French combat units were equipped with U.S.-made, British-made, and/or French-made equipment.


P19305
This unit represents a Free French Divisional-level HQ. Free French officers proved themselves time and again to be brave, intelligent, and very adaptable. The HQ represented here still suffered from poor communications equipment, a problem not relieved until U.S. equipment became available in mid to late 1943.


P19306
This unit represents a U.S.-equipped Free French Divisional-level HQ. Free French officers proved themselves time and again to be brave, intelligent and adaptable. This adaptability was a must by 1943 when Free French combat units were equipped with U.S.-made, British-made, and/or French-made equipment


P19307
This unit represents a Free French Brigade-level HQ. Free French officers proved themselves time and again to be brave, intelligent, and very adaptable. The HQ represented here still suffered from poor communications equipment, a problem not relieved until U.S. equipment became available in mid to late 1943.


P19308
This unit represents a U.S.-equipped Free French Brigade-level HQ. Free French officers proved themselves time and again to be brave, intelligent and adaptable. This adaptability was a must by 1943 when Free French combat units were equipped with U.S.-made, British-made, and/or French-made equipment.


P19309
This unit represents a Free French Regimental-level HQ. Free French officers proved themselves time and again to be brave, intelligent, and very adaptable. The HQ represented here still suffered from poor communications equipment, a problem not relieved until U.S. equipment became available in mid to late 1943.


P19310
This unit represents a U.S.-equipped Free French Regimental-level HQ. Free French officers proved themselves time and again to be brave, intelligent and adaptable. This adaptability was a must by 1943 when Free French combat units were equipped with U.S.-made, British-made, and/or French-made equipment.


P19311
This unit represents a Free French Battalion-level HQ(foot). Free French officers proved themselves time and again to be brave, intelligent, and very adaptable. The HQ represented here still suffered from poor communications equipment, a problem not relieved until U.S. equipment became available in mid to late 1943.


P19312
This unit represents a U.S.-equipped Free French Battalion-level HQ(foot). Free French officers proved themselves time and again to be brave, intelligent and adaptable. This adaptability was a must by 1943 when Free French combat units were equipped with U.S.-made, British-made, and/or French-made equipment.


P19313
This unit represents a Free French Battalion-level HQ(mot.). Free French officers proved themselves time and again to be brave, intelligent, and very adaptable. The HQ represented here still suffered from poor communications equipment, a problem not relieved until U.S. equipment became available in mid to late 1943.


P19314
This unit represents a U.S.-equipped Free French Battalion-level HQ(mot.). Free French officers proved themselves time and again to be brave, intelligent and adaptable. This adaptability was a must by 1943 when Free French combat units were equipped with U.S.-made, British-made, and/or French-made equipment.


P19401
To generalize, Free French officers were well trained, brave, intelligent and adaptable. With metropolitan France occupied by Germany, it appeared that these officers often bordered on the fanatical in combat. Often using obsolete equipment, especially prior to U.S. entry, the Free French forces proved to be as formidable a foe as was faced by Axis forces during the war.


P19402
To generalize, Free French officers were well trained, brave, intelligent and adaptable. With metropolitan France occupied by Germany, it appeared that these officers often bordered on the fanatical in combat. Often using obsolete equipment, especially prior to U.S. entry, the Free French forces proved to be as formidable a foe as was faced by Axis forces during the war.


P19403
To generalize, Free French officers were well trained, brave, intelligent and adaptable. With metropolitan France occupied by Germany, it appeared that these officers often bordered on the fanatical in combat. Often using obsolete equipment, especially prior to U.S. entry, the Free French forces proved to be as formidable a foe as was faced by Axis forces during the war.


P19404
To generalize, Free French officers were well trained, brave, intelligent and adaptable. With metropolitan France occupied by Germany, it appeared that these officers often bordered on the fanatical in combat. Often using obsolete equipment, especially prior to U.S. entry, the Free French forces proved to be as formidable a foe as was faced by Axis forces during the war.


P19405
To generalize, Free French officers were well trained, brave, intelligent and adaptable. With metropolitan France occupied by Germany, it appeared that these officers often bordered on the fanatical in combat. Often using obsolete equipment, especially prior to U.S. entry, the Free French forces proved to be as formidable a foe as was faced by Axis forces during the war.


P19406
To generalize, Free French officers were well trained, brave, intelligent and adaptable. With metropolitan France occupied by Germany, it appeared that these officers often bordered on the fanatical in combat. Often using obsolete equipment, especially prior to U.S. entry, the Free French forces proved to be as formidable a foe as was faced by Axis forces during the war.


P19407
To generalize, Free French officers were well trained, brave, intelligent and adaptable. With metropolitan France occupied by Germany, it appeared that these officers often bordered on the fanatical in combat. Often using obsolete equipment, especially prior to U.S. entry, the Free French forces proved to be as formidable a foe as was faced by Axis forces during the war.


P19408
To generalize, Free French officers were well trained, brave, intelligent and adaptable. With metropolitan France occupied by Germany, it appeared that these officers often bordered on the fanatical in combat. Often using obsolete equipment, especially prior to U.S. entry, the Free French forces proved to be as formidable a foe as was faced by Axis forces during the war.


P19409
To generalize, Free French officers were well trained, brave, intelligent and adaptable. With metropolitan France occupied by Germany, it appeared that these officers often bordered on the fanatical in combat. Often using obsolete equipment, especially prior to U.S. entry, the Free French forces proved to be as formidable a foe as was faced by Axis forces during the war.


P19410
To generalize, Free French officers were well trained, brave, intelligent and adaptable. With metropolitan France occupied by Germany, it appeared that these officers often bordered on the fanatical in combat. Often using obsolete equipment, especially prior to U.S. entry, the Free French forces proved to be as formidable a foe as was faced by Axis forces during the war.


P20017
The T30 Howitzer Motor Carriage was an M3 halftrack equipped with a 75mm pack howitzer. Three of these vehicles made up a platoon which served in the HQ company of each tank battalion. The armored regiment's recon company also included a platoon of T30s. Initially, infantry regiments also included two of these platoons in their cannon company. The T30 HMC fought exclusively in Africa and the Mediterranean theaters. A total of 500 was built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 75mm howitzer
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
12.7mm
WEIGHT
8.9 tonnes


P20018
The T19 Howitzer Motor Carriage was an M3 halftrack equipped with a 105mm howitzer. Six comprised a battery in the armored field artillery battalions of the 1st and 2nd Armored Divisions in Tunisia. Initially, cannon companies of infantry regiments in the Mediterranean Theater had two T19 HMC halftracks. The T19 was eventually replaced by the M7 HMC and M3 105mm howitzer. Only 324 were built.

ARMAMENT
1 x 105mm howitzer
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
12.7mm
WEIGHT
9.1 tonnes


P20023
The M3A1 Scout Car was found mainly in mechanized cavalry troops of infantry and armored divisions, where its functions were to scout enemy positions, screen flanks and provide security. Some were used in tank destroyer battalions as well. Close to 21,000 were built, many of which were given to Allied nations through the Lend-Lease program.

ARMAMENT
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
1 x 7.62mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
12.7mm
WEIGHT
5.6 tonnes


P20026
The M8 Light Armored Car served as the primary AFV in mechanized cavalry units, replacing the M3A1 Scout Car and the M2 Halftrack. Although it was lightly armored and undergunned, its crews liked its speed and the cross-country mobility provided by its light weight and 6x6 drive.

ARMAMENT
1 x 37mm gun
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
1 x 7.62mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
19mm
WEIGHT
7.9 tonnes


P20033
A Jeep scout section included six jeeps. Three had a mounted machinegun, and three carried 60mm mortars and their crews. They served as standard equipment in mechanized cavalry recon platoons from 1943 onward.

ARMAMENT
1 x 7.62mm machinegun
or
1 x 12.7mm machinegun
MAX. ARMOR
none
WEIGHT
1.5 tonnes


P20034
Derived from the "GP" (General Purpose) designation by Ford, the Jeep was a 1/4-ton 4x4 utility vehicle that served many roles: command, liaison, and recon. By the end of World War II, a total of 639,245 Jeeps had been built. In the game this unit represents a number of Jeeps used for towing light guns or carrying light mortars.


P20035
Five classes of trucks were standardized by the U.S. Army in 1939: the 1/2-ton, 1.5-ton, 2.5-ton, 4-ton, and 7.5-ton trucks. The 1/2-ton truck was later superseded by the larger 3/4-ton weapons carrier. These vehicles - many of which had 6x6 drive - were used to transport troops, weapons, equipment and supplies. The united States produced some 3.2 million soft-skin vehicles during the war.


P20037
This unit represents a variable number of unarmed and unarmored powered boats used to transport infantry and equipment across water.


P20038
This unit represents a variable number of unarmed and unarmored powered boats used to transport infantry and equipment across water.


P20102
This unit represents a section of three 60mm mortars, which were used in rifle, armored infantry, glider and parachute infantry companies. The mortars were not very powerful, but gave the company commander his own private 'artillery' that could bring immediate fire on the enemy from a mile away. Adopted in 1940, the weapon itself was a copy of a French design. About 75,000 were built.

MAX. RANGE
1800m
SHELL WEIGHT
1.36kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
19kg


P20104
This was a copy of the French Brandt 81mm mortar. It could fire both light (7-lb.) and heavy (10.75-lb.) HE bombs and white phosphorus smoke shells. In the game this unit represents the platoon of six mortars found in the heavy weapons company of the infantry battalion. About 30,000 M1 81mm mortars were built during WWII.

MAX. RANGE
3000m
SHELL WEIGHT
3.12 & 4.82kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
61.7kg


P20106
Based on the German PaK 35/36, this gun had a manual breech block which lowered its rate of fire. It was first used in North Africa, but eventually was replaced in the European Theater by the 57mm gun. It was usually towed by a Jeep or 3/4-ton truck. For short-range anti-personnel use it was provided with a potent canister round. 18,702 M3A1 anti-tank guns were built. In the game this unit represents a platoon in the anti-tank company of an infantry regiment.

ARMOR PENETRATION
53mm at 500m
SHELL WEIGHT
.86kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
410kg


P20107
Based on the German PaK 35/36, this gun had a manual breech block which lowered its rate of fire. It was first used North Africa, but was eventually replaced in the European Theater by the 57mm gun. It was usually towed by a Jeep or 3/4-ton truck. For short-range anti-personnel use it was provided with a potent canister round. 18,702 M3A1 anti-tank guns were built. In the game this unit represents the anti-tank platoon in an armored infantry company or glider HQ company.

ARMOR PENETRATION
53mm at 500m
SHELL WEIGHT
.86kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
410kg


P20109
This was a U.S.-produced copy of the British 6-pounder anti-tank gun. The U.S. Army adopted the British design in order to replace its obsolete 37mm guns as rapidly as possible. It normally fired only AP (armor-piercing) ammunition. About 16,000 were built. In the game this unit represents a platoon of two guns as found in the anti-tank company of a mountain infantry regiment.

ARMOR PENETRATION
73mm at 1000m
SHELL WEIGHT
2.83kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1215kg


P20110
This was a U.S.-produced copy of the British 6-pounder anti-tank gun. The U.S. Army adopted the British design in order to replace its obsolete 37mm guns as rapidly as possible. It normally fired only AP (armor-piercing) ammunition. About 16,000 were built. This unit represents the anti-tank platoon in an armored infantry company and in the anti-tank company of an infantry regiment.

ARMOR PENETRATION
73mm at 1000m
SHELL WEIGHT
2.83kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1215kg


P20114
The M2A1 105mm Howitzer was the standard divisional light artillery piece. Towed 2.5-ton trucks or in some cases by high-speed tractors, these guns were assigned four per battery, and could use thirteen different types of ammunition. 

MAX. RANGE
11,440m
SHELL WEIGHT
15kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1934kg


P20115
The M3 105mm Howitzer was designed to be air-transportable. It used a shorter barrel than the regular M2A1 105mm howitzer and the carriage from the cavalry version of the 75mm pack howitzer, with a modified recoil mechanism. This unit represents the "cannon company" of six M3s in an infantry regiment. The gun also served in glider field artillery battalions in 1944-45, towed by Jeeps that were also carried in the gliders.

MAX. RANGE
6633m
SHELL WEIGHT
15kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1133kg


P20118
In June 1940 there were 2,791 M1917 (the original French C 17 S) and M1918 (the U.S.-produced version) 155mm howitzers in service. The weapon was used in North Africa, Sicily and Italy. It was eventually supplanted, but never entirely superseded, by the more modern M1.

MAX. RANGE
11,250m
SHELL WEIGHT
42.8kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
3715kg


P20119
This gun developed a reputation for both accuracy and reliability. The 155mm howitzer was most commonly used as a companion piece to the 105mm howitzer in divisional artillery, with one 155mm medium field artillery battalion per division. A total of 4,035 was built during the war.

MAX. RANGE
14,640m
SHELL WEIGHT
43kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
5432kg


P20123
This weapon consisted of four .50-caliber machineguns mounted on an electrically driven turret, all carried on a four-wheel trailer. The turret-gun combination was the same as found on the M16 AA halftrack. The combination of "quad 50s" and rapid turret traverse (the turret could turn 360 degrees in six seconds) proved a lethal combination against low-flying aircraft.

BULLET WEIGHT
.045kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
1088kg


P20201
Based on the US model the Brazilian Rifle Platoon consisted of three squads and a small headquarters, with a total of 41 men. Each 12-man squad was authorized ten M1 rifles, a Browning Automatic Rifle (BAR) and a Model 1903 Springfield Rifle. Three platoons plus a weapons platoon made up a rifle company, and three rifle companies plus a heavy weapons company formed an infantry battalion.  Brazils simple but valorous soldiers of the 1st Expeditionary Infantry Division overcame terrible handicaps in both training and leadership.  Most of the soldiers were conscripts, from a rural background.  They included decendants of Japanese, Polish, Russian, African, German, Italian, Portuguese and many other origins. The Brazilian Army was not segregated, unlike the American forces. Infantry training consisted of every type of warfare except mountain warfare, which became the typical type of warfare the Brazilians faced in Italy. For the majority of the troops, training was given to a reasonable degree, but still far from what average U.S. infantry divisions were used to.


P20207
This unit represents the light machinegun section in the weapons platoon of a rifle company. The section contained about 13 men with two air-cooled M1919A4 Browning .30-cal machineguns.


P20208
This unit represents a machinegun platoon in the heavy weapons company of an infantry battalion. The company contained two such platoons, each with about 40 men and four water-cooled M1917A1 Browning.30-cal. machineguns.


P20209
A Combat Engineer Platoon comprised three squads with a total of some 40 men. It was armed with standard infantry equipment along with the special equipment needed to do engineering projects. The combat engineer platoon was capable of performing various duties like mine clearance, demolition and construction.


P20211
This unit represents a grouping of the .50-cal machineguns found in an infantry battalion. Though issued primarily for AA defense, they were often used in support of ground operations.


P20301
This unit represents the 1st Expeditionary Infantry Divisional HQ. The organization of a headquarters for combat operations is designed to facilitate the command and control process. It includes consideration of the physical means of accomplishing the mission - the communications, control centers, and the staffs, facilities, and equipment necessary to gather and analyze information, plan and supervise execution. The commander determines the location, size, composition, and organization of the headquarters. The Division is one echelon below a Corps level command and it is responsible for the Brigade and Regimental units in its command. 


P20302
This unit represents a 1st Expeditionary Infantry Brigade HQ. The organization of a headquarters for combat operations is designed to facilitate the command and control process. It includes consideration of the physical means of accomplishing the mission - the communications, control centers, and the staffs, facilities, and equipment necessary to gather and analyze information, plan and supervise execution. The commander determines the location, size, composition, and organization of the headquarters. The Brigade is the building block of a Division and it commands and controls battalion sized units. 


P20303
This unit represents a 1st Expeditionary Infantry Regimental HQ. The organization of a headquarters for combat operations is designed to facilitate the command and control process. It includes consideration of the physical means of accomplishing the mission - the communications, control centers, and the staffs, facilities, and equipment necessary to gather and analyze information, plan and supervise execution. The commander determines the location, size, composition, and organization of the headquarters. The Battalion is really the lowest level that you will see a true headquarters as part of its table of organization. The Battalion HQ keeps track of the Company level units in its command. 


P20304
This unit represents a 1st Expeditionary Infantry Battalion (Foot) HQ. The organization of a headquarters for combat operations is designed to facilitate the command and control process. It includes consideration of the physical means of accomplishing the mission - the communications, control centers, and the staffs, facilities, and equipment necessary to gather and analyze information, plan and supervise execution. The commander determines the location, size, composition, and organization of the headquarters. The Battalion is really the lowest level that you will see a true headquarters as part of its table of organization. The Battalion HQ keeps track of the Company level units in its command. This Battalion is comprised of "foot" or light infantry soldiers and generally does not have any organic transportation assets.


P20305
This unit represents a 1st Expeditionary Infantry Battalion (Motorized) HQ. The organization of a headquarters for combat operations is designed to facilitate the command and control process. It includes consideration of the physical means of accomplishing the mission - the communications, control centers, and the staffs, facilities, and equipment necessary to gather and analyze information, plan and supervise execution. The commander determines the location, size, composition, and organization of the headquarters. The Battalion is really the lowest level that you will see a true headquarters as part of its table of organization. The Battalion HQ keeps track of the Company level units in its command. This Battalion is basically the same as a light infantry Battalion but it has some organic wheeled transportation assets. 


P20401
 In 1943, when the 1st DIE  was organized the combat experience of Brazilian officers and NCOs was almost non existant and many officers were opposed to direct involvement in the war.  All throught the FEB campaign in Italy, dated tactical mentality would pose a grave hindrance for the FEB infantry, not because lack of combat experience, which they painstakingly acquired, rather because sheer incompetence of  commanders.  During the 20's and well into the 30's a French military mission was responsible for the formation of officers and the Armys organization, so it closely followed the French doctrine of the 1914-18 war.  Brazilian soldiers s were accustomed to severe discipline of the caste-like Brazilian Army.  Even during peacetime, other ranks were not allowed to wear civilian clothes, a rule which did not apply to officers. There was no trace of friendship or comraderie between officers and men whatsoever, rations and meals differed, enlisted men were very poorly fed.  This state of affairs was to change dramatically after initial contacts with other Allied forces.  The 1st DIE was organized after U.S. standards and for  every type of warfare possible but mountain warfare, but this was to be the typical terrain that the Brazilians faced in Italy. For the majority of the troops, training was given to a reasonable degree, but still far from what average U.S. infantry divisions were used to.


P20402
 In 1943, when the 1st DIE  was organized the combat experience of Brazilian officers and NCOs was almost non existant and many officers were opposed to direct involvement in the war.  All throught the FEB campaign in Italy, dated tactical mentality would pose a grave hindrance for the FEB infantry, not because lack of combat experience, which they painstakingly acquired, rather because sheer incompetence of  commanders.  During the 20's and well into the 30's a French military mission was responsible for the formation of officers and the Armys organization, so it closely followed the French doctrine of the 1914-18 war.  Brazilian soldiers s were accustomed to severe discipline of the caste like Brazilian Army.  Even during peacetime, other ranks were not allowed to wear civilian clothes, a rule to which officers did not apply. There was no trace of friendship or comraderie between officers and men whatsoever, rations and meals differed, enlisted men were very poorly fed.  This state of affairs was to change dramatically after initial contacts with other Allied forces.  The 1st DIE was organized after U.S. standards and for  every type of warfare possible but mountain warfare, but this was to be the typical terrain that the Brazilians faced in Italy. For the majority of the troops, training was given to a reasonable degree, but still far from what average U.S. infantry divisions were used to.


P20403
 In 1943, when the 1st DIE  was organized the combat experience of Brazilian officers and NCOs was almost non existant and many officers were opposed to direct involvement in the war.  All throught the FEB campaign in Italy, dated tactical mentality would pose a grave hindrance for the FEB infantry, not because lack of combat experience, which they painstakingly acquired, rather because sheer incompetence of  commanders.  During the 20's and well into the 30's a French military mission was responsible for the formation of officers and the Armys organization, so it closely followed the French doctrine of the 1914-18 war.  Brazilian soldiers s were accustomed to severe discipline of the caste-like Brazilian Army.  Even during peacetime, other ranks were not allowed to wear civilian clothes, a rule which did not apply to officers. There was no trace of friendship or comraderie between officers and men whatsoever, rations and meals differed, enlisted men were very poorly fed.  This state of affairs was to change dramatically after initial contacts with other Allied forces.  The 1st DIE was organized after U.S. standards and for  every type of warfare possible but mountain warfare, but this was to be the typical terrain that the Brazilians faced in Italy. For the majority of the troops, training was given to a reasonable degree, but still far from what average U.S. infantry divisions were used to.


P20404
 In 1943, when the 1st DIE  was organized the combat experience of Brazilian officers and NCOs was almost non existant and many officers were opposed to direct involvement in the war.  All throught the FEB campaign in Italy, dated tactical mentality would pose a grave hindrance for the FEB infantry, not because lack of combat experience, which they painstakingly acquired, rather because sheer incompetence of  commanders.  During the 20's and well into the 30's a French military mission was responsible for the formation of officers and the Armys organization, so it closely followed the French doctrine of the 1914-18 war.  Brazilian soldiers s were accustomed to severe discipline of the caste-like Brazilian Army.  Even during peacetime, other ranks were not allowed to wear civilian clothes, a rule which did not apply to officers. There was no trace of friendship or comraderie between officers and men whatsoever, rations and meals differed, enlisted men were very poorly fed.  This state of affairs was to change dramatically after initial contacts with other Allied forces.  The 1st DIE was organized after U.S. standards and for  every type of warfare possible but mountain warfare, but this was to be the typical terrain that the Brazilians faced in Italy. For the majority of the troops, training was given to a reasonable degree, but still far from what average U.S. infantry divisions were used to.


P20405
 In 1943, when the 1st DIE  was organized the combat experience of Brazilian officers and NCOs was almost non existant and many officers were opposed to direct involvement in the war.  All throught the FEB campaign in Italy, dated tactical mentality would pose a grave hindrance for the FEB infantry, not because lack of combat experience, which they painstakingly acquired, rather because sheer incompetence of  commanders.  During the 20's and well into the 30's a French military mission was responsible for the formation of officers and the Armys organization, so it closely followed the French doctrine of the 1914-18 war.  Brazilian soldiers s were accustomed to severe discipline of the caste-like Brazilian Army.  Even during peacetime, other ranks were not allowed to wear civilian clothes, a rule which did not apply to officers. There was no trace of friendship or comraderie between officers and men whatsoever, rations and meals differed, enlisted men were very poorly fed.  This state of affairs was to change dramatically after initial contacts with other Allied forces.  The 1st DIE was organized after U.S. standards and for  every type of warfare possible but mountain warfare, but this was to be the typical terrain that the Brazilians faced in Italy. For the majority of the troops, training was given to a reasonable degree, but still far from what average U.S. infantry divisions were used to.


P20406
 In 1943, when the 1st DIE  was organized the combat experience of Brazilian officers and NCOs was almost non existant and many officers were opposed to direct involvement in the war.  All throught the FEB campaign in Italy, dated tactical mentality would pose a grave hindrance for the FEB infantry, not because lack of combat experience, which they painstakingly acquired, rather because sheer incompetence of  commanders.  During the 20's and well into the 30's a French military mission was responsible for the formation of officers and the Armys organization, so it closely followed the French doctrine of the 1914-18 war.  Brazilian soldiers s were accustomed to severe discipline of the caste-like Brazilian Army.  Even during peacetime, other ranks were not allowed to wear civilian clothes, a rule which did not apply to officers. There was no trace of friendship or comraderie between officers and men whatsoever, rations and meals differed, enlisted men were very poorly fed.  This state of affairs was to change dramatically after initial contacts with other Allied forces.  The 1st DIE was organized after U.S. standards and for  every type of warfare possible but mountain warfare, but this was to be the typical terrain that the Brazilians faced in Italy. For the majority of the troops, training was given to a reasonable degree, but still far from what average U.S. infantry divisions were used to.


P20407
 In 1943, when the 1st DIE  was organized the combat experience of Brazilian officers and NCOs was almost non existant and many officers were opposed to direct involvement in the war.  All throught the FEB campaign in Italy, dated tactical mentality would pose a grave hindrance for the FEB infantry, not because lack of combat experience, which they painstakingly acquired, rather because sheer incompetence of  commanders.  During the 20's and well into the 30's a French military mission was responsible for the formation of officers and the Armys organization, so it closely followed the French doctrine of the 1914-18 war.  Brazilian soldiers s were accustomed to severe discipline of the caste-like Brazilian Army.  Even during peacetime, other ranks were not allowed to wear civilian clothes, a rule which did not apply to officers. There was no trace of friendship or comraderie between officers and men whatsoever, rations and meals differed, enlisted men were very poorly fed.  This state of affairs was to change dramatically after initial contacts with other Allied forces.  The 1st DIE was organized after U.S. standards and for  every type of warfare possible but mountain warfare, but this was to be the typical terrain that the Brazilians faced in Italy. For the majority of the troops, training was given to a reasonable degree, but still far from what average U.S. infantry divisions were used to.


P20408
 In 1943, when the 1st DIE  was organized the combat experience of Brazilian officers and NCOs was almost non existant and many officers were opposed to direct involvement in the war.  All throught the FEB campaign in Italy, dated tactical mentality would pose a grave hindrance for the FEB infantry, not because lack of combat experience, which they painstakingly acquired, rather because sheer incompetence of  commanders.  During the 20's and well into the 30's a French military mission was responsible for the formation of officers and the Armys organization, so it closely followed the French doctrine of the 1914-18 war.  Brazilian soldiers s were accustomed to severe discipline of the caste-like Brazilian Army.  Even during peacetime, other ranks were not allowed to wear civilian clothes, a rule which did not apply to officers. There was no trace of friendship or comraderie between officers and men whatsoever, rations and meals differed, enlisted men were very poorly fed.  This state of affairs was to change dramatically after initial contacts with other Allied forces.  The 1st DIE was organized after U.S. standards and for  every type of warfare possible but mountain warfare, but this was to be the typical terrain that the Brazilians faced in Italy. For the majority of the troops, training was given to a reasonable degree, but still far from what average U.S. infantry divisions were used to.


P20409
 In 1943, when the 1st DIE  was organized the combat experience of Brazilian officers and NCOs was almost non existant and many officers were opposed to direct involvement in the war.  All throught the FEB campaign in Italy, dated tactical mentality would pose a grave hindrance for the FEB infantry, not because lack of combat experience, which they painstakingly acquired, rather because sheer incompetence of  commanders.  During the 20's and well into the 30's a French military mission was responsible for the formation of officers and the Armys organization, so it closely followed the French doctrine of the 1914-18 war.  Brazilian soldiers s were accustomed to severe discipline of the caste-like Brazilian Army.  Even during peacetime, other ranks were not allowed to wear civilian clothes, a rule which did not apply to officers. There was no trace of friendship or comraderie between officers and men whatsoever, rations and meals differed, enlisted men were very poorly fed.  This state of affairs was to change dramatically after initial contacts with other Allied forces.  The 1st DIE was organized after U.S. standards and for  every type of warfare possible but mountain warfare, but this was to be the typical terrain that the Brazilians faced in Italy. For the majority of the troops, training was given to a reasonable degree, but still far from what average U.S. infantry divisions were used to.


P20410
 In 1943, when the 1st DIE  was organized the combat experience of Brazilian officers and NCOs was almost non existant and many officers were opposed to direct involvement in the war.  All throught the FEB campaign in Italy, dated tactical mentality would pose a grave hindrance for the FEB infantry, not because lack of combat experience, which they painstakingly acquired, rather because sheer incompetence of  commanders.  During the 20's and well into the 30's a French military mission was responsible for the formation of officers and the Armys organization, so it closely followed the French doctrine of the 1914-18 war.  Brazilian soldiers s were accustomed to severe discipline of the caste-like Brazilian Army.  Even during peacetime, other ranks were not allowed to wear civilian clothes, a rule which did not apply to officers. There was no trace of friendship or comraderie between officers and men whatsoever, rations and meals differed, enlisted men were very poorly fed.  This state of affairs was to change dramatically after initial contacts with other Allied forces.  The 1st DIE was organized after U.S. standards and for  every type of warfare possible but mountain warfare, but this was to be the typical terrain that the Brazilians faced in Italy. For the majority of the troops, training was given to a reasonable degree, but still far from what average U.S. infantry divisions were used to.


P20501
The 1st Grupo de Aviao de Caa equipped with the P-47 - Thunderbolt opperated within the American 350th Fighter Group.


P22001
About 1930 two Ford AA chassis with twin rear wheels were armored and armed with a 20mm Madsen machinegun. These cars were named FP-1 and FP-2, FP meaning "Forsoegs Panser" or armored experimental. The idea was, that in case of war, suited commercial vehicles were to be given to the army, and armored bodywork was to be fitted on them. This idea was later abandoned, but FP1 and 2 were kept in service right up to WW2, as they were cheap to use, and Denmark only had very few other armored cars.


P22002
In 1935 the army ordered two Landsverk M36 bodies on a German Bssing-chassis'. These were the first true Danish armored cars, and were delivered in 1936. A rear drivers position was provided as well as chains to put on the rear wheels, to make a kind of halftrack in rough terrain. Price: 100.000 Danish Kr each.

ARMAMENT
1 X 20mm cannon
2 x 8mm Machineguns
MAX ARMOR
19mm
WEIGHT
7,400 kg


P22003
Three Lynx cars were recieved from Landsverk in late 1939, and by February a total of 15 more where ordered from Sweden. They were to equip the two cavalry units in Denmark: Jydske Dragon Regiment and Garder Husar Regiment. The German invasion of Denmark in 1940 prevented delivery and all 15 were taken by the Swedish army. None of the five battleworthy armored cars PV36 or PV39 saw action against the Germans on the 9th of April, 1940.

ARMAMENT
1 x 20mm cannon
3 x 8mm Machineguns
MAX ARMOR
18mm
WEIGHT
7,800 kg


P22004
Danish engineer, E. R. Kornbeck, designed a simplified track system using three massive bogie rollers instead of the four lightweight rollers of the French Kegresse system. In the late 1920's it was tested and compared to other half-tracks and tractors. In 1931 it was chosen for production as the Triangel-Kornbeck and equipped with an 85hp engine. The heavy artillery up to (approximately) 1941 used these units.


P22005
The Danish Army realized, that they needed a small cross-country vehicle for reconnaissance and transportation of supplies and small weapons just like the American Jeep or the German Kbelwagen. In 1937 they bought one Tempo-Gelndwagen from "Vidal und Sohn-Tempo Werke" in Germany and tested it. The four wheel drive car was unusual in it's engine and drive train design with twin two-stroke engines located one to each end of the vehicle. It could be driven with either one engine or both engines operating. The Danes accepted the vehicle for service and bought 29. Only 20 were received before the war.


P22006
This unit represents a group of trucks used by the Danish Army.


P22007
This unit represents a group of wagons used by the Danish Army.


P22008
This unit represents a group of Horses used by the Danish Army Cavalry units.


P22009
This unit represents a group of Bicycles used by the Danish Army.


P22010
The Nimbus was an aircooled, four cylinder motorbike of 750 ccm with 21 hp.The four cylinders were in a row parallel with the bikes length, and it had shaft drive. It was, alongside with BMW, the first motorbike with telescopic forks. The framework wasn't tube, but flat steel bars, riveted together. Topspeed was around 85 km/t with sidecar. 


P22011
This unit represents small boats used by Danish forces.


P22012
This unit represents small boats or rafts used by Danish forces.


P22101
This unit represents 81mm mortars used by Danish forces. They were a Brandt design with performance similar to that of Frence 81mm mortar.


P22102
The 20mm Madsen machinegun was a scaled up 8mm Madsen machine gun. The 8mm Madsen was developed in the 1890s, and adopted by the Danish army in 1903. It was one of the very first light machineguns, and at the same time very reliable. No one has ever used the same system as in the Madsen. The Madsen had a unique firing system and was rather expensive to make. Like the Nimbus, there were some national pride connected to it.


P22103
The Bofors M/36 37mm anti-tank gun was used by the Danish army as an anti-tank gun and infantry gun.

ARMOR PENETRATION
33mm at 500m
SHELL WEIGHT
1.4kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
380kg


P22104
The is the Krupp 99/00/01/02/03 export model. This gun was the standard field gun of the Danish Army.


P22105
This weapon was the French 105mm L M1936 Schneider. The French model had rubber tires and highspeed-mods, the Danish model did not. The mle 36 S 105mm Field Gun was the intended replacement for the L 13 S and was the most modern artillery piece in the French inventory.

MAX RANGE
16,000m
SHELL WEIGHT
15.7kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
3540-3920kg


P22106
This weapon was the French 155mm C M1917 Schneider. The mle 17 S 155mm Howitzer C 17 S was originally designed as a 152mm howitzer for Czarist Russia. Adopted for use by France during WWI, and still in use in 1940.

MAX RANGE
11,300m
SHELL WEIGHT
43.6kg
WEIGHT IN ACTION
3300kg

P22108
This weapon was a variant of the Vickers model 1931.


P22109
This unit represents the main armament of the Coastal defense ships Niels Juel and Peder Skram.


P22201
This unit represents a platoon of the Life Guard Regiment. The life Guard and Hussar Guard regiments were royal guard regiments and the elite of the Danish army. In time of war, they operated as regular cavalry and infantry units. This unit represents a platoon of Life Guards armed with 8mm Krag rifles and 8mm Madsen light machineguns. Each platoon was divided into 4 rifle sections (with 9 men each) and 1 light machine gun section (also with 9 men). 


P22202
This unit represents a standard rifle platoon of the Danish Army. The Danish Army depended on reservists to a large degree, however the troops who briefly faught the Germans in 1940 gave a good acount of themselves. In 1940 the Danish Army was transitioning from a grey to a brown uniform. The process was not complete at the time of the German invasion. A rifle platoon was armed with 8mm Krag rifles and 8mm Madsen light machineguns. Each platoon was divided into 4 rifle sections (with 9 men each) and 1 light machine gun section (also with 9 men). 


P22203
The Madsen machinegun is unique, in that it was the world's first true light machinegun. Production began in 1897 and ended in the 1950's. This weapon has an unusual action somewhat similar to the Martini-Henry. Overall, this weapon proved to be very reliable and was sold around the world.


P22204
This unit represents a tripod mounted Madsen, used as a medium machinegun or light anti-aircraft machinegun. The Madsen machinegun is unique, in that it was the world's first true light machinegun. Production began in 1897 and ended in the 1950's. This weapon has an unusual action somewhat similar to the Martini-Henry. Overall, this weapon proved to be very reliable and was sold around the world.


P22205
This unit represents a platoon of the Hussar Guard Regiment. The life Guard and Hussar Guard regiments were royal guard regiments and the elite of the Danish army. In time of war, they operated as regular cavalry and infantry units. This unit represents a platoon of Hussar Guards armed with 8mm Krag.


P22206
This unit represents a platoon of cavalry. The Cavalry were armed with 8mm Krag rifles.


P22207
This unit represents a bicycle platoon of the Danish Army. The Danish Army depended on reservists to a large degree, however the troops who briefly faught the Germans in 1940 gave a good acount of themselves. In 1940 the Danish Army was transitioning from a grey to a brown uniform. The process was not complete at the time of the German invasion. A bicycle platoon was armed with 8mm Krag rifles and 8mm Madsen light machineguns.


P22208
This unit represents a motorcycle platoon of the Danish Army. The Danish Army depended on reservists to a large degree, however the troops who briefly faught the Germans in 1940 gave a good acount of themselves. In 1940 the Danish Army was transitioning from a grey to a brown uniform. The process was not complete at the time of the German invasion. A motorcycle platoon was armed with 8mm Krag rifles and 8mm Madsen light machineguns.


P22209
This unit represents a pioneer or engineer platoon of the Danish army.


P22210
This unit represents Danish partisans. Denmark never had a strong resistance movement. There was however an active resistance from 1940 on which intensified to a considerable degree after the complete German takeover of Denmark in 1943.


P22301
This unit represents a Danish HQ.


P22302
This unit represents a Danish HQ.


P22303
This unit represents a Danish HQ.


P22304
This unit represents a Danish HQ.


P22305
This unit represents a Danish HQ.



P22306
This unit represents a Danish HQ.


P22401
This unit represents a Danish officer.


P22402
This unit represents a Danish officer.


P22403
This unit represents a Danish officer.


P22404
This unit represents a Danish officer.


P22405
This unit represents a Danish officer.


P22406
This unit represents a Danish officer.


P22407
This unit represents a Danish officer.


P22408
This unit represents a Danish officer.


P22409
This unit represents a Danish officer.


P22410
This unit represents a Danish officer.


P22501
The Fokker XXI was the main fighter of the Danish Airforce. Two aircraft were delivered from the Netherlands with a further 10 built in Copenhagen in 1939. They were powered by 1  Mercury VIS radial, armmed with 2  0.312 in (7,92 mm) guns in the fuselage and 2  20 mm Madsen cannon in large underwing gondolas faired into the undersurface of the wing just outboard of the main landing gear units. Length was 23 ft 7.5 in (7,20 m), empty weight was 2,701 lb (1.225 kg), max take-off weight was 3,858 lb (1.750 kg), max level speed was 245.5 mph (395 km/h) at optimum altitude, cruising speed was 207 mph (333 km/h) at optimum altitude, range was 559 miles (900 km), and service ceiling was 29,530 ft (9.000 m) 


